* remote.c (kill_kludge): Delete.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
... / ...
CommitLineData
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
6@c %**start of header
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27@syncodeindex vr cp
28@syncodeindex fn cp
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31@c This is updated by GNU Press.
32@set EDITION Ninth
33
34@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35@set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40@c manuals to an info tree.
41@dircategory Software development
42@direntry
43* Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44@end direntry
45
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68@end ifinfo
69
70@titlepage
71@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73@sp 1
74@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76@page
77@tex
78{\parskip=0pt
79\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82}
83@end tex
84
85@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
871996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89@sp 2
90Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9151 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105@page
106This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108software in general. We will miss him.
109@end titlepage
110@page
111
112@ifnottex
113@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120@value{GDBVN}.
121
122Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126software in general. We will miss him.
127
128@menu
129* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136* Stack:: Examining the stack
137* Source:: Examining source files
138* Data:: Examining data
139* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146* Altering:: Altering execution
147* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167* Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168* Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173* Index:: Index
174@end menu
175
176@end ifnottex
177
178@contents
179
180@node Summary
181@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190@itemize @bullet
191@item
192Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194@item
195Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197@item
198Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200@item
201Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203@end itemize
204
205You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209@cindex Modula-2
210Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213@cindex Pascal
214Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217syntax.
218
219@cindex Fortran
220@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222underscore.
223
224@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227@menu
228* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230@end menu
231
232@node Free Software
233@unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236General Public License
237(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246from anyone else.
247
248@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252include with the free software. Many of our most important
253programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255when an important free software package does not come with a free
256manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257gaps today.
258
259Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263them from the free software world.
264
265That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269contract to make it non-free.
270
271Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290community.
291
292Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300of the manual.
301
302However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306manual to replace it.
307
308Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313the free software community.
314
315If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335published by other publishers, at
336@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338@node Contributors
339@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347blow-by-blow account.
348
349Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351@quotation
352@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355@end quotation
356
357So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359releases:
360Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390support.
391Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411libraries.
412
413Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414about several machine instruction sets.
415
416Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422command-line editing and command history.
423
424Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429symbols.
430
431Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437processors.
438
439Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446watchpoints.
447
448Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486Hat.
487
488Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506Weigand.
507
508Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513@node Sample Session
514@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520@iftex
521In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523@end iftex
524
525@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538@smallexample
539$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540$ @b{./m4}
541@b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543@b{foo}
5440000
545@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547@b{bar}
5480000
549@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552@b{baz}
553@b{Ctrl-d}
554m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555@end smallexample
556
557@noindent
558Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560@smallexample
561$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563@c FIXME... format to come out better.
564@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571(@value{GDBP})
572@end smallexample
573
574@noindent
575@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578that examples fit in this manual.
579
580@smallexample
581(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582@end smallexample
583
584@noindent
585We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588@code{break} command.
589
590@smallexample
591(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593@end smallexample
594
595@noindent
596Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600@smallexample
601(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603@b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605@b{foo}
6060000
607@end smallexample
608
609@noindent
610To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612context where it stops.
613
614@smallexample
615@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620@end smallexample
621
622@noindent
623Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624the next line of the current function.
625
626@smallexample
627(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630@end smallexample
631
632@noindent
633@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638@smallexample
639(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643@end smallexample
644
645@noindent
646The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653@smallexample
654(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664@end smallexample
665
666@noindent
667We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671@smallexample
672(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6730x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6750x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682@end smallexample
683
684@noindent
685The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688(@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690@smallexample
691(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695@end smallexample
696
697@noindent
698@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702@smallexample
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704533 xfree(rquote);
705534
706535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710537
711538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713540 @}
714541
715542 void
716@end smallexample
717
718@noindent
719Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722@smallexample
723(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726540 @}
727(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728$3 = 9
729(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730$4 = 7
731@end smallexample
732
733@noindent
734That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739assignments.
740
741@smallexample
742(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743$5 = 7
744(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745$6 = 9
746@end smallexample
747
748@noindent
749Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752example that caused trouble initially:
753
754@smallexample
755(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756Continuing.
757
758@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760baz
7610000
762@end smallexample
763
764@noindent
765Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769@smallexample
770@b{Ctrl-d}
771Program exited normally.
772@end smallexample
773
774@noindent
775The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779@smallexample
780(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781@end smallexample
782
783@node Invocation
784@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787The essentials are:
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
790type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791@item
792type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793@end itemize
794
795@menu
796* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799* Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800@end menu
801
802@node Invoking GDB
803@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811The command-line options described here are designed
812to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816specifying an executable program:
817
818@smallexample
819@value{GDBP} @var{program}
820@end smallexample
821
822@noindent
823You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824specified:
825
826@smallexample
827@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828@end smallexample
829
830You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831to debug a running process:
832
833@smallexample
834@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835@end smallexample
836
837@noindent
838would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849option processing.
850@smallexample
851@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852@end smallexample
853This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859@smallexample
860@value{GDBP} -silent
861@end smallexample
862
863@noindent
864You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867@noindent
868Type
869
870@smallexample
871@value{GDBP} -help
872@end smallexample
873
874@noindent
875to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880@samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883@menu
884* File Options:: Choosing files
885* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886* Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887@end menu
888
889@node File Options
890@subsection Choosing Files
891
892When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908argument and ignore it.
909
910Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918@c it.
919
920@table @code
921@item -symbols @var{file}
922@itemx -s @var{file}
923@cindex @code{--symbols}
924@cindex @code{-s}
925Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927@item -exec @var{file}
928@itemx -e @var{file}
929@cindex @code{--exec}
930@cindex @code{-e}
931Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934@item -se @var{file}
935@cindex @code{--se}
936Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937file.
938
939@item -core @var{file}
940@itemx -c @var{file}
941@cindex @code{--core}
942@cindex @code{-c}
943Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945@item -pid @var{number}
946@itemx -p @var{number}
947@cindex @code{--pid}
948@cindex @code{-p}
949Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
950
951@item -command @var{file}
952@itemx -x @var{file}
953@cindex @code{--command}
954@cindex @code{-x}
955Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
956Files,, Command files}.
957
958@item -eval-command @var{command}
959@itemx -ex @var{command}
960@cindex @code{--eval-command}
961@cindex @code{-ex}
962Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
963
964This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
965also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
966
967@smallexample
968@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
969 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
970@end smallexample
971
972@item -directory @var{directory}
973@itemx -d @var{directory}
974@cindex @code{--directory}
975@cindex @code{-d}
976Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
977
978@item -r
979@itemx -readnow
980@cindex @code{--readnow}
981@cindex @code{-r}
982Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
983the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
984This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
985
986@end table
987
988@node Mode Options
989@subsection Choosing Modes
990
991You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
992batch mode or quiet mode.
993
994@table @code
995@item -nx
996@itemx -n
997@cindex @code{--nx}
998@cindex @code{-n}
999Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1000@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1001options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1002Files}.
1003
1004@item -quiet
1005@itemx -silent
1006@itemx -q
1007@cindex @code{--quiet}
1008@cindex @code{--silent}
1009@cindex @code{-q}
1010``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1011messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1012
1013@item -batch
1014@cindex @code{--batch}
1015Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1016command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1017initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1018nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1019in the command files.
1020
1021Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1022example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1023make this more useful, the message
1024
1025@smallexample
1026Program exited normally.
1027@end smallexample
1028
1029@noindent
1030(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1031@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1032mode.
1033
1034@item -batch-silent
1035@cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1036Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1037@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1038unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1039for an interactive session.
1040
1041This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1042messages, for example.
1043
1044Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1045writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1046
1047@item -return-child-result
1048@cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1049The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1050process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1051
1052@itemize @bullet
1053@item
1054@value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1055internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1056without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1057@item
1058The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1059@item
1060The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1061the exit code will be -1.
1062@end itemize
1063
1064This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1065when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1066interface.
1067
1068@item -nowindows
1069@itemx -nw
1070@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1071@cindex @code{-nw}
1072``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1073(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1074interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1075
1076@item -windows
1077@itemx -w
1078@cindex @code{--windows}
1079@cindex @code{-w}
1080If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1081used if possible.
1082
1083@item -cd @var{directory}
1084@cindex @code{--cd}
1085Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1086instead of the current directory.
1087
1088@item -fullname
1089@itemx -f
1090@cindex @code{--fullname}
1091@cindex @code{-f}
1092@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1093subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1094number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1095displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1096recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1097the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1098and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1099@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1100frame.
1101
1102@item -epoch
1103@cindex @code{--epoch}
1104The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1105@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1106routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1107separate window.
1108
1109@item -annotate @var{level}
1110@cindex @code{--annotate}
1111This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1112effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1113(@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1114information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1115expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1116normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1117@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1118that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1119
1120The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1121(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1122
1123@item --args
1124@cindex @code{--args}
1125Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1126executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1127This option stops option processing.
1128
1129@item -baud @var{bps}
1130@itemx -b @var{bps}
1131@cindex @code{--baud}
1132@cindex @code{-b}
1133Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1134interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1135
1136@item -l @var{timeout}
1137@cindex @code{-l}
1138Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1139for remote debugging.
1140
1141@item -tty @var{device}
1142@itemx -t @var{device}
1143@cindex @code{--tty}
1144@cindex @code{-t}
1145Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1146@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1147
1148@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1149@item -tui
1150@cindex @code{--tui}
1151Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1152Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1153source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1154(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1155Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1156@samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1157Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1158
1159@c @item -xdb
1160@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1161@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1162@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1163@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1164@c systems.
1165
1166@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1167@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1168Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1169program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1170communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1171@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1172
1173@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1174@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1175The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1176previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1177selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1178@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1179
1180@item -write
1181@cindex @code{--write}
1182Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1183is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1184(@pxref{Patching}).
1185
1186@item -statistics
1187@cindex @code{--statistics}
1188This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1189memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1190
1191@item -version
1192@cindex @code{--version}
1193This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1194no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1195
1196@end table
1197
1198@node Startup
1199@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1200@cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1201
1202Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1203
1204@enumerate
1205@item
1206Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1207(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1208
1209@item
1210@cindex init file
1211Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1212DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1213@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1214that file.
1215
1216@item
1217Processes command line options and operands.
1218
1219@item
1220Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1221working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1222different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1223init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1224to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1225@value{GDBN}.
1226
1227@item
1228Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1229Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1230
1231@item
1232Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1233@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1234files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1235@end enumerate
1236
1237Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1238Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1239file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1240complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1241and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1242option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1243
1244@cindex init file name
1245@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1246@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1247The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1248The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1249the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1250ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1251@file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1252the file to the standard name.
1253
1254
1255@node Quitting GDB
1256@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1257@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1258@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1259
1260@table @code
1261@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1262@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1263@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1264@itemx q
1265To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1266@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1267do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1268otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1269error code.
1270@end table
1271
1272@cindex interrupt
1273An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1274terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1275returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1276character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1277until a time when it is safe.
1278
1279If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1280device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1281(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1282
1283@node Shell Commands
1284@section Shell Commands
1285
1286If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1287debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1288just use the @code{shell} command.
1289
1290@table @code
1291@kindex shell
1292@cindex shell escape
1293@item shell @var{command string}
1294Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1295If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1296shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1297(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1298@end table
1299
1300The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1301You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1302@value{GDBN}:
1303
1304@table @code
1305@kindex make
1306@cindex calling make
1307@item make @var{make-args}
1308Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1309arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1310@end table
1311
1312@node Logging Output
1313@section Logging Output
1314@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1315@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1316
1317You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1318There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1319
1320@table @code
1321@kindex set logging
1322@item set logging on
1323Enable logging.
1324@item set logging off
1325Disable logging.
1326@cindex logging file name
1327@item set logging file @var{file}
1328Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1329@item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1330By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1331you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1332@item set logging redirect [on|off]
1333By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1334Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1335@kindex show logging
1336@item show logging
1337Show the current values of the logging settings.
1338@end table
1339
1340@node Commands
1341@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1342
1343You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1344name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1345@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1346key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1347show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1348
1349@menu
1350* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1351* Completion:: Command completion
1352* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1353@end menu
1354
1355@node Command Syntax
1356@section Command Syntax
1357
1358A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1359how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1360arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1361command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1362step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1363with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1364
1365@cindex abbreviation
1366@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1367unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1368documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1369abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1370equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1371names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1372arguments to the @code{help} command.
1373
1374@cindex repeating commands
1375@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1376A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1377repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1378will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1379repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1380repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1381@ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1382
1383The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1384@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1385exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1386
1387@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1388output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1389(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1390@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1391repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1392
1393@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1394@cindex comment
1395Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1396nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1397Files,,Command Files}).
1398
1399@cindex repeating command sequences
1400@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1401The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1402commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1403then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1404for editing.
1405
1406@node Completion
1407@section Command Completion
1408
1409@cindex completion
1410@cindex word completion
1411@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1412only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1413are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1414commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1415
1416Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1417of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1418word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1419enter it). For example, if you type
1420
1421@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1422@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1423@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1424@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1425@smallexample
1426(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1427@end smallexample
1428
1429@noindent
1430@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1431the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1432
1433@smallexample
1434(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1435@end smallexample
1436
1437@noindent
1438You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1439breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1440@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1441were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1442might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1443to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1444
1445If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1446@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1447characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1448@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1449example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1450begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1451just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1452function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1453example:
1454
1455@smallexample
1456(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1457@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1458make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1459make_abs_section make_function_type
1460make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1461make_cleanup make_reference_type
1462make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1463(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1464@end smallexample
1465
1466@noindent
1467After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1468partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1469command.
1470
1471If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1472can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1473means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1474key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1475one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1476
1477@cindex quotes in commands
1478@cindex completion of quoted strings
1479Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1480parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1481its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1482situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1483@value{GDBN} commands.
1484
1485The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1486name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1487overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1488by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1489may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1490that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1491that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1492word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1493@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1494@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1495when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1496
1497@smallexample
1498(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1499bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1500(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1501@end smallexample
1502
1503In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1504quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1505completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1506place:
1507
1508@smallexample
1509(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1510@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1511(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1512@end smallexample
1513
1514@noindent
1515In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1516you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1517completion on an overloaded symbol.
1518
1519For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1520Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1521overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1522see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1523
1524
1525@node Help
1526@section Getting Help
1527@cindex online documentation
1528@kindex help
1529
1530You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1531using the command @code{help}.
1532
1533@table @code
1534@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1535@item help
1536@itemx h
1537You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1538display a short list of named classes of commands:
1539
1540@smallexample
1541(@value{GDBP}) help
1542List of classes of commands:
1543
1544aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1545breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1546data -- Examining data
1547files -- Specifying and examining files
1548internals -- Maintenance commands
1549obscure -- Obscure features
1550running -- Running the program
1551stack -- Examining the stack
1552status -- Status inquiries
1553support -- Support facilities
1554tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1555 stopping the program
1556user-defined -- User-defined commands
1557
1558Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1559commands in that class.
1560Type "help" followed by command name for full
1561documentation.
1562Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1563(@value{GDBP})
1564@end smallexample
1565@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1566
1567@item help @var{class}
1568Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1569list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1570help display for the class @code{status}:
1571
1572@smallexample
1573(@value{GDBP}) help status
1574Status inquiries.
1575
1576List of commands:
1577
1578@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1579@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1580info -- Generic command for showing things
1581 about the program being debugged
1582show -- Generic command for showing things
1583 about the debugger
1584
1585Type "help" followed by command name for full
1586documentation.
1587Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1588(@value{GDBP})
1589@end smallexample
1590
1591@item help @var{command}
1592With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1593short paragraph on how to use that command.
1594
1595@kindex apropos
1596@item apropos @var{args}
1597The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1598commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1599@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1600
1601@smallexample
1602apropos reload
1603@end smallexample
1604
1605@noindent
1606results in:
1607
1608@smallexample
1609@c @group
1610set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1611 multiple times in one run
1612show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1613 multiple times in one run
1614@c @end group
1615@end smallexample
1616
1617@kindex complete
1618@item complete @var{args}
1619The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1620for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1621command you want completed. For example:
1622
1623@smallexample
1624complete i
1625@end smallexample
1626
1627@noindent results in:
1628
1629@smallexample
1630@group
1631if
1632ignore
1633info
1634inspect
1635@end group
1636@end smallexample
1637
1638@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1639@end table
1640
1641In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1642and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1643of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1644manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1645under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1646all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1647
1648@c @group
1649@table @code
1650@kindex info
1651@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1652@item info
1653This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1654program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1655with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1656registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1657You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1658@w{@code{help info}}.
1659
1660@kindex set
1661@item set
1662You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1663@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1664@code{set prompt $}.
1665
1666@kindex show
1667@item show
1668In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1669@value{GDBN} itself.
1670You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1671related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1672system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1673which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1674
1675@kindex info set
1676To display all the settable parameters and their current
1677values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1678@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1679@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1680@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1681@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1682@end table
1683@c @end group
1684
1685Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1686exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1687
1688@table @code
1689@kindex show version
1690@cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1691@item show version
1692Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1693information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1694@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1695version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1696commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1697system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1698variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1699The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1700@value{GDBN}.
1701
1702@kindex show copying
1703@kindex info copying
1704@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1705@item show copying
1706@itemx info copying
1707Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1708
1709@kindex show warranty
1710@kindex info warranty
1711@item show warranty
1712@itemx info warranty
1713Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1714if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1715
1716@end table
1717
1718@node Running
1719@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1720
1721When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1722debugging information when you compile it.
1723
1724You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1725of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1726your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1727kill a child process.
1728
1729@menu
1730* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1731* Starting:: Starting your program
1732* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1733* Environment:: Your program's environment
1734
1735* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1736* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1737* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1738* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1739
1740* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1741* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1742* Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1743@end menu
1744
1745@node Compilation
1746@section Compiling for Debugging
1747
1748In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755the compiler.
1756
1757Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767in pushing your luck.
1768
1769@cindex optimized code, debugging
1770@cindex debugging optimized code
1771When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793provides macro information if you specify the options
1794@option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798@option{-g} alone.
1799
1800@need 2000
1801@node Starting
1802@section Starting your Program
1803@cindex starting
1804@cindex running
1805
1806@table @code
1807@kindex run
1808@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809@item run
1810@itemx r
1811Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1816
1817@end table
1818
1819If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1822@code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1823like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1824message like this one:
1825
1826@smallexample
1827The "remote" target does not support "run".
1828Try "help target" or "continue".
1829@end smallexample
1830
1831@noindent
1832then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1833first (@pxref{load}).
1834
1835The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1836receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1837information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1838can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1839your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1840divided into four categories:
1841
1842@table @asis
1843@item The @emph{arguments.}
1844Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1845@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1846is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1847(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1848the arguments.
1849In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1850@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1851@xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1852
1853@item The @emph{environment.}
1854Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1855use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1856environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1857your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1858
1859@item The @emph{working directory.}
1860Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1861the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1862@xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1863
1864@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1865Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1866standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1867in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1868set a different device for your program.
1869@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1870
1871@cindex pipes
1872@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1873pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1874program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1875wrong program.
1876@end table
1877
1878When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1879immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1880of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1881stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1882or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1883
1884If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1885time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1886table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1887your current breakpoints.
1888
1889@table @code
1890@kindex start
1891@item start
1892@cindex run to main procedure
1893The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1894With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1895other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1896main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1897execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1898procedure, depending on the language used.
1899
1900The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1901breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1902the @samp{run} command.
1903
1904@cindex elaboration phase
1905Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1906executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1907languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1908constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1909@code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1910before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1911will remain to halt execution.
1912
1913Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1914@samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1915underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1916reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1917@samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1918
1919It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1920these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1921your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1922elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1923elaboration code before running your program.
1924
1925@kindex set exec-wrapper
1926@item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1927@itemx show exec-wrapper
1928@itemx unset exec-wrapper
1929When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1930launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1931with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1932@var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1933arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1934appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1935your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1936
1937You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1938its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1939this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1940with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1941
1942For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1943the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1944environment:
1945
1946@smallexample
1947(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1948(@value{GDBP}) run
1949@end smallexample
1950
1951This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
1952@sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
1953
1954@end table
1955
1956@node Arguments
1957@section Your Program's Arguments
1958
1959@cindex arguments (to your program)
1960The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1961@code{run} command.
1962They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1963performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1964@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1965@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1966the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1967
1968On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1969@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1970calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1971the program, not by the shell.
1972
1973@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1974@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1975
1976@table @code
1977@kindex set args
1978@item set args
1979Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1980@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1981with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1982using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1983it again without arguments.
1984
1985@kindex show args
1986@item show args
1987Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1988@end table
1989
1990@node Environment
1991@section Your Program's Environment
1992
1993@cindex environment (of your program)
1994The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1995their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1996your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1997path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1998the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1999debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2000environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2001
2002@table @code
2003@kindex path
2004@item path @var{directory}
2005Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2006(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2007The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2008You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2009system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2010MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2011is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2012
2013You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2014working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2015use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2016@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2017@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2018@var{directory} to the search path.
2019@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2020@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2021
2022@kindex show paths
2023@item show paths
2024Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2025environment variable).
2026
2027@kindex show environment
2028@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2029Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2030your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2031print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2032your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2033
2034@kindex set environment
2035@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2036Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2037changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2038be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2039any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2040parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2041null value.
2042@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2043@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2044
2045For example, this command:
2046
2047@smallexample
2048set env USER = foo
2049@end smallexample
2050
2051@noindent
2052tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2053@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2054are not actually required.)
2055
2056@kindex unset environment
2057@item unset environment @var{varname}
2058Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2059program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2060@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2061rather than assigning it an empty value.
2062@end table
2063
2064@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2065the shell indicated
2066by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2067@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2068that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2069@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2070your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2071files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2072@file{.profile}.
2073
2074@node Working Directory
2075@section Your Program's Working Directory
2076
2077@cindex working directory (of your program)
2078Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2079working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2080The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2081from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2082working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2083
2084The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2085that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2086Specify Files}.
2087
2088@table @code
2089@kindex cd
2090@cindex change working directory
2091@item cd @var{directory}
2092Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2093
2094@kindex pwd
2095@item pwd
2096Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2097@end table
2098
2099It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2100the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2101during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2102configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2103proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2104current working directory of the debuggee.
2105
2106@node Input/Output
2107@section Your Program's Input and Output
2108
2109@cindex redirection
2110@cindex i/o
2111@cindex terminal
2112By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2113the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2114to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2115modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2116running your program.
2117
2118@table @code
2119@kindex info terminal
2120@item info terminal
2121Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2122program is using.
2123@end table
2124
2125You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2126redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2127
2128@smallexample
2129run > outfile
2130@end smallexample
2131
2132@noindent
2133starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2134
2135@kindex tty
2136@cindex controlling terminal
2137Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2138with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2139argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2140commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2141process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2142
2143@smallexample
2144tty /dev/ttyb
2145@end smallexample
2146
2147@noindent
2148directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2149default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2150that as their controlling terminal.
2151
2152An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2153effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2154terminal.
2155
2156When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2157command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2158for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2159for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2160
2161@cindex inferior tty
2162@cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2163You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2164display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2165program.
2166
2167@table @code
2168@item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2169@kindex set inferior-tty
2170Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2171
2172@item show inferior-tty
2173@kindex show inferior-tty
2174Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2175@end table
2176
2177@node Attach
2178@section Debugging an Already-running Process
2179@kindex attach
2180@cindex attach
2181
2182@table @code
2183@item attach @var{process-id}
2184This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2185outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2186targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2187find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2188or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2189
2190@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2191executing the command.
2192@end table
2193
2194To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2195which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2196programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2197also have permission to send the process a signal.
2198
2199When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2200the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2201the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2202(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2203the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2204Specify Files}.
2205
2206The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2207process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2208with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2209you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2210can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2211process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2212attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2213
2214@table @code
2215@kindex detach
2216@item detach
2217When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2218@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2219the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2220that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2221are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2222@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2223executing the command.
2224@end table
2225
2226If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2227that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2228By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2229things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2230@code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2231Messages}).
2232
2233@node Kill Process
2234@section Killing the Child Process
2235
2236@table @code
2237@kindex kill
2238@item kill
2239Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2240@end table
2241
2242This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2243running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2244is running.
2245
2246On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2247while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2248@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2249outside the debugger.
2250
2251The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2252relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2253executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2254next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2255reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2256breakpoint settings).
2257
2258@node Threads
2259@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2260
2261@cindex threads of execution
2262@cindex multiple threads
2263@cindex switching threads
2264In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2265may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2266of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2267the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2268that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2269modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2270registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2271
2272@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2273programs:
2274
2275@itemize @bullet
2276@item automatic notification of new threads
2277@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2278@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2279@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2280a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2281@item thread-specific breakpoints
2282@item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2283messages on thread start and exit.
2284@end itemize
2285
2286@quotation
2287@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2288@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2289If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2290effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2291from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2292like this:
2293
2294@smallexample
2295(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2296(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2297Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2298see the IDs of currently known threads.
2299@end smallexample
2300@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2301@c doesn't support threads"?
2302@end quotation
2303
2304@cindex focus of debugging
2305@cindex current thread
2306The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2307threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2308control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2309This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2310program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2311
2312@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2313@cindex thread identifier (system)
2314@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2315@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2316@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2317Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2318the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2319form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2320whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2321@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2322
2323@smallexample
2324[New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2325@end smallexample
2326
2327@noindent
2328when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2329the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2330further qualifier.
2331
2332@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2333@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2334@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2335@c program?
2336@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2337@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2338@c threads ab initio?
2339
2340@cindex thread number
2341@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2342For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2343number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2344
2345@table @code
2346@kindex info threads
2347@item info threads
2348Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2349program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2350
2351@enumerate
2352@item
2353the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2354
2355@item
2356the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2357
2358@item
2359the current stack frame summary for that thread
2360@end enumerate
2361
2362@noindent
2363An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2364indicates the current thread.
2365
2366For example,
2367@end table
2368@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2369
2370@smallexample
2371(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2372 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2373 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2374* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2375 at threadtest.c:68
2376@end smallexample
2377
2378On HP-UX systems:
2379
2380@cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2381@cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2382For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2383number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2384thread in your program.
2385
2386@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2387@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2388@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2389@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2390@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2391Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2392both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2393form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2394whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2395HP-UX, you see
2396
2397@smallexample
2398[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2399@end smallexample
2400
2401@noindent
2402when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2403
2404@table @code
2405@kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2406@item info threads
2407Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2408program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2409
2410@enumerate
2411@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2412
2413@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2414
2415@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2416@end enumerate
2417
2418@noindent
2419An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2420indicates the current thread.
2421
2422For example,
2423@end table
2424@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2425
2426@smallexample
2427(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2428 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2429 at quicksort.c:137
2430 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2431 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2432 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2433 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2434@end smallexample
2435
2436On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2437Solaris-specific command:
2438
2439@table @code
2440@item maint info sol-threads
2441@kindex maint info sol-threads
2442@cindex thread info (Solaris)
2443Display info on Solaris user threads.
2444@end table
2445
2446@table @code
2447@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2448@item thread @var{threadno}
2449Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2450argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2451shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2452@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2453you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2454
2455@smallexample
2456@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2457(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2458[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
24590x34e5 in sigpause ()
2460@end smallexample
2461
2462@noindent
2463As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2464@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2465threads.
2466
2467@kindex thread apply
2468@cindex apply command to several threads
2469@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2470The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2471@var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2472threads that you want affected with the command argument
2473@var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2474shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2475could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2476command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2477
2478@kindex set print thread-events
2479@cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2480@item set print thread-events
2481@itemx set print thread-events on
2482@itemx set print thread-events off
2483The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2484disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2485started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2486be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2487Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2488
2489@kindex show print thread-events
2490@item show print thread-events
2491Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2492have started and exited.
2493@end table
2494
2495@cindex automatic thread selection
2496@cindex switching threads automatically
2497@cindex threads, automatic switching
2498Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2499signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2500signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2501message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2502thread.
2503
2504@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2505more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2506programs with multiple threads.
2507
2508@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2509watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2510
2511@node Processes
2512@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2513
2514@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2515@cindex multiple processes
2516@cindex processes, multiple
2517On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2518programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2519function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2520parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2521set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2522will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2523will cause it to terminate.
2524
2525However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2526which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2527the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2528only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2529so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2530on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2531get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2532@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2533the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2534the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2535
2536On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2537create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2538Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2539only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2540
2541By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2542the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2543
2544If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2545use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2546
2547@table @code
2548@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2549@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2550Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2551@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2552process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2553
2554@table @code
2555@item parent
2556The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2557unimpeded. This is the default.
2558
2559@item child
2560The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2561unimpeded.
2562
2563@end table
2564
2565@kindex show follow-fork-mode
2566@item show follow-fork-mode
2567Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2568@end table
2569
2570@cindex debugging multiple processes
2571On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2572command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2573
2574@table @code
2575@kindex set detach-on-fork
2576@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2577Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2578retain debugger control over them both.
2579
2580@table @code
2581@item on
2582The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2583@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2584independently. This is the default.
2585
2586@item off
2587Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2588One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2589@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2590is held suspended.
2591
2592@end table
2593
2594@kindex show detach-on-fork
2595@item show detach-on-fork
2596Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2597@end table
2598
2599If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2600@value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2601nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2602@value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2603from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2604
2605@table @code
2606@kindex info forks
2607@item info forks
2608Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2609The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2610position (program counter) of the process.
2611
2612@kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2613@item fork @var{fork-id}
2614Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2615@var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2616as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2617
2618@kindex process @var{process-id}
2619@item process @var{process-id}
2620Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2621argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2622@samp{info forks}.
2623
2624@end table
2625
2626To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2627from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2628run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2629@w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2630
2631@table @code
2632@kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2633@item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2634Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2635@var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2636allowed to run independently.
2637
2638@kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2639@item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2640Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2641and remove it from the fork list.
2642
2643@end table
2644
2645If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2646@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2647breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2648@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2649the child process's @code{main}.
2650
2651When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2652child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2653
2654If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2655call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2656use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2657argument.
2658
2659You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2660a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2661Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2662
2663@node Checkpoint/Restart
2664@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2665
2666@cindex checkpoint
2667@cindex restart
2668@cindex bookmark
2669@cindex snapshot of a process
2670@cindex rewind program state
2671
2672On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2673@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2674program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2675later.
2676
2677Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2678happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2679includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2680system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2681moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2682
2683Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2684getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2685a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2686the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2687from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2688start again from there.
2689
2690This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2691steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2692
2693To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2694
2695@table @code
2696@kindex checkpoint
2697@item checkpoint
2698Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2699The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2700is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2701
2702@kindex info checkpoints
2703@item info checkpoints
2704List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2705session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2706listed:
2707
2708@table @code
2709@item Checkpoint ID
2710@item Process ID
2711@item Code Address
2712@item Source line, or label
2713@end table
2714
2715@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2716@item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2717Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2718@var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2719etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2720was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2721in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2722
2723Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2724are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2725only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2726the debugger.
2727
2728@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2729@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2730Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2731
2732@end table
2733
2734Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2735of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2736(OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2737a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2738so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2739opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2740previously read data can be read again.
2741
2742Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2743external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2744from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2745but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2746be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2747been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2748
2749However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2750program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2751again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2752different execution path this time.
2753
2754@cindex checkpoints and process id
2755Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2756different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2757id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2758and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2759If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2760potentially pose a problem.
2761
2762@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2763
2764On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2765is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2766difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2767absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2768absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2769next.
2770
2771A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2772Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2773and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2774process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2775your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2776
2777@node Stopping
2778@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2779
2780The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2781program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2782trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2783
2784Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2785such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2786@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2787change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2788continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2789ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2790explicitly request this information at any time.
2791
2792@table @code
2793@kindex info program
2794@item info program
2795Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2796running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2797@end table
2798
2799@menu
2800* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2801* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2802* Signals:: Signals
2803* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2804@end menu
2805
2806@node Breakpoints
2807@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2808
2809@cindex breakpoints
2810A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2811the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2812control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2813breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2814Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2815should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2816program.
2817
2818On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2819the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2820you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2821in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2822(for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2823call).
2824
2825@cindex watchpoints
2826@cindex data breakpoints
2827@cindex memory tracing
2828@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2829@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2830A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2831when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2832of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2833combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2834@dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2835watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2836from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2837enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2838same commands.
2839
2840You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2841whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2842Automatic Display}.
2843
2844@cindex catchpoints
2845@cindex breakpoint on events
2846A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2847when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2848exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2849different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2850Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2851other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2852@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2853
2854@cindex breakpoint numbers
2855@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2856@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2857catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2858starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2859features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2860breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2861@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2862enable it again.
2863
2864@cindex breakpoint ranges
2865@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2866Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2867operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2868@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2869hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2870all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2871
2872@menu
2873* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2874* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2875* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2876* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2877* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2878* Conditions:: Break conditions
2879* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2880* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2881* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2882@end menu
2883
2884@node Set Breaks
2885@subsection Setting Breakpoints
2886
2887@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2888@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2889@c
2890@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2891
2892@kindex break
2893@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2894@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2895@cindex latest breakpoint
2896Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2897@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2898number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2899Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2900convenience variables.
2901
2902@table @code
2903@item break @var{location}
2904Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2905function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2906(@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2907specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2908before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2909
2910When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2911C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2912@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
2913that situation.
2914
2915@item break
2916When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2917the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2918(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2919innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2920returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2921@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2922that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2923@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2924the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2925inside loops.
2926
2927@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2928least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2929would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2930breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2931existed when your program stopped.
2932
2933@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2934Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2935@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2936value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2937@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2938above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2939,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2940
2941@kindex tbreak
2942@item tbreak @var{args}
2943Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2944same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2945way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2946program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2947
2948@kindex hbreak
2949@cindex hardware breakpoints
2950@item hbreak @var{args}
2951Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2952@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2953breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2954have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2955debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2956changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2957provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2958will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2959address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2960breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2961example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2962@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2963or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2964(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2965@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2966For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2967breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2968hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2969
2970@kindex thbreak
2971@item thbreak @var{args}
2972Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2973are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2974the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2975the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2976first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2977command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2978may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2979See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2980
2981@kindex rbreak
2982@cindex regular expression
2983@cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2984@cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2985@item rbreak @var{regex}
2986Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2987@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2988matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2989breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2990the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2991them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2992
2993The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2994like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2995shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2996an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2997@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2998match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2999
3000@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3001When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3002breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3003classes.
3004
3005@cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3006The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3007@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3008
3009@smallexample
3010(@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3011@end smallexample
3012
3013@kindex info breakpoints
3014@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3015@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3016@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3017@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3018Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3019not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3020about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3021each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3022
3023@table @emph
3024@item Breakpoint Numbers
3025@item Type
3026Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3027@item Disposition
3028Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3029@item Enabled or Disabled
3030Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3031that are not enabled.
3032@item Address
3033Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3034pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3035contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3036library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3037See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3038have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3039@item What
3040Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3041line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3042the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3043the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3044@end table
3045
3046@noindent
3047If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3048the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3049are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3050specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3051library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3052valid location.
3053
3054@noindent
3055@code{info break} with a breakpoint
3056number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3057convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3058the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3059listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3060
3061@noindent
3062@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3063has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3064@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3065hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3066was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3067will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3068@end table
3069
3070@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3071your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3072the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3073(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3074
3075@cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3076@cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3077It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3078in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3079
3080@itemize @bullet
3081@item
3082For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3083instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3084
3085@item
3086For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3087correspond to any number of instantiations.
3088
3089@item
3090For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3091several places where that function is inlined.
3092@end itemize
3093
3094In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3095the relevant locations@footnote{
3096As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3097line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3098will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3099info with line numbers for them.}.
3100
3101A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3102table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3103each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3104address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3105addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3106locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3107@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3108
3109For example:
3110
3111@smallexample
3112Num Type Disp Enb Address What
31131 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3114 stop only if i==1
3115 breakpoint already hit 1 time
31161.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
31171.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3118@end smallexample
3119
3120Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3121@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3122@code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3123delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3124entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3125the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3126the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3127the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3128that belong to that breakpoint.
3129
3130@cindex pending breakpoints
3131It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3132Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3133and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3134this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3135any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3136set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3137debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3138symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3139breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3140a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3141is not yet resolved.
3142
3143After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3144@value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3145shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3146pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3147ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3148that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3149
3150This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3151example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3152a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3153a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3154
3155Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3156differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3157enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3158
3159@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3160happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3161address specification to an address:
3162
3163@kindex set breakpoint pending
3164@kindex show breakpoint pending
3165@table @code
3166@item set breakpoint pending auto
3167This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3168location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3169
3170@item set breakpoint pending on
3171This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3172result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3173
3174@item set breakpoint pending off
3175This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3176unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3177not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3178
3179@item show breakpoint pending
3180Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3181@end table
3182
3183The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3184variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3185as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3186
3187@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3188For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3189software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3190breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3191breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3192breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3193breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3194breakpoints.
3195
3196You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3197
3198@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3199@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3200@table @code
3201@item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3202This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3203will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3204breakpoint must be used.
3205
3206@item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3207This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3208type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3209trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3210@end table
3211
3212@value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3213at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3214executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3215code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3216the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3217behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3218target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3219targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3220This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3221
3222@kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3223@kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3224@table @code
3225@item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3226This is the default behaviour. All breakpoints, including newly added
3227by the user, are inserted in the target only when the target is
3228resumed. All breakpoints are removed from the target when it stops.
3229
3230@item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3231Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3232the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3233breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3234removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3235@end table
3236
3237@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3238@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3239@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3240special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3241programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3242starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3243You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3244@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3245
3246
3247@node Set Watchpoints
3248@subsection Setting Watchpoints
3249
3250@cindex setting watchpoints
3251You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3252expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3253this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3254The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3255as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3256
3257@itemize @bullet
3258@item
3259A reference to the value of a single variable.
3260
3261@item
3262An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3263@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3264address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3265
3266@item
3267An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3268expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3269language (@pxref{Languages}).
3270@end itemize
3271
3272You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3273not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3274@samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3275@value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3276the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3277valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3278pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3279@code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3280the expression changes.
3281
3282@cindex software watchpoints
3283@cindex hardware watchpoints
3284Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3285hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3286program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3287times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3288catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3289culprit.)
3290
3291On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3292x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3293watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3294
3295@table @code
3296@kindex watch
3297@item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3298Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3299expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3300changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3301to watch the value of a single variable:
3302
3303@smallexample
3304(@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3305@end smallexample
3306
3307If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3308clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3309@var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3310change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3311that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3312with Hardware Watchpoints.
3313
3314@kindex rwatch
3315@item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3316Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3317by the program.
3318
3319@kindex awatch
3320@item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3321Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3322or written into by the program.
3323
3324@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3325@item info watchpoints
3326This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3327it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3328@end table
3329
3330@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3331watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3332value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3333cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3334executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3335@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3336
3337@cindex use only software watchpoints
3338You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3339@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3340zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3341the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3342watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3343@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3344mechanism of watching expression values.)
3345
3346@table @code
3347@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3348@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3349Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3350
3351@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3352@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3353Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3354@end table
3355
3356For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3357watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3358hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3359
3360When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3361
3362@smallexample
3363Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3364@end smallexample
3365
3366@noindent
3367if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3368
3369Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3370hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3371value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3372every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3373that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3374hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3375will print a message like this:
3376
3377@smallexample
3378Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3379@end smallexample
3380
3381Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3382data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3383watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3384can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3385cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3386double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3387wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3388into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3389
3390If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3391to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3392Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3393time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3394able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3395warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3396
3397@smallexample
3398Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3399@end smallexample
3400
3401@noindent
3402If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3403
3404Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3405exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3406That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3407expression with separately allocated resources.
3408
3409If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3410any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3411kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3412
3413@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3414(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3415they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3416which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3417being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3418and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3419rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3420way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3421@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3422
3423@cindex watchpoints and threads
3424@cindex threads and watchpoints
3425In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3426watched expression from every thread.
3427
3428@quotation
3429@emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3430have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3431watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3432single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3433change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3434confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3435software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3436when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3437watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3438@end quotation
3439
3440@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3441
3442@node Set Catchpoints
3443@subsection Setting Catchpoints
3444@cindex catchpoints, setting
3445@cindex exception handlers
3446@cindex event handling
3447
3448You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3449kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3450shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3451
3452@table @code
3453@kindex catch
3454@item catch @var{event}
3455Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3456@table @code
3457@item throw
3458@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3459The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3460
3461@item catch
3462The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3463
3464@item exception
3465@cindex Ada exception catching
3466@cindex catch Ada exceptions
3467An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3468at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3469the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3470Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3471
3472@item exception unhandled
3473An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3474
3475@item assert
3476A failed Ada assertion.
3477
3478@item exec
3479@cindex break on fork/exec
3480A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3481and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3482
3483@item fork
3484A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3485and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3486
3487@item vfork
3488A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3489and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3490
3491@item load
3492@itemx load @var{libname}
3493@cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3494The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3495@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3496
3497@item unload
3498@itemx unload @var{libname}
3499The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3500of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3501@end table
3502
3503@item tcatch @var{event}
3504Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3505automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3506
3507@end table
3508
3509Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3510
3511There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3512(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3513
3514@itemize @bullet
3515@item
3516If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3517control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3518raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3519returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3520simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3521that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3522you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3523disabled within interactive calls.
3524
3525@item
3526You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3527
3528@item
3529You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3530@end itemize
3531
3532@cindex raise exceptions
3533Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3534if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3535stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3536can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3537breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3538out where the exception was raised.
3539
3540To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3541knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3542raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3543which has the following ANSI C interface:
3544
3545@smallexample
3546 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3547 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3548 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3549@end smallexample
3550
3551@noindent
3552To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3553unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3554(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3555
3556With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3557that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3558a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3559breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3560raised.
3561
3562
3563@node Delete Breaks
3564@subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3565
3566@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3567@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3568It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3569catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3570to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3571breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3572
3573With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3574where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3575delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3576their breakpoint numbers.
3577
3578It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3579automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3580when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3581
3582@table @code
3583@kindex clear
3584@item clear
3585Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3586selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3587the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3588breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3589
3590@item clear @var{location}
3591Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3592@xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3593most useful ones are listed below:
3594
3595@table @code
3596@item clear @var{function}
3597@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3598Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3599
3600@item clear @var{linenum}
3601@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3602Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3603@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3604@end table
3605
3606@cindex delete breakpoints
3607@kindex delete
3608@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3609@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3610Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3611ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3612breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3613confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3614@end table
3615
3616@node Disabling
3617@subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3618
3619@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3620Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3621prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3622it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3623that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3624
3625You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3626the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3627or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3628@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3629catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3630
3631Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3632affects all of its locations.
3633
3634A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3635states of enablement:
3636
3637@itemize @bullet
3638@item
3639Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3640with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3641@item
3642Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3643@item
3644Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3645disabled.
3646@item
3647Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3648immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3649set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3650@end itemize
3651
3652You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3653watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3654
3655@table @code
3656@kindex disable
3657@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3658@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3659Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3660listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3661options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3662case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3663@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3664
3665@kindex enable
3666@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3667Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3668become effective once again in stopping your program.
3669
3670@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3671Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3672of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3673
3674@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3675Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3676deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3677Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3678@end table
3679
3680@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3681@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3682Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3683,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3684subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3685the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3686breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3687breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3688Stepping}.)
3689
3690@node Conditions
3691@subsection Break Conditions
3692@cindex conditional breakpoints
3693@cindex breakpoint conditions
3694
3695@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3696@c in particular for a watchpoint?
3697The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3698specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3699breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3700programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3701a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3702and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3703
3704This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3705situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3706when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3707by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3708@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3709
3710Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3711since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3712it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3713and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3714one.
3715
3716Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3717your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3718that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3719format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3720unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3721that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3722program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3723breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3724conditions for the
3725purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3726(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3727
3728Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3729@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3730Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3731with the @code{condition} command.
3732
3733You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3734The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3735@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3736catchpoint.
3737
3738@table @code
3739@kindex condition
3740@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3741Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3742watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3743breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3744@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3745@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3746syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3747referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3748symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3749prints an error message:
3750
3751@smallexample
3752No symbol "foo" in current context.
3753@end smallexample
3754
3755@noindent
3756@value{GDBN} does
3757not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3758command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3759@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3760
3761@item condition @var{bnum}
3762Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3763an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3764@end table
3765
3766@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3767A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3768breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3769useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3770count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3771is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3772therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3773ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3774the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3775value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3776your program reaches it.
3777
3778@table @code
3779@kindex ignore
3780@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3781Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3782The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3783execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3784takes no action.
3785
3786To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3787a count of zero.
3788
3789When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3790breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3791@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3792Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3793
3794If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3795condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3796@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3797
3798You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3799as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3800is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3801Variables}.
3802@end table
3803
3804Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3805
3806
3807@node Break Commands
3808@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3809
3810@cindex breakpoint commands
3811You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3812commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3813example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3814enable other breakpoints.
3815
3816@table @code
3817@kindex commands
3818@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3819@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3820@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3821@itemx end
3822Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3823themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3824@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3825
3826To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3827follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3828
3829With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3830breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3831recently encountered).
3832@end table
3833
3834Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3835disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3836
3837You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3838use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3839that resumes execution.
3840
3841Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3842execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3843(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3844another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3845ambiguities about which list to execute.
3846
3847@kindex silent
3848If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3849usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3850be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3851then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3852see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3853meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3854
3855The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3856print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3857breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3858
3859For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3860value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3861
3862@smallexample
3863break foo if x>0
3864commands
3865silent
3866printf "x is %d\n",x
3867cont
3868end
3869@end smallexample
3870
3871One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3872you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3873of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3874erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3875to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3876so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3877command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3878
3879@smallexample
3880break 403
3881commands
3882silent
3883set x = y + 4
3884cont
3885end
3886@end smallexample
3887
3888@c @ifclear BARETARGET
3889@node Error in Breakpoints
3890@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3891@c
3892@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3893@c
3894Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3895any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3896attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3897@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3898
3899@smallexample
3900Cannot insert breakpoints.
3901The same program may be running in another process.
3902@end smallexample
3903
3904When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3905
3906@enumerate
3907@item
3908Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3909
3910@item
3911Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3912name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3913that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3914Then start your program again.
3915
3916@item
3917Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3918linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3919to nonsharable executables.
3920@end enumerate
3921@c @end ifclear
3922
3923A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3924hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3925
3926@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3927@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3928@smallexample
3929Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3930You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3931@end smallexample
3932
3933@noindent
3934This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3935only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3936watchpoints it needs to insert.
3937
3938When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3939hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3940
3941@node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3942@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3943@cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3944
3945Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3946which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3947@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3948with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3949
3950One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3951a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3952bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3953constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3954bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3955honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3956first in the bundle.
3957
3958It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3959instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3960a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3961another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3962breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3963printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3964is hit.
3965
3966A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3967that's been subject to address adjustment:
3968
3969@smallexample
3970warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3971@end smallexample
3972
3973Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3974internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3975verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3976desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3977other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3978E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3979instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3980cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3981
3982@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3983adjusted breakpoints:
3984
3985@smallexample
3986warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3987to 0x00010410.
3988@end smallexample
3989
3990When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3991action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3992frequently than expected.
3993
3994@node Continuing and Stepping
3995@section Continuing and Stepping
3996
3997@cindex stepping
3998@cindex continuing
3999@cindex resuming execution
4000@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4001completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4002one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4003line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4004particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4005your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4006it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4007@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4008
4009@table @code
4010@kindex continue
4011@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4012@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4013@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4014@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4015@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4016Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4017any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4018@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4019ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4020@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4021
4022The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4023stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4024@code{continue} is ignored.
4025
4026The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4027debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4028purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4029@code{continue}.
4030@end table
4031
4032To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4033(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4034calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4035Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4036
4037A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4038(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4039beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4040is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4041and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4042interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4043
4044@table @code
4045@kindex step
4046@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4047@item step
4048Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4049line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4050abbreviated @code{s}.
4051
4052@quotation
4053@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4054@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4055@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4056@c distinction here.
4057@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4058within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4059execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4060debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4061is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4062without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4063below.
4064@end quotation
4065
4066The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4067line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4068@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4069to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4070the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4071called within the line.
4072
4073Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4074number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4075@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4076on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4077was any debugging information about the routine.
4078
4079@item step @var{count}
4080Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4081breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4082@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4083
4084@kindex next
4085@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4086@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4087Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4088This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4089the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4090control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4091that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4092is abbreviated @code{n}.
4093
4094An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4095
4096
4097@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4098@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4099@c
4100@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4101@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4102@c function are executed without stopping.
4103
4104The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4105source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4106@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4107
4108@kindex set step-mode
4109@item set step-mode
4110@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4111@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4112@itemx set step-mode on
4113The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4114stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4115information rather than stepping over it.
4116
4117This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4118machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4119want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4120
4121@item set step-mode off
4122Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4123debug information. This is the default.
4124
4125@item show step-mode
4126Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4127source line debug information.
4128
4129@kindex finish
4130@kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4131@item finish
4132Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4133returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4134abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4135
4136Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4137,Returning from a Function}).
4138
4139@kindex until
4140@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4141@cindex run until specified location
4142@item until
4143@itemx u
4144Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4145current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4146stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4147command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4148automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4149than the address of the jump.
4150
4151This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4152though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4153exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4154simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4155through the next iteration.
4156
4157@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4158stack frame.
4159
4160@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4161of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4162example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4163(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4164@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4165
4166@smallexample
4167(@value{GDBP}) f
4168#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4169206 expand_input();
4170(@value{GDBP}) until
4171195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4172@end smallexample
4173
4174This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4175generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4176start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4177written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4178to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4179expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4180statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4181
4182@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4183instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4184argument.
4185
4186@item until @var{location}
4187@itemx u @var{location}
4188Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4189reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4190the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4191This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4192hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4193location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4194implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4195invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4196line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4197line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4198invocations have returned.
4199
4200@smallexample
420194 int factorial (int value)
420295 @{
420396 if (value > 1) @{
420497 value *= factorial (value - 1);
420598 @}
420699 return (value);
4207100 @}
4208@end smallexample
4209
4210
4211@kindex advance @var{location}
4212@itemx advance @var{location}
4213Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4214required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4215@ref{Specify Location}.
4216Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4217frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4218not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4219have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4220
4221
4222@kindex stepi
4223@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4224@item stepi
4225@itemx stepi @var{arg}
4226@itemx si
4227Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4228
4229It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4230instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4231instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4232Display,, Automatic Display}.
4233
4234An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4235
4236@need 750
4237@kindex nexti
4238@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4239@item nexti
4240@itemx nexti @var{arg}
4241@itemx ni
4242Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4243proceed until the function returns.
4244
4245An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4246@end table
4247
4248@node Signals
4249@section Signals
4250@cindex signals
4251
4252A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4253operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4254kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4255signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4256@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4257memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4258the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4259requested an alarm).
4260
4261@cindex fatal signals
4262Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4263functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4264errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4265program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4266@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4267fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4268
4269@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4270program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4271signal.
4272
4273@cindex handling signals
4274Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4275@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4276(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4277but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4278You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4279
4280@table @code
4281@kindex info signals
4282@kindex info handle
4283@item info signals
4284@itemx info handle
4285Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4286handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4287the defined types of signals.
4288
4289@item info signals @var{sig}
4290Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4291
4292@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4293
4294@kindex handle
4295@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4296Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4297can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4298@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4299@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4300known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4301say what change to make.
4302@end table
4303
4304@c @group
4305The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4306Their full names are:
4307
4308@table @code
4309@item nostop
4310@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4311still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4312
4313@item stop
4314@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4315the @code{print} keyword as well.
4316
4317@item print
4318@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4319
4320@item noprint
4321@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4322implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4323
4324@item pass
4325@itemx noignore
4326@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4327can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4328and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4329
4330@item nopass
4331@itemx ignore
4332@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4333@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4334@end table
4335@c @end group
4336
4337When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4338program until you
4339continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4340effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4341after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4342command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4343program sees that signal when you continue.
4344
4345The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4346non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4347@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4348erroneous signals.
4349
4350You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4351seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4352or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4353due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4354values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4355execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4356a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4357you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4358Program a Signal}.
4359
4360@node Thread Stops
4361@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4362
4363When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4364Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4365breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4366
4367@table @code
4368@cindex breakpoints and threads
4369@cindex thread breakpoints
4370@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4371@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4372@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4373@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4374writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4375specify some source line.
4376
4377Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4378to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4379particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4380numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4381column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4382
4383If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4384breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4385program.
4386
4387You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4388well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4389breakpoint condition, like this:
4390
4391@smallexample
4392(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4393@end smallexample
4394
4395@end table
4396
4397@cindex stopped threads
4398@cindex threads, stopped
4399Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4400@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4401allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4402switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4403underfoot.
4404
4405@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4406@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4407@cindex premature return from system calls
4408There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4409breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4410system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4411consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4412that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4413stop execution.
4414
4415To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4416each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4417style anyways.
4418
4419For example, do not write code like this:
4420
4421@smallexample
4422 sleep (10);
4423@end smallexample
4424
4425The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4426at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4427
4428Instead, write this:
4429
4430@smallexample
4431 int unslept = 10;
4432 while (unslept > 0)
4433 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4434@end smallexample
4435
4436A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4437conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4438multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4439@value{GDBN}.
4440
4441Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4442monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4443When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4444prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4445
4446@cindex continuing threads
4447@cindex threads, continuing
4448Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4449executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4450like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4451
4452In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4453Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4454system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4455execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4456single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4457statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4458stops.
4459
4460You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4461continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4462thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4463first thread completes whatever you requested.
4464
4465On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4466thread to run.
4467
4468@table @code
4469@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4470@cindex scheduler locking mode
4471@cindex lock scheduler
4472Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4473locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4474current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4475mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4476``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4477stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4478when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4479function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4480like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4481thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4482@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4483
4484@item show scheduler-locking
4485Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4486@end table
4487
4488
4489@node Stack
4490@chapter Examining the Stack
4491
4492When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4493stopped and how it got there.
4494
4495@cindex call stack
4496Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4497is generated.
4498That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4499the arguments of the call,
4500and the local variables of the function being called.
4501The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4502The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4503stack}.
4504
4505When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4506stack allow you to see all of this information.
4507
4508@cindex selected frame
4509One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4510@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4511particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4512your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4513special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4514interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4515
4516When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4517currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4518@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4519
4520@menu
4521* Frames:: Stack frames
4522* Backtrace:: Backtraces
4523* Selection:: Selecting a frame
4524* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4525
4526@end menu
4527
4528@node Frames
4529@section Stack Frames
4530
4531@cindex frame, definition
4532@cindex stack frame
4533The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4534frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4535with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4536to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4537which the function is executing.
4538
4539@cindex initial frame
4540@cindex outermost frame
4541@cindex innermost frame
4542When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4543function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4544@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4545made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4546is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4547the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4548actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4549recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4550
4551@cindex frame pointer
4552Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4553stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4554kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4555address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4556in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4557(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4558
4559@cindex frame number
4560@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4561zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4562and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4563they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4564frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4565
4566@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4567@c underflow problems.
4568@cindex frameless execution
4569Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4570without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4571@smallexample
4572@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4573@end smallexample
4574generates functions without a frame.)
4575This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4576the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4577with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4578has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4579it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4580correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4581no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4582
4583@table @code
4584@kindex frame@r{, command}
4585@cindex current stack frame
4586@item frame @var{args}
4587The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4588and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4589address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4590@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4591
4592@kindex select-frame
4593@cindex selecting frame silently
4594@item select-frame
4595The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4596to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4597@code{frame}.
4598@end table
4599
4600@node Backtrace
4601@section Backtraces
4602
4603@cindex traceback
4604@cindex call stack traces
4605A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4606line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4607frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4608stack.
4609
4610@table @code
4611@kindex backtrace
4612@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4613@item backtrace
4614@itemx bt
4615Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4616frames in the stack.
4617
4618You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4619character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4620
4621@item backtrace @var{n}
4622@itemx bt @var{n}
4623Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4624
4625@item backtrace -@var{n}
4626@itemx bt -@var{n}
4627Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4628
4629@item backtrace full
4630@itemx bt full
4631@itemx bt full @var{n}
4632@itemx bt full -@var{n}
4633Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4634number of frames to print, as described above.
4635@end table
4636
4637@kindex where
4638@kindex info stack
4639The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4640are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4641
4642@cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4643In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4644backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4645several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4646(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4647apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4648the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4649multi-threaded program.
4650
4651Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4652The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4653print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4654line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4655counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4656line number.
4657
4658Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4659@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4660
4661@smallexample
4662@group
4663#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4664 at builtin.c:993
4665#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4666#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4667 at macro.c:71
4668(More stack frames follow...)
4669@end group
4670@end smallexample
4671
4672@noindent
4673The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4674value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4675code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4676
4677@cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4678@cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4679If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4680optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4681never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4682passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4683in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4684arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4685such a backtrace might look like:
4686
4687@smallexample
4688@group
4689#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4690 at builtin.c:993
4691#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4692#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4693 at macro.c:71
4694(More stack frames follow...)
4695@end group
4696@end smallexample
4697
4698@noindent
4699The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4700shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4701
4702If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4703either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4704you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4705
4706@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4707@cindex program entry point
4708@cindex startup code, and backtrace
4709Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4710libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4711@code{main}@footnote{
4712Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4713environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4714entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4715When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4716it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4717system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4718
4719If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4720in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4721
4722@table @code
4723@item set backtrace past-main
4724@itemx set backtrace past-main on
4725@kindex set backtrace
4726Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4727
4728@item set backtrace past-main off
4729Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4730default.
4731
4732@item show backtrace past-main
4733@kindex show backtrace
4734Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4735
4736@item set backtrace past-entry
4737@itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4738Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4739This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4740and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4741
4742@item set backtrace past-entry off
4743Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4744application. This is the default.
4745
4746@item show backtrace past-entry
4747Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4748
4749@item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4750@itemx set backtrace limit 0
4751@cindex backtrace limit
4752Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4753unlimited.
4754
4755@item show backtrace limit
4756Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4757@end table
4758
4759@node Selection
4760@section Selecting a Frame
4761
4762Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4763whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4764selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4765of the stack frame just selected.
4766
4767@table @code
4768@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4769@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4770@item frame @var{n}
4771@itemx f @var{n}
4772Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4773(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4774innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4775@code{main}.
4776
4777@item frame @var{addr}
4778@itemx f @var{addr}
4779Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4780chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4781impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4782addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4783switches between them.
4784
4785On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4786select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4787
4788On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4789pointer and a program counter.
4790
4791On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4792pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4793
4794@kindex up
4795@item up @var{n}
4796Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4797advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4798that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4799
4800@kindex down
4801@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4802@item down @var{n}
4803Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4804advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4805that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4806abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4807@end table
4808
4809All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4810frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4811arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4812frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4813
4814@need 1000
4815For example:
4816
4817@smallexample
4818@group
4819(@value{GDBP}) up
4820#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4821 at env.c:10
482210 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4823@end group
4824@end smallexample
4825
4826After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4827prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4828You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4829editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4830@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4831for details.
4832
4833@table @code
4834@kindex down-silently
4835@kindex up-silently
4836@item up-silently @var{n}
4837@itemx down-silently @var{n}
4838These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4839respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4840causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4841in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4842distracting.
4843@end table
4844
4845@node Frame Info
4846@section Information About a Frame
4847
4848There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4849stack frame.
4850
4851@table @code
4852@item frame
4853@itemx f
4854When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4855frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4856selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4857argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4858@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4859
4860@kindex info frame
4861@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4862@item info frame
4863@itemx info f
4864This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4865including:
4866
4867@itemize @bullet
4868@item
4869the address of the frame
4870@item
4871the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4872@item
4873the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4874@item
4875the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4876@item
4877the address of the frame's arguments
4878@item
4879the address of the frame's local variables
4880@item
4881the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4882@item
4883which registers were saved in the frame
4884@end itemize
4885
4886@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4887something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4888the usual conventions.
4889
4890@item info frame @var{addr}
4891@itemx info f @var{addr}
4892Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4893selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4894command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4895architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4896@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4897
4898@kindex info args
4899@item info args
4900Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4901
4902@item info locals
4903@kindex info locals
4904Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4905line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4906accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4907
4908@kindex info catch
4909@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4910@cindex exception handlers, how to list
4911@item info catch
4912Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4913current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4914exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4915@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4916@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4917
4918@end table
4919
4920
4921@node Source
4922@chapter Examining Source Files
4923
4924@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4925information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4926used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4927the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4928(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4929execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4930source files by explicit command.
4931
4932If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4933prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4934@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4935
4936@menu
4937* List:: Printing source lines
4938* Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
4939* Edit:: Editing source files
4940* Search:: Searching source files
4941* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4942* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4943@end menu
4944
4945@node List
4946@section Printing Source Lines
4947
4948@kindex list
4949@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4950To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4951(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4952There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
4953print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
4954
4955Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4956
4957@table @code
4958@item list @var{linenum}
4959Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4960current source file.
4961
4962@item list @var{function}
4963Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4964@var{function}.
4965
4966@item list
4967Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4968@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4969printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4970as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4971Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4972
4973@item list -
4974Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4975@end table
4976
4977@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4978By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4979the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4980
4981@table @code
4982@kindex set listsize
4983@item set listsize @var{count}
4984Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4985the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4986
4987@kindex show listsize
4988@item show listsize
4989Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4990@end table
4991
4992Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4993so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4994than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4995argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4996each repetition moves up in the source file.
4997
4998In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4999@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5000of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5001to specify some source line.
5002
5003Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5004
5005@table @code
5006@item list @var{linespec}
5007Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5008
5009@item list @var{first},@var{last}
5010Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5011linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5012source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5013the same source file as the first linespec.
5014
5015@item list ,@var{last}
5016Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5017
5018@item list @var{first},
5019Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5020
5021@item list +
5022Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5023
5024@item list -
5025Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5026
5027@item list
5028As described in the preceding table.
5029@end table
5030
5031@node Specify Location
5032@section Specifying a Location
5033@cindex specifying location
5034@cindex linespec
5035
5036Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5037of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5038debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5039for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5040
5041Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5042@value{GDBN} understands:
5043
5044@table @code
5045@item @var{linenum}
5046Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5047
5048@item -@var{offset}
5049@itemx +@var{offset}
5050Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5051line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5052printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5053execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5054(@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5055used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5056this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5057linespec.
5058
5059@item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5060Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5061
5062@item @var{function}
5063Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5064For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5065
5066@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5067Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5068in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5069function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5070functions in different source files.
5071
5072@item *@var{address}
5073Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5074commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5075line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5076breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5077parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5078source files.
5079
5080Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5081language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5082address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5083semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5084that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5085of @var{address}:
5086
5087@table @code
5088@item @var{expression}
5089Any expression valid in the current working language.
5090
5091@item @var{funcaddr}
5092An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5093C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5094simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5095of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5096@code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5097(although the Pascal form also works).
5098
5099This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5100before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5101
5102@item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5103Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5104file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5105specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5106functions with identical names in different source files.
5107@end table
5108
5109@end table
5110
5111
5112@node Edit
5113@section Editing Source Files
5114@cindex editing source files
5115
5116@kindex edit
5117@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5118To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5119The editing program of your choice
5120is invoked with the current line set to
5121the active line in the program.
5122Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5123want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5124
5125@table @code
5126@item edit @var{location}
5127Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5128that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5129specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5130of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5131command most commonly used:
5132
5133@table @code
5134@item edit @var{number}
5135Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5136
5137@item edit @var{function}
5138Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5139@end table
5140
5141@end table
5142
5143@subsection Choosing your Editor
5144You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5145@footnote{
5146The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5147following command-line syntax:
5148@smallexample
5149ex +@var{number} file
5150@end smallexample
5151The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5152the file where to start editing.}.
5153By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5154by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5155@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5156@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5157@smallexample
5158EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5159export EDITOR
5160gdb @dots{}
5161@end smallexample
5162or in the @code{csh} shell,
5163@smallexample
5164setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5165gdb @dots{}
5166@end smallexample
5167
5168@node Search
5169@section Searching Source Files
5170@cindex searching source files
5171
5172There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5173regular expression.
5174
5175@table @code
5176@kindex search
5177@kindex forward-search
5178@item forward-search @var{regexp}
5179@itemx search @var{regexp}
5180The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5181starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5182@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5183synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5184@code{fo}.
5185
5186@kindex reverse-search
5187@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5188The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5189with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5190for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5191this command as @code{rev}.
5192@end table
5193
5194@node Source Path
5195@section Specifying Source Directories
5196
5197@cindex source path
5198@cindex directories for source files
5199Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5200files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5201the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5202session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5203this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5204it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5205in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5206
5207For example, suppose an executable references the file
5208@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5209@file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5210fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5211fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5212message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5213source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5214Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5215the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5216@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5217@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5218
5219Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5220names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5221instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5222is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5223@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5224that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5225
5226Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5227source files.
5228
5229Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5230any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5231each line is in the file.
5232
5233@kindex directory
5234@kindex dir
5235When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5236and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5237To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5238
5239The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5240script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5241
5242In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5243that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5244rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5245debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5246directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5247two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5248the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5249In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5250@var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5251of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5252source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5253name to look up the sources.
5254
5255Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5256moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5257@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5258@file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5259@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5260of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5261substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5262(@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5263
5264To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5265@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5266For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5267@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5268not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5269is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5270not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5271
5272In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5273command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5274the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5275subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5276subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5277preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5278allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5279command.
5280
5281@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5282The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5283longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5284the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5285for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5286located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5287method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5288
5289@table @code
5290@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5291@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5292Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5293directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5294(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5295part of absolute file names) or
5296whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5297path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5298
5299@kindex cdir
5300@kindex cwd
5301@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5302@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5303@cindex compilation directory
5304@cindex current directory
5305@cindex working directory
5306@cindex directory, current
5307@cindex directory, compilation
5308You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5309directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5310working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5311tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5312session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5313directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5314
5315@item directory
5316Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5317
5318@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5319@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5320
5321@item show directories
5322@kindex show directories
5323Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5324
5325@anchor{set substitute-path}
5326@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5327@kindex set substitute-path
5328Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5329current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5330@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5331
5332For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5333@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5334
5335@smallexample
5336(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5337@end smallexample
5338
5339@noindent
5340will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5341@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5342@file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5343
5344In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5345the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5346defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5347the substitution.
5348
5349For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5350
5351@smallexample
5352(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5353(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5354@end smallexample
5355
5356@noindent
5357@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5358@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5359use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5360@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5361
5362
5363@item unset substitute-path [path]
5364@kindex unset substitute-path
5365If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5366for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5367A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5368
5369If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5370
5371@item show substitute-path [path]
5372@kindex show substitute-path
5373If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5374which would rewrite that path, if any.
5375
5376If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5377rules.
5378
5379@end table
5380
5381If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5382interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5383versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5384
5385@enumerate
5386@item
5387Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5388
5389@item
5390Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5391directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5392directories in one command.
5393@end enumerate
5394
5395@node Machine Code
5396@section Source and Machine Code
5397@cindex source line and its code address
5398
5399You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5400addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5401a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5402mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5403line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5404well as hex.
5405
5406@table @code
5407@kindex info line
5408@item info line @var{linespec}
5409Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5410source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5411the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5412@end table
5413
5414For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5415the object code for the first line of function
5416@code{m4_changequote}:
5417
5418@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5419@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5420@smallexample
5421(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5422Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5423@end smallexample
5424
5425@noindent
5426@cindex code address and its source line
5427We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5428@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5429@smallexample
5430(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5431Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5432@end smallexample
5433
5434@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5435@cindex @code{x} command, default address
5436@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5437After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5438is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5439sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5440,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5441convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5442Variables}).
5443
5444@table @code
5445@kindex disassemble
5446@cindex assembly instructions
5447@cindex instructions, assembly
5448@cindex machine instructions
5449@cindex listing machine instructions
5450@item disassemble
5451@itemx disassemble /m
5452This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5453instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
5454the @code{/m} modifier.
5455The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5456program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5457command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5458surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5459(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5460@end table
5461
5462The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5463HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5464
5465@smallexample
5466(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5467Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
54680x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
54690x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
54700x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
54710x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
54720x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
54730x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
54740x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
54750x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5476End of assembler dump.
5477@end smallexample
5478
5479Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
5480
5481@smallexample
5482(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
5483Dump of assembler code for function main:
54845 @{
54850x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
54860x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
54870x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
54880x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
54890x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
5490
54916 printf ("Hello.\n");
54920x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
54930x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
5494
54957 return 0;
54968 @}
54970x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
54980x0804834d <main+29>: leave
54990x0804834e <main+30>: ret
5500
5501End of assembler dump.
5502@end smallexample
5503
5504Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5505mnemonics or other syntax.
5506
5507For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5508instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5509libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5510location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5511might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5512
5513@table @code
5514@kindex set disassembly-flavor
5515@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5516@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5517@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5518Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5519program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5520
5521Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5522can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5523The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5524assemblers for x86-based targets.
5525
5526@kindex show disassembly-flavor
5527@item show disassembly-flavor
5528Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5529@end table
5530
5531
5532@node Data
5533@chapter Examining Data
5534
5535@cindex printing data
5536@cindex examining data
5537@kindex print
5538@kindex inspect
5539@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5540@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5541@c different window or something like that.
5542The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5543command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5544evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5545program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5546Different Languages}).
5547
5548@table @code
5549@item print @var{expr}
5550@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5551@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5552value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5553you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5554@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5555Formats}.
5556
5557@item print
5558@itemx print /@var{f}
5559@cindex reprint the last value
5560If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5561@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5562conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5563@end table
5564
5565A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5566It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5567specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5568
5569If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5570fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5571command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5572Table}.
5573
5574@menu
5575* Expressions:: Expressions
5576* Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
5577* Variables:: Program variables
5578* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5579* Output Formats:: Output formats
5580* Memory:: Examining memory
5581* Auto Display:: Automatic display
5582* Print Settings:: Print settings
5583* Value History:: Value history
5584* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5585* Registers:: Registers
5586* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5587* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5588* OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5589* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5590* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5591* Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5592* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5593 character set than GDB does
5594* Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5595* Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
5596@end menu
5597
5598@node Expressions
5599@section Expressions
5600
5601@cindex expressions
5602@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5603compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5604by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5605@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5606casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5607you compiled your program to include this information; see
5608@ref{Compilation}.
5609
5610@cindex arrays in expressions
5611@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5612the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5613you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
5614of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
5615to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
5616is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5617
5618Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5619this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5620Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5621languages.
5622
5623In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5624expressions regardless of your programming language.
5625
5626@cindex casts, in expressions
5627Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5628useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5629at that address in memory.
5630@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5631
5632@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5633to programming languages:
5634
5635@table @code
5636@item @@
5637@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5638@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5639
5640@item ::
5641@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5642function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5643
5644@cindex @{@var{type}@}
5645@cindex type casting memory
5646@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5647@cindex casts, to view memory
5648@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5649Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5650memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5651pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5652a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5653normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5654@end table
5655
5656@node Ambiguous Expressions
5657@section Ambiguous Expressions
5658@cindex ambiguous expressions
5659
5660Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
5661some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
5662a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
5663different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
5664involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
5665templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
5666the same function name being defined in different contexts.
5667
5668In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
5669the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
5670can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
5671@kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
5672qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
5673as well.
5674
5675When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
5676has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
5677possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
5678The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
5679aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
5680used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
5681menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
5682choices.
5683
5684For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
5685breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
5686We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
5687
5688@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
5689@smallexample
5690@group
5691(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
5692[0] cancel
5693[1] all
5694[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
5695[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
5696[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
5697[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
5698[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
5699[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
5700> 2 4 6
5701Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
5702Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
5703Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
5704Multiple breakpoints were set.
5705Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
5706 breakpoints.
5707(@value{GDBP})
5708@end group
5709@end smallexample
5710
5711@table @code
5712@kindex set multiple-symbols
5713@item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
5714@cindex multiple-symbols menu
5715
5716This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
5717is ambiguous.
5718
5719By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
5720the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
5721automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
5722a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
5723inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
5724then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
5725For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
5726in the use of the menu.
5727
5728When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
5729when an ambiguity is detected.
5730
5731Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
5732an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
5733
5734@kindex show multiple-symbols
5735@item show multiple-symbols
5736Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
5737@end table
5738
5739@node Variables
5740@section Program Variables
5741
5742The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5743in your program.
5744
5745Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5746(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5747
5748@itemize @bullet
5749@item
5750global (or file-static)
5751@end itemize
5752
5753@noindent or
5754
5755@itemize @bullet
5756@item
5757visible according to the scope rules of the
5758programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5759@end itemize
5760
5761@noindent This means that in the function
5762
5763@smallexample
5764foo (a)
5765 int a;
5766@{
5767 bar (a);
5768 @{
5769 int b = test ();
5770 bar (b);
5771 @}
5772@}
5773@end smallexample
5774
5775@noindent
5776you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5777executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5778examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5779the block where @code{b} is declared.
5780
5781@cindex variable name conflict
5782There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5783scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5784in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5785function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5786happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5787you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5788using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5789
5790@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5791@ifnotinfo
5792@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5793@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5794@end ifnotinfo
5795@smallexample
5796@var{file}::@var{variable}
5797@var{function}::@var{variable}
5798@end smallexample
5799
5800@noindent
5801Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5802static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5803make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5804to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5805
5806@smallexample
5807(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5808@end smallexample
5809
5810@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5811This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5812use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5813scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5814@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5815@c conflict?? --mew
5816
5817@cindex wrong values
5818@cindex variable values, wrong
5819@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5820@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5821@quotation
5822@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5823wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5824scope, and just before exit.
5825@end quotation
5826You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5827This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5828set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5829stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5830values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5831also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5832after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5833variable definitions may be gone.
5834
5835This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5836To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5837when compiling.
5838
5839@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5840Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5841unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5842opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5843offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5844might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5845happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5846
5847@smallexample
5848No symbol "foo" in current context.
5849@end smallexample
5850
5851To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5852different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5853formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5854usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5855produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5856COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5857an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5858for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5859Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5860@xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5861that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5862
5863If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5864@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5865by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5866type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5867
5868Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5869signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5870printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5871@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5872defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5873For program code
5874
5875@smallexample
5876char var0[] = "A";
5877signed char var1[] = "A";
5878@end smallexample
5879
5880You get during debugging
5881@smallexample
5882(gdb) print var0
5883$1 = "A"
5884(gdb) print var1
5885$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5886@end smallexample
5887
5888@node Arrays
5889@section Artificial Arrays
5890
5891@cindex artificial array
5892@cindex arrays
5893@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5894It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5895same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5896dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5897program.
5898
5899You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5900@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5901operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5902and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5903of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5904the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5905argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5906following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5907example. If a program says
5908
5909@smallexample
5910int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5911@end smallexample
5912
5913@noindent
5914you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5915
5916@smallexample
5917p *array@@len
5918@end smallexample
5919
5920The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5921with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5922subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5923Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5924(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5925
5926Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5927This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5928The value need not be in memory:
5929@smallexample
5930(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5931$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5932@end smallexample
5933
5934As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5935@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5936the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5937@smallexample
5938(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5939$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5940@end smallexample
5941
5942Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5943moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5944actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5945of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5946to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5947Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5948interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5949instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5950structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5951in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5952
5953@smallexample
5954set $i = 0
5955p dtab[$i++]->fv
5956@key{RET}
5957@key{RET}
5958@dots{}
5959@end smallexample
5960
5961@node Output Formats
5962@section Output Formats
5963
5964@cindex formatted output
5965@cindex output formats
5966By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5967this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5968in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5969at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5970these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5971
5972The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5973already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5974@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5975letters supported are:
5976
5977@table @code
5978@item x
5979Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5980hexadecimal.
5981
5982@item d
5983Print as integer in signed decimal.
5984
5985@item u
5986Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5987
5988@item o
5989Print as integer in octal.
5990
5991@item t
5992Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5993@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5994used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5995see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5996
5997@item a
5998@cindex unknown address, locating
5999@cindex locate address
6000Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6001the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6002where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6003
6004@smallexample
6005(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6006$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6007@end smallexample
6008
6009@noindent
6010The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6011@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6012
6013@item c
6014Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6015prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6016character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6017for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6018
6019Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6020@w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6021constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6022data.
6023
6024@item f
6025Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6026using typical floating point syntax.
6027
6028@item s
6029@cindex printing strings
6030@cindex printing byte arrays
6031Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6032data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6033are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6034natural types.
6035
6036Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6037@code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6038strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6039array.
6040@end table
6041
6042For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6043
6044@smallexample
6045p/x $pc
6046@end smallexample
6047
6048@noindent
6049Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6050names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6051
6052To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6053you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6054expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6055
6056@node Memory
6057@section Examining Memory
6058
6059You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6060any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6061
6062@cindex examining memory
6063@table @code
6064@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6065@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6066@itemx x @var{addr}
6067@itemx x
6068Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6069@end table
6070
6071@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6072much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6073expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6074If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6075Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6076
6077@table @r
6078@item @var{n}, the repeat count
6079The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6080how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6081@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6082@c 4.1.2.
6083
6084@item @var{f}, the display format
6085The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6086(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6087@samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6088The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6089each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6090
6091@item @var{u}, the unit size
6092The unit size is any of
6093
6094@table @code
6095@item b
6096Bytes.
6097@item h
6098Halfwords (two bytes).
6099@item w
6100Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6101@item g
6102Giant words (eight bytes).
6103@end table
6104
6105Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6106default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6107@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6108
6109@item @var{addr}, starting display address
6110@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6111memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6112it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6113@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6114@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6115other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6116the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6117starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6118a value from memory).
6119@end table
6120
6121For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6122(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6123starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6124words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6125@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6126
6127Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6128letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6129unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6130specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6131(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6132
6133Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6134and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6135@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6136including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6137the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6138slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6139follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6140@code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6141instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6142
6143All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6144easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6145you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6146instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6147with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6148the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6149for successive uses of @code{x}.
6150
6151@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6152The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6153in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6154would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6155subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6156@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6157examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6158@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6159the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6160
6161If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6162are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6163address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6164
6165@cindex remote memory comparison
6166@cindex verify remote memory image
6167When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6168(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6169remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6170the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6171situations.
6172
6173@table @code
6174@kindex compare-sections
6175@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6176Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6177executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6178the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6179arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6180availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6181remote request.
6182@end table
6183
6184@node Auto Display
6185@section Automatic Display
6186@cindex automatic display
6187@cindex display of expressions
6188
6189If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6190(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6191display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6192Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6193to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6194The automatic display looks like this:
6195
6196@smallexample
61972: foo = 38
61983: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6199@end smallexample
6200
6201@noindent
6202This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6203displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6204specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6205whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6206specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6207or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6208
6209@table @code
6210@kindex display
6211@item display @var{expr}
6212Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6213each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6214
6215@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6216
6217@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6218For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6219count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6220arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6221@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6222
6223@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6224For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6225number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6226be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6227doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6228@end table
6229
6230For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6231instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6232is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6233
6234@table @code
6235@kindex delete display
6236@kindex undisplay
6237@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6238@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6239Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6240
6241@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6242(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6243
6244@kindex disable display
6245@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6246Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6247item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6248enabled again later.
6249
6250@kindex enable display
6251@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6252Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6253again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6254
6255@item display
6256Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6257done when your program stops.
6258
6259@kindex info display
6260@item info display
6261Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6262automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6263values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6264It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6265because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6266@end table
6267
6268@cindex display disabled out of scope
6269If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6270sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6271expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6272variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6273@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6274@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6275continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6276there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6277automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6278is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6279
6280@node Print Settings
6281@section Print Settings
6282
6283@cindex format options
6284@cindex print settings
6285@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6286and symbols are printed.
6287
6288@noindent
6289These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6290
6291@table @code
6292@kindex set print
6293@item set print address
6294@itemx set print address on
6295@cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6296@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6297traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6298even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6299is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6300@code{set print address on}:
6301
6302@smallexample
6303@group
6304(@value{GDBP}) f
6305#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6306 at input.c:530
6307530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6308@end group
6309@end smallexample
6310
6311@item set print address off
6312Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6313this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6314
6315@smallexample
6316@group
6317(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6318(@value{GDBP}) f
6319#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6320530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6321@end group
6322@end smallexample
6323
6324You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6325dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6326@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6327all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6328
6329@kindex show print
6330@item show print address
6331Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6332@end table
6333
6334When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6335closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6336identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6337source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6338@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6339you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6340it prints a symbolic address:
6341
6342@table @code
6343@item set print symbol-filename on
6344@cindex source file and line of a symbol
6345@cindex symbol, source file and line
6346Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6347symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6348
6349@item set print symbol-filename off
6350Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6351default.
6352
6353@item show print symbol-filename
6354Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6355line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6356@end table
6357
6358Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6359numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6360number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6361
6362Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6363printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6364
6365@table @code
6366@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6367@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6368Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6369offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6370@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6371to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6372
6373@item show print max-symbolic-offset
6374Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6375symbolic address.
6376@end table
6377
6378@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6379@cindex pointer, finding referent
6380If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6381@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6382and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6383@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6384For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6385at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6386
6387@smallexample
6388(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6389(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6390$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6391@end smallexample
6392
6393@quotation
6394@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6395does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6396the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6397@end quotation
6398
6399Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6400
6401@table @code
6402@item set print array
6403@itemx set print array on
6404@cindex pretty print arrays
6405Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6406but uses more space. The default is off.
6407
6408@item set print array off
6409Return to compressed format for arrays.
6410
6411@item show print array
6412Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6413arrays.
6414
6415@cindex print array indexes
6416@item set print array-indexes
6417@itemx set print array-indexes on
6418Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6419convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6420index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6421
6422@item set print array-indexes off
6423Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6424
6425@item show print array-indexes
6426Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6427arrays.
6428
6429@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6430@cindex number of array elements to print
6431@cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6432Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6433If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6434printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6435This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6436When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6437Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6438
6439@item show print elements
6440Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6441If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6442
6443@item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6444@cindex printing frame argument values
6445@cindex print all frame argument values
6446@cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6447@cindex do not print frame argument values
6448This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6449when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6450values are:
6451
6452@table @code
6453@item all
6454The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6455
6456@item scalars
6457Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6458complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6459by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6460
6461@smallexample
6462#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6463 at frame-args.c:23
6464@end smallexample
6465
6466@item none
6467None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6468is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6469
6470@smallexample
6471#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6472 at frame-args.c:23
6473@end smallexample
6474@end table
6475
6476By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6477can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6478the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6479more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6480when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6481can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6482Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6483avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6484
6485@item show print frame-arguments
6486Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6487
6488@item set print repeats
6489@cindex repeated array elements
6490Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6491elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6492array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6493@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6494identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6495themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6496be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6497
6498@item show print repeats
6499Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6500elements.
6501
6502@item set print null-stop
6503@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6504Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6505@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6506contain only short strings.
6507The default is off.
6508
6509@item show print null-stop
6510Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6511@sc{null} character.
6512
6513@item set print pretty on
6514@cindex print structures in indented form
6515@cindex indentation in structure display
6516Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6517per line, like this:
6518
6519@smallexample
6520@group
6521$1 = @{
6522 next = 0x0,
6523 flags = @{
6524 sweet = 1,
6525 sour = 1
6526 @},
6527 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6528@}
6529@end group
6530@end smallexample
6531
6532@item set print pretty off
6533Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6534
6535@smallexample
6536@group
6537$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6538meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6539@end group
6540@end smallexample
6541
6542@noindent
6543This is the default format.
6544
6545@item show print pretty
6546Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6547
6548@item set print sevenbit-strings on
6549@cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6550@cindex octal escapes in strings
6551Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6552@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6553character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6554best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6555high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6556
6557@item set print sevenbit-strings off
6558Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6559international character sets, and is the default.
6560
6561@item show print sevenbit-strings
6562Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6563
6564@item set print union on
6565@cindex unions in structures, printing
6566Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6567and other unions. This is the default setting.
6568
6569@item set print union off
6570Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6571structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6572instead.
6573
6574@item show print union
6575Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6576structures and other unions.
6577
6578For example, given the declarations
6579
6580@smallexample
6581typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6582typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6583typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6584 Bug_forms;
6585
6586struct thing @{
6587 Species it;
6588 union @{
6589 Tree_forms tree;
6590 Bug_forms bug;
6591 @} form;
6592@};
6593
6594struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6595@end smallexample
6596
6597@noindent
6598with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6599
6600@smallexample
6601$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6602@end smallexample
6603
6604@noindent
6605and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6606
6607@smallexample
6608$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6609@end smallexample
6610
6611@noindent
6612@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6613and in Pascal.
6614@end table
6615
6616@need 1000
6617@noindent
6618These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6619
6620@table @code
6621@cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6622@item set print demangle
6623@itemx set print demangle on
6624Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6625(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6626linkage. The default is on.
6627
6628@item show print demangle
6629Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6630
6631@item set print asm-demangle
6632@itemx set print asm-demangle on
6633Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6634in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6635The default is off.
6636
6637@item show print asm-demangle
6638Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6639or demangled form.
6640
6641@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6642@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6643@kindex set demangle-style
6644@item set demangle-style @var{style}
6645Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6646represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6647
6648@table @code
6649@item auto
6650Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6651
6652@item gnu
6653Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6654This is the default.
6655
6656@item hp
6657Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6658
6659@item lucid
6660Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6661
6662@item arm
6663Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6664@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6665debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6666require further enhancement to permit that.
6667
6668@end table
6669If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6670
6671@item show demangle-style
6672Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6673
6674@item set print object
6675@itemx set print object on
6676@cindex derived type of an object, printing
6677@cindex display derived types
6678When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6679(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6680the virtual function table.
6681
6682@item set print object off
6683Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6684virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6685
6686@item show print object
6687Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6688
6689@item set print static-members
6690@itemx set print static-members on
6691@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6692Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6693
6694@item set print static-members off
6695Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6696
6697@item show print static-members
6698Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6699
6700@item set print pascal_static-members
6701@itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6702@cindex static members of Pascal objects
6703@cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6704Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6705
6706@item set print pascal_static-members off
6707Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6708
6709@item show print pascal_static-members
6710Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6711
6712@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6713@item set print vtbl
6714@itemx set print vtbl on
6715@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6716@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6717@cindex VTBL display
6718Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6719(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6720ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6721
6722@item set print vtbl off
6723Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6724
6725@item show print vtbl
6726Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6727@end table
6728
6729@node Value History
6730@section Value History
6731
6732@cindex value history
6733@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6734Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6735@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6736Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6737(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6738When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6739since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6740symbol table.
6741
6742@cindex @code{$}
6743@cindex @code{$$}
6744@cindex history number
6745The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6746refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6747@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6748printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6749history number.
6750
6751To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6752history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6753remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6754the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6755@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6756is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6757@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6758
6759For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6760want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6761
6762@smallexample
6763p *$
6764@end smallexample
6765
6766If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6767to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6768
6769@smallexample
6770p *$.next
6771@end smallexample
6772
6773@noindent
6774You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6775command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6776
6777Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6778@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6779
6780@smallexample
6781print x
6782set x=5
6783@end smallexample
6784
6785@noindent
6786then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6787remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6788
6789@table @code
6790@kindex show values
6791@item show values
6792Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6793This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6794values} does not change the history.
6795
6796@item show values @var{n}
6797Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6798
6799@item show values +
6800Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6801values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6802@end table
6803
6804Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6805same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6806
6807@node Convenience Vars
6808@section Convenience Variables
6809
6810@cindex convenience variables
6811@cindex user-defined variables
6812@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6813@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6814exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6815setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6816of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6817
6818Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6819@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6820the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6821(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6822by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6823
6824You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6825expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6826For example:
6827
6828@smallexample
6829set $foo = *object_ptr
6830@end smallexample
6831
6832@noindent
6833would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6834@code{object_ptr}.
6835
6836Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6837value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6838value with another assignment at any time.
6839
6840Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6841variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6842that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6843variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6844
6845@table @code
6846@kindex show convenience
6847@cindex show all user variables
6848@item show convenience
6849Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6850Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6851
6852@kindex init-if-undefined
6853@cindex convenience variables, initializing
6854@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6855Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6856for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6857to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6858convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6859override default values used in a command script.
6860
6861If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6862any side-effects do not occur.
6863@end table
6864
6865One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6866incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6867a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6868
6869@smallexample
6870set $i = 0
6871print bar[$i++]->contents
6872@end smallexample
6873
6874@noindent
6875Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6876
6877Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6878values likely to be useful.
6879
6880@table @code
6881@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6882@item $_
6883The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6884the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6885commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6886set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6887and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6888except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6889to the type of @code{$__}.
6890
6891@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6892@item $__
6893The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6894to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6895to match the format in which the data was printed.
6896
6897@item $_exitcode
6898@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6899The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6900the program being debugged terminates.
6901@end table
6902
6903On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6904begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6905name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6906
6907@node Registers
6908@section Registers
6909
6910@cindex registers
6911You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6912with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6913for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6914your machine.
6915
6916@table @code
6917@kindex info registers
6918@item info registers
6919Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6920and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6921
6922@kindex info all-registers
6923@cindex floating point registers
6924@item info all-registers
6925Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6926and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6927
6928@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6929Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6930As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6931the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6932the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6933@end table
6934
6935@cindex stack pointer register
6936@cindex program counter register
6937@cindex process status register
6938@cindex frame pointer register
6939@cindex standard registers
6940@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6941expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6942architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6943@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6944the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6945pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6946register that contains the processor status. For example,
6947you could print the program counter in hex with
6948
6949@smallexample
6950p/x $pc
6951@end smallexample
6952
6953@noindent
6954or print the instruction to be executed next with
6955
6956@smallexample
6957x/i $pc
6958@end smallexample
6959
6960@noindent
6961or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6962one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6963memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6964stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6965stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6966regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6967see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6968
6969@smallexample
6970set $sp += 4
6971@end smallexample
6972
6973Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6974your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6975so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6976shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6977registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6978can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6979is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6980
6981@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6982integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6983special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6984registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6985to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6986(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6987@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6988
6989Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6990means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6991the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6992sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6993coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6994programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6995cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6996that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6997prints the data in both formats.
6998
6999@cindex SSE registers (x86)
7000@cindex MMX registers (x86)
7001Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7002in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7003have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7004together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7005registers in @code{struct} notation:
7006
7007@smallexample
7008(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7009$1 = @{
7010 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7011 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7012 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7013 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7014 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7015 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7016 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7017@}
7018@end smallexample
7019
7020@noindent
7021To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7022view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7023value to a @code{struct} member:
7024
7025@smallexample
7026 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7027@end smallexample
7028
7029Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7030(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7031value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7032were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7033true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7034frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7035
7036However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7037code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7038@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7039frame makes no difference.
7040
7041@node Floating Point Hardware
7042@section Floating Point Hardware
7043@cindex floating point
7044
7045Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7046you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7047
7048@table @code
7049@kindex info float
7050@item info float
7051Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7052point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7053floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7054the ARM and x86 machines.
7055@end table
7056
7057@node Vector Unit
7058@section Vector Unit
7059@cindex vector unit
7060
7061Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7062more information about the status of the vector unit.
7063
7064@table @code
7065@kindex info vector
7066@item info vector
7067Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7068layout vary depending on the hardware.
7069@end table
7070
7071@node OS Information
7072@section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7073@cindex OS information
7074
7075@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7076you debug your program.
7077
7078@cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7079@cindex @code{struct user} contents
7080When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7081machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7082system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7083called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7084command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7085structure.
7086
7087@table @code
7088@item info udot
7089@kindex info udot
7090Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7091kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7092contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7093the @code{examine} command.
7094@end table
7095
7096@cindex auxiliary vector
7097@cindex vector, auxiliary
7098Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7099startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7100specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7101binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7102hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7103identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7104Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7105@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7106targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7107support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7108@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7109
7110@table @code
7111@kindex info auxv
7112@item info auxv
7113Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7114live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7115numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7116tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7117pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7118most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7119an unrecognized tag.
7120@end table
7121
7122
7123@node Memory Region Attributes
7124@section Memory Region Attributes
7125@cindex memory region attributes
7126
7127@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7128required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7129attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7130accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7131target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7132fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7133user can override the fetched regions.
7134
7135Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7136memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7137accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7138been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7139all memory.
7140
7141When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7142to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7143
7144@table @code
7145@kindex mem
7146@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7147Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7148attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7149monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7150case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7151(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7152
7153@item mem auto
7154Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7155regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7156
7157@kindex delete mem
7158@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7159Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7160monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7161
7162@kindex disable mem
7163@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7164Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7165A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7166It may be enabled again later.
7167
7168@kindex enable mem
7169@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7170Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7171
7172@kindex info mem
7173@item info mem
7174Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7175for each region:
7176
7177@table @emph
7178@item Memory Region Number
7179@item Enabled or Disabled.
7180Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7181Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7182
7183@item Lo Address
7184The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7185
7186@item Hi Address
7187The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7188
7189@item Attributes
7190The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7191@end table
7192@end table
7193
7194
7195@subsection Attributes
7196
7197@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7198The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7199write accesses to a memory region.
7200
7201While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7202memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7203etc.@: from accessing memory.
7204
7205@table @code
7206@item ro
7207Memory is read only.
7208@item wo
7209Memory is write only.
7210@item rw
7211Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7212@end table
7213
7214@subsubsection Memory Access Size
7215The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7216accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7217require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7218specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7219
7220@table @code
7221@item 8
7222Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7223@item 16
7224Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7225@item 32
7226Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7227@item 64
7228Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7229@end table
7230
7231@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7232@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7233@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7234@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7235@c
7236@c @table @code
7237@c @item hwbreak
7238@c Always use hardware breakpoints
7239@c @item swbreak (default)
7240@c @end table
7241
7242@subsubsection Data Cache
7243The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7244memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7245protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7246does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7247registers.
7248
7249@table @code
7250@item cache
7251Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7252@item nocache
7253Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7254@end table
7255
7256@subsection Memory Access Checking
7257@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7258not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7259regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7260better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7261
7262@table @code
7263@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7264@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7265If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7266explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7267to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7268memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7269treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7270The default value is @code{on}.
7271@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7272@item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7273Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7274@end table
7275
7276
7277@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7278@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7279@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7280@c
7281@c @table @code
7282@c @item verify
7283@c @item noverify (default)
7284@c @end table
7285
7286@node Dump/Restore Files
7287@section Copy Between Memory and a File
7288@cindex dump/restore files
7289@cindex append data to a file
7290@cindex dump data to a file
7291@cindex restore data from a file
7292
7293You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7294@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7295@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7296@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7297memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7298Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7299files.
7300
7301@table @code
7302
7303@kindex dump
7304@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7305@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7306Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7307or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7308
7309The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7310@table @code
7311@item binary
7312Raw binary form.
7313@item ihex
7314Intel hex format.
7315@item srec
7316Motorola S-record format.
7317@item tekhex
7318Tektronix Hex format.
7319@end table
7320
7321@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7322@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7323@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7324form.
7325
7326@kindex append
7327@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7328@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7329Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7330or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7331(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7332
7333@kindex restore
7334@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7335Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7336@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7337file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7338must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7339
7340If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7341contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7342they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7343a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7344from that location.
7345
7346If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7347file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7348These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7349the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7350
7351@end table
7352
7353@node Core File Generation
7354@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7355@cindex dump core from inferior
7356
7357A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7358image of a running process and its process status (register values
7359etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7360crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7361automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7362the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7363the post-mortem debugging mode.
7364
7365Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7366are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7367@value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7368
7369@table @code
7370@kindex gcore
7371@kindex generate-core-file
7372@item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7373@itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7374Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7375@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7376specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7377@var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7378
7379Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7380this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7381@end table
7382
7383@node Character Sets
7384@section Character Sets
7385@cindex character sets
7386@cindex charset
7387@cindex translating between character sets
7388@cindex host character set
7389@cindex target character set
7390
7391If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7392represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7393@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7394you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7395character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7396@dfn{target character set}.
7397
7398For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7399uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7400remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7401running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7402then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7403@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7404target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7405@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7406character and string literals in expressions.
7407
7408@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7409the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7410target-charset} command, described below.
7411
7412Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7413support:
7414
7415@table @code
7416@item set target-charset @var{charset}
7417@kindex set target-charset
7418Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7419character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7420@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7421list the target character sets it supports.
7422@end table
7423
7424@table @code
7425@item set host-charset @var{charset}
7426@kindex set host-charset
7427Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7428
7429By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7430system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7431@code{set host-charset} command.
7432
7433@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7434set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7435indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7436@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7437list the host character sets it supports.
7438
7439@item set charset @var{charset}
7440@kindex set charset
7441Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7442above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7443@value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7444for both host and target.
7445
7446
7447@item show charset
7448@kindex show charset
7449Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7450
7451@itemx show host-charset
7452@kindex show host-charset
7453Show the name of the current host charset.
7454
7455@itemx show target-charset
7456@kindex show target-charset
7457Show the name of the current target charset.
7458
7459@end table
7460
7461@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7462sets:
7463
7464@table @code
7465
7466@item ASCII
7467@cindex ASCII character set
7468Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7469character set.
7470
7471@item ISO-8859-1
7472@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7473@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7474The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7475characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7476this as its host character set.
7477
7478@item EBCDIC-US
7479@itemx IBM1047
7480@cindex EBCDIC character set
7481@cindex IBM1047 character set
7482Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7483mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7484@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7485
7486@end table
7487
7488Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7489@value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7490encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7491
7492Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7493Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7494@file{charset-test.c}:
7495
7496@smallexample
7497#include <stdio.h>
7498
7499char ascii_hello[]
7500 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7501 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7502char ibm1047_hello[]
7503 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7504 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7505
7506main ()
7507@{
7508 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7509@}
7510@end smallexample
7511
7512In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7513containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7514encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7515
7516We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7517
7518@smallexample
7519$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7520$ gdb -nw charset-test
7521GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7522Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7523@dots{}
7524(@value{GDBP})
7525@end smallexample
7526
7527We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7528@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7529strings:
7530
7531@smallexample
7532(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7533The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7534(@value{GDBP})
7535@end smallexample
7536
7537For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7538initial character set:
7539@smallexample
7540(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7541(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7542The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7543(@value{GDBP})
7544@end smallexample
7545
7546Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7547host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7548characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7549them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7550@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7551
7552@smallexample
7553(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7554$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7555(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7556$2 = 72 'H'
7557(@value{GDBP})
7558@end smallexample
7559
7560@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7561literals you use in expressions:
7562
7563@smallexample
7564(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7565$3 = 43 '+'
7566(@value{GDBP})
7567@end smallexample
7568
7569The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7570character.
7571
7572@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7573target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7574character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7575
7576@smallexample
7577(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7578$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7579(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7580$5 = 200 '\310'
7581(@value{GDBP})
7582@end smallexample
7583
7584If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7585@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7586
7587@smallexample
7588(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7589ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7590(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7591@end smallexample
7592
7593We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7594program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7595@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7596target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7597@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7598
7599@smallexample
7600(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7601(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7602The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7603The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7604(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7605$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7606(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7607$7 = 72 '\110'
7608(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7609$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7610(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7611$9 = 200 'H'
7612(@value{GDBP})
7613@end smallexample
7614
7615As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7616string literals you use in expressions:
7617
7618@smallexample
7619(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7620$10 = 78 '+'
7621(@value{GDBP})
7622@end smallexample
7623
7624The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7625character.
7626
7627@node Caching Remote Data
7628@section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7629@cindex caching data of remote targets
7630
7631@value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7632remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7633performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7634bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7635@value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7636registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7637volatile registers are in use.
7638
7639@table @code
7640@kindex set remotecache
7641@item set remotecache on
7642@itemx set remotecache off
7643Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7644caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7645
7646@kindex show remotecache
7647@item show remotecache
7648Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7649
7650@kindex info dcache
7651@item info dcache
7652Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7653information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7654each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7655state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7656the data cache operation.
7657@end table
7658
7659@node Searching Memory
7660@section Search Memory
7661@cindex searching memory
7662
7663Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
7664@code{find} command.
7665
7666@table @code
7667@kindex find
7668@item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
7669@itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
7670Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
7671etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
7672@var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
7673@end table
7674
7675@var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
7676They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
7677
7678@table @r
7679@item @var{s}, search query size
7680The size of each search query value.
7681
7682@table @code
7683@item b
7684bytes
7685@item h
7686halfwords (two bytes)
7687@item w
7688words (four bytes)
7689@item g
7690giant words (eight bytes)
7691@end table
7692
7693All values are interpreted in the current language.
7694This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
7695then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
7696
7697If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
7698value's type in the current language.
7699This is useful when one wants to specify the search
7700pattern as a mixture of types.
7701Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
7702a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
7703which is typically four bytes.
7704
7705@item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
7706The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
7707@end table
7708
7709You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
7710 (@code{"}).
7711The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
7712regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
7713
7714The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
7715number of matches found.
7716
7717The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
7718@samp{$_}.
7719A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
7720
7721For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
7722
7723@smallexample
7724void
7725hello ()
7726@{
7727 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
7728 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
7729 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
7730 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
7731 printf ("%s\n", hello);
7732@}
7733@end smallexample
7734
7735@noindent
7736you get during debugging:
7737
7738@smallexample
7739(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
77400x804956d <hello.1620+6>
77411 pattern found
7742(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
77430x8049567 <hello.1620>
77440x804956d <hello.1620+6>
77452 patterns found
7746(gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
77470x8049567 <hello.1620>
77481 pattern found
7749(gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
77500x8049560 <mixed.1625>
77511 pattern found
7752(gdb) print $numfound
7753$1 = 1
7754(gdb) print $_
7755$2 = (void *) 0x8049560
7756@end smallexample
7757
7758@node Macros
7759@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7760
7761Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7762``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7763@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7764the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7765where it was defined.
7766
7767You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7768with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7769include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7770with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7771
7772A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7773and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7774points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7775no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7776uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7777@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7778see @ref{List}.
7779
7780At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7781token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7782variable-arity macros.
7783
7784Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7785macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7786the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7787
7788@table @code
7789
7790@kindex macro expand
7791@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7792@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7793@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7794@item macro expand @var{expression}
7795@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7796Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7797@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7798not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7799it can be any string of tokens.
7800
7801@kindex macro exp1
7802@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7803@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7804@cindex expand macro once
7805@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7806expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7807@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7808left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7809particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7810expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7811parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7812can be any string of tokens.
7813
7814@kindex info macro
7815@cindex macro definition, showing
7816@cindex definition, showing a macro's
7817@item info macro @var{macro}
7818Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7819source location where that definition was established.
7820
7821@kindex macro define
7822@cindex user-defined macros
7823@cindex defining macros interactively
7824@cindex macros, user-defined
7825@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7826@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7827@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7828preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7829by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7830command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7831second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7832given in @var{arglist}.
7833
7834A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7835evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7836undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7837definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7838well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7839
7840@kindex macro undef
7841@item macro undef @var{macro}
7842@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7843definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7844definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7845above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7846debugged.
7847
7848@kindex macro list
7849@item macro list
7850@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7851defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7852@end table
7853
7854@cindex macros, example of debugging with
7855Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7856show our source files:
7857
7858@smallexample
7859$ cat sample.c
7860#include <stdio.h>
7861#include "sample.h"
7862
7863#define M 42
7864#define ADD(x) (M + x)
7865
7866main ()
7867@{
7868#define N 28
7869 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7870#undef N
7871 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7872#define N 1729
7873 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7874@}
7875$ cat sample.h
7876#define Q <
7877$
7878@end smallexample
7879
7880Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7881We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7882compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7883information.
7884
7885@smallexample
7886$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7887$
7888@end smallexample
7889
7890Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7891
7892@smallexample
7893$ gdb -nw sample
7894GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7895Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7896GDB is free software, @dots{}
7897(@value{GDBP})
7898@end smallexample
7899
7900We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7901program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7902to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7903
7904@smallexample
7905(@value{GDBP}) list main
79063
79074 #define M 42
79085 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
79096
79107 main ()
79118 @{
79129 #define N 28
791310 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
791411 #undef N
791512 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7916(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7917Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7918#define ADD(x) (M + x)
7919(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7920Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7921 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7922#define Q <
7923(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7924expands to: (42 + 1)
7925(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7926expands to: once (M + 1)
7927(@value{GDBP})
7928@end smallexample
7929
7930In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7931the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7932@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7933which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7934
7935Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7936force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7937
7938@smallexample
7939(@value{GDBP}) break main
7940Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7941(@value{GDBP}) run
7942Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7943
7944Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
794510 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7946(@value{GDBP})
7947@end smallexample
7948
7949At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7950
7951@smallexample
7952(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7953Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7954#define N 28
7955(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7956expands to: 28 < 42
7957(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7958$1 = 1
7959(@value{GDBP})
7960@end smallexample
7961
7962As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7963give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7964thereof) in force at each point:
7965
7966@smallexample
7967(@value{GDBP}) next
7968Hello, world!
796912 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7970(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7971The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7972at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7973(@value{GDBP}) next
7974We're so creative.
797514 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7976(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7977Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7978#define N 1729
7979(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7980expands to: 1729 < 42
7981(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7982$2 = 0
7983(@value{GDBP})
7984@end smallexample
7985
7986
7987@node Tracepoints
7988@chapter Tracepoints
7989@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7990@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7991
7992@cindex tracepoints
7993In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7994the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7995anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7996depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7997might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7998fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7999to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8000
8001Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8002specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8003arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8004Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8005those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8006expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8007for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8008a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8009in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8010values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8011unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8012
8013The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8014targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8015how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8016remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8017support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8018packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8019Packets}.
8020
8021This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8022
8023@menu
8024* Set Tracepoints::
8025* Analyze Collected Data::
8026* Tracepoint Variables::
8027@end menu
8028
8029@node Set Tracepoints
8030@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8031
8032Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8033tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
8034tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
8035breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
8036one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
8037tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
8038work on.
8039
8040For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8041of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8042it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8043local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8044commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8045tracepoint was hit.
8046
8047This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8048conditions and actions.
8049
8050@menu
8051* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8052* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8053* Tracepoint Passcounts::
8054* Tracepoint Actions::
8055* Listing Tracepoints::
8056* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8057@end menu
8058
8059@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8060@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8061
8062@table @code
8063@cindex set tracepoint
8064@kindex trace
8065@item trace
8066The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8067Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
8068the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
8069defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
8070debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
8071program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
8072doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
8073cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
8074running.
8075
8076Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8077
8078@smallexample
8079(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8080
8081(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8082
8083(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8084
8085(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8086
8087(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8088@end smallexample
8089
8090@noindent
8091You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8092
8093@vindex $tpnum
8094@cindex last tracepoint number
8095@cindex recent tracepoint number
8096@cindex tracepoint number
8097The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8098of the most recently set tracepoint.
8099
8100@kindex delete tracepoint
8101@cindex tracepoint deletion
8102@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8103Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8104default is to delete all tracepoints.
8105
8106Examples:
8107
8108@smallexample
8109(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8110
8111(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8112@end smallexample
8113
8114@noindent
8115You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8116@end table
8117
8118@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8119@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8120
8121@table @code
8122@kindex disable tracepoint
8123@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8124Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8125@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8126the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8127a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8128
8129@kindex enable tracepoint
8130@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8131Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8132tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8133run.
8134@end table
8135
8136@node Tracepoint Passcounts
8137@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8138
8139@table @code
8140@kindex passcount
8141@cindex tracepoint pass count
8142@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8143Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8144automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8145@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8146the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8147@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8148passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8149given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8150user.
8151
8152Examples:
8153
8154@smallexample
8155(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8156@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8157
8158(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8159@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8160(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8161(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8162(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8163(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8164(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8165(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8166@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8167@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8168@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8169@end smallexample
8170@end table
8171
8172@node Tracepoint Actions
8173@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8174
8175@table @code
8176@kindex actions
8177@cindex tracepoint actions
8178@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8179This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8180tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8181specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8182recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8183@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8184actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8185terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8186far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8187@code{while-stepping}.
8188
8189@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8190To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8191and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8192
8193@smallexample
8194(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8195
8196(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8197
8198(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8199@end smallexample
8200
8201In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8202commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8203hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8204following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8205followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8206@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8207@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8208@code{end} command.
8209
8210@smallexample
8211(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8212(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8213Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8214> collect bar,baz
8215> collect $regs
8216> while-stepping 12
8217 > collect $fp, $sp
8218 > end
8219end
8220@end smallexample
8221
8222@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8223@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8224Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8225This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8226In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8227special arguments are supported:
8228
8229@table @code
8230@item $regs
8231collect all registers
8232
8233@item $args
8234collect all function arguments
8235
8236@item $locals
8237collect all local variables.
8238@end table
8239
8240You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8241with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8242arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8243
8244The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8245particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8246
8247@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8248@item while-stepping @var{n}
8249Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8250new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8251followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8252its own @code{end} command):
8253
8254@smallexample
8255> while-stepping 12
8256 > collect $regs, myglobal
8257 > end
8258>
8259@end smallexample
8260
8261@noindent
8262You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8263@code{stepping}.
8264@end table
8265
8266@node Listing Tracepoints
8267@subsection Listing Tracepoints
8268
8269@table @code
8270@kindex info tracepoints
8271@kindex info tp
8272@cindex information about tracepoints
8273@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8274Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8275a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8276defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8277shown:
8278
8279@itemize @bullet
8280@item
8281its number
8282@item
8283whether it is enabled or disabled
8284@item
8285its address
8286@item
8287its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8288@item
8289its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8290@item
8291where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8292@item
8293its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8294@end itemize
8295
8296@smallexample
8297(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8298Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
82991 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
83002 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
83013 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8302(@value{GDBP})
8303@end smallexample
8304
8305@noindent
8306This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8307@end table
8308
8309@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8310@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8311
8312@table @code
8313@kindex tstart
8314@cindex start a new trace experiment
8315@cindex collected data discarded
8316@item tstart
8317This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8318begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8319the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8320experiment.
8321
8322@kindex tstop
8323@cindex stop a running trace experiment
8324@item tstop
8325This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8326stops collecting data.
8327
8328@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8329automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8330(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8331
8332@kindex tstatus
8333@cindex status of trace data collection
8334@cindex trace experiment, status of
8335@item tstatus
8336This command displays the status of the current trace data
8337collection.
8338@end table
8339
8340Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8341
8342@smallexample
8343(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8344(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8345Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8346> collect $regs,$locals,$args
8347> while-stepping 11
8348 > collect $regs
8349 > end
8350> end
8351(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8352 [time passes @dots{}]
8353(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8354@end smallexample
8355
8356
8357@node Analyze Collected Data
8358@section Using the Collected Data
8359
8360After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8361for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8362collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8363snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8364consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8365examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8366specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8367snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8368registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8369rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8370debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8371(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8372behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8373when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8374the buffer will fail.
8375
8376@menu
8377* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8378* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8379* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8380@end menu
8381
8382@node tfind
8383@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8384
8385@kindex tfind
8386@cindex select trace snapshot
8387@cindex find trace snapshot
8388The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8389@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8390counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8391snapshot is selected.
8392
8393Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8394
8395@table @code
8396@item tfind start
8397Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8398@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8399
8400@item tfind none
8401Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8402
8403@item tfind end
8404Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8405
8406@item tfind
8407No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8408
8409@item tfind -
8410Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8411retracing earlier steps.
8412
8413@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8414Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8415proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8416argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8417for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8418
8419@item tfind pc @var{addr}
8420Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8421program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8422snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8423snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8424
8425@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8426Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8427addresses.
8428
8429@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8430Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8431@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8432
8433@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8434Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8435the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8436that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8437trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8438next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8439@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8440stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8441@end table
8442
8443The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8444designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8445instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8446snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8447trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8448simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8449snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8450@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8451The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8452for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8453no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8454(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8455no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8456tracepoint as the current one.
8457
8458In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8459these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8460scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8461you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8462registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8463
8464@smallexample
8465(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8466(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8467> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8468 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8469> tfind
8470> end
8471
8472Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8473Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8474Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8475Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8476Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8477Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8478Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8479Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8480Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8481Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8482Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8483@end smallexample
8484
8485Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8486the buffer:
8487
8488@smallexample
8489(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8490(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8491> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8492> tfind line
8493> end
8494
8495Frame 0, X = 1
8496Frame 7, X = 2
8497Frame 13, X = 255
8498@end smallexample
8499
8500@node tdump
8501@subsection @code{tdump}
8502@kindex tdump
8503@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8504@cindex tracepoint data, display
8505
8506This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8507the current trace snapshot.
8508
8509@smallexample
8510(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8511(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8512Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8513> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8514> end
8515
8516(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8517
8518(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8519#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8520at gdb_test.c:444
8521444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8522
8523(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8524Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8525d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8526d1 0x18 24
8527d2 0x80 128
8528d3 0x33 51
8529d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8530d5 0x22 34
8531d6 0xe0 224
8532d7 0x380035 3670069
8533a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8534a1 0x3000668 50333288
8535a2 0x100 256
8536a3 0x322000 3284992
8537a4 0x3000698 50333336
8538a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8539fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8540sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8541ps 0x0 0
8542pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8543fpcontrol 0x0 0
8544fpstatus 0x0 0
8545fpiaddr 0x0 0
8546p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8547p1 = (void *) 0x11
8548p2 = (void *) 0x22
8549p3 = (void *) 0x33
8550p4 = (void *) 0x44
8551p5 = (void *) 0x55
8552p6 = (void *) 0x66
8553gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8554
8555(@value{GDBP})
8556@end smallexample
8557
8558@node save-tracepoints
8559@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8560@kindex save-tracepoints
8561@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8562
8563This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8564their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8565suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8566tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8567Files}).
8568
8569@node Tracepoint Variables
8570@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8571@cindex tracepoint variables
8572@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8573
8574@table @code
8575@vindex $trace_frame
8576@item (int) $trace_frame
8577The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8578snapshot is selected.
8579
8580@vindex $tracepoint
8581@item (int) $tracepoint
8582The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8583
8584@vindex $trace_line
8585@item (int) $trace_line
8586The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8587
8588@vindex $trace_file
8589@item (char []) $trace_file
8590The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8591
8592@vindex $trace_func
8593@item (char []) $trace_func
8594The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8595@end table
8596
8597Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8598use @code{output} instead.
8599
8600Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8601stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8602data.
8603
8604@smallexample
8605(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8606
8607(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8608> output $trace_file
8609> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8610> tfind
8611> end
8612@end smallexample
8613
8614@node Overlays
8615@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8616@cindex overlays
8617
8618If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8619memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8620problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8621use overlays.
8622
8623@menu
8624* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8625* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8626* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8627 mapped by asking the inferior.
8628* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8629@end menu
8630
8631@node How Overlays Work
8632@section How Overlays Work
8633@cindex mapped overlays
8634@cindex unmapped overlays
8635@cindex load address, overlay's
8636@cindex mapped address
8637@cindex overlay area
8638
8639Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8640kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8641other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8642management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8643adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8644
8645One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8646independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8647@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8648their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8649instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8650largest overlay as well.
8651
8652Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8653overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8654for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8655there.
8656
8657@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8658@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8659@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8660
8661@smallexample
8662@group
8663 Data Instruction Larger
8664Address Space Address Space Address Space
8665+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8666| | | | | |
8667+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8668| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8669| variables | | program | | +-----------+
8670| and heap | | | | | |
8671+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8672| | +-----------+ | | | load address
8673+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8674 | | | | | |
8675 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8676 address | | | | | |
8677 | overlay | <-' | | |
8678 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8679 | | <---. | | load address
8680 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8681 | | | |
8682 +-----------+ | |
8683 +-----------+
8684 | |
8685 +-----------+
8686
8687 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8688@end group
8689@end smallexample
8690
8691The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8692and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8693its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8694Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8695may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8696data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8697program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8698program and the overlay area.
8699
8700An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8701@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8702instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8703in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8704is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8705the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8706called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8707
8708Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8709program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8710global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8711
8712@itemize @bullet
8713
8714@item
8715Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8716must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8717return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8718overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8719
8720@item
8721If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8722will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8723your program's performance.
8724
8725@item
8726The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8727overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8728mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8729and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8730You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8731addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8732ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8733
8734@item
8735The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8736to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8737instruction and data spaces.
8738
8739@end itemize
8740
8741The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8742improved in many ways:
8743
8744@itemize @bullet
8745
8746@item
8747If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8748hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8749contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8750This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8751area in the usual way.
8752
8753@item
8754If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8755overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8756
8757@item
8758You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8759general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8760code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8761return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8762the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8763must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8764different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8765
8766@end itemize
8767
8768
8769@node Overlay Commands
8770@section Overlay Commands
8771
8772To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8773correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8774virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8775mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8776@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8777variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8778
8779@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8780you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8781
8782@table @code
8783@item overlay off
8784@kindex overlay
8785Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8786disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8787always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8788overlay support is disabled.
8789
8790@item overlay manual
8791@cindex manual overlay debugging
8792Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8793relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8794using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8795commands described below.
8796
8797@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8798@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8799@cindex map an overlay
8800Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8801be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8802overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8803functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8804that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8805@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8806
8807@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8808@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8809@cindex unmap an overlay
8810Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8811must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8812When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8813overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8814
8815@item overlay auto
8816Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8817consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8818to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8819Overlay Debugging}.
8820
8821@item overlay load-target
8822@itemx overlay load
8823@cindex reloading the overlay table
8824Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8825re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8826stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8827overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8828useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8829
8830@item overlay list-overlays
8831@itemx overlay list
8832@cindex listing mapped overlays
8833Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8834addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8835
8836@end table
8837
8838Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8839of the function the address falls in:
8840
8841@smallexample
8842(@value{GDBP}) print main
8843$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8844@end smallexample
8845@noindent
8846When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8847unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8848asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8849unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8850
8851@smallexample
8852(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8853No sections are mapped.
8854(@value{GDBP}) print foo
8855$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8856@end smallexample
8857@noindent
8858When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8859name normally:
8860
8861@smallexample
8862(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8863Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8864 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8865(@value{GDBP}) print foo
8866$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8867@end smallexample
8868
8869When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8870address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8871overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8872@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8873code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8874
8875@itemize @bullet
8876@item
8877@cindex breakpoints in overlays
8878@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8879You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8880@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8881@item
8882@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8883unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8884overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8885you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8886breakpoints properly.
8887@end itemize
8888
8889
8890@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8891@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8892@cindex automatic overlay debugging
8893
8894@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8895are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8896inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8897@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8898looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8899current state of the overlays.
8900
8901Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8902@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8903
8904@table @asis
8905
8906@item @code{_ovly_table}:
8907This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8908
8909@smallexample
8910struct
8911@{
8912 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8913 unsigned long vma;
8914
8915 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8916 unsigned long size;
8917
8918 /* The overlay's load address. */
8919 unsigned long lma;
8920
8921 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8922 zero otherwise. */
8923 unsigned long mapped;
8924@}
8925@end smallexample
8926
8927@item @code{_novlys}:
8928This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8929number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8930
8931@end table
8932
8933To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8934looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8935@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8936executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8937the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8938currently mapped.
8939
8940In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8941@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8942will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8943calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8944will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8945are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8946in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8947overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8948are not being executed.
8949
8950@node Overlay Sample Program
8951@section Overlay Sample Program
8952@cindex overlay example program
8953
8954When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8955at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8956addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8957Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8958since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8959architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8960portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8961
8962However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8963program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8964suite. The program consists of the following files from
8965@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8966
8967@table @file
8968@item overlays.c
8969The main program file.
8970@item ovlymgr.c
8971A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8972@item foo.c
8973@itemx bar.c
8974@itemx baz.c
8975@itemx grbx.c
8976Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8977@item d10v.ld
8978@itemx m32r.ld
8979Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8980and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8981@end table
8982
8983You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8984cross-compiler like this:
8985
8986@smallexample
8987$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8988$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8989$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8990$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8991$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8992$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8993$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8994 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8995@end smallexample
8996
8997The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8998you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8999target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9000
9001
9002@node Languages
9003@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9004@cindex languages
9005
9006Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9007rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9008dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9009Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9010represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9011@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9012
9013@cindex working language
9014Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9015allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9016native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9017consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9018language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9019language}.
9020
9021@menu
9022* Setting:: Switching between source languages
9023* Show:: Displaying the language
9024* Checks:: Type and range checks
9025* Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9026* Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9027@end menu
9028
9029@node Setting
9030@section Switching Between Source Languages
9031
9032There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9033set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9034@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9035defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9036used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9037are printed, etc.
9038
9039In addition to the working language, every source file that
9040@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9041file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9042source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9043language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9044controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9045show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9046set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9047set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9048Displaying the Language}.
9049
9050This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9051as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9052another language. In that case, make the
9053program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9054@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9055program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9056
9057@menu
9058* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9059* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9060* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9061@end menu
9062
9063@node Filenames
9064@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9065
9066If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9067@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9068
9069@table @file
9070@item .ada
9071@itemx .ads
9072@itemx .adb
9073@itemx .a
9074Ada source file.
9075
9076@item .c
9077C source file
9078
9079@item .C
9080@itemx .cc
9081@itemx .cp
9082@itemx .cpp
9083@itemx .cxx
9084@itemx .c++
9085C@t{++} source file
9086
9087@item .m
9088Objective-C source file
9089
9090@item .f
9091@itemx .F
9092Fortran source file
9093
9094@item .mod
9095Modula-2 source file
9096
9097@item .s
9098@itemx .S
9099Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9100@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9101@end table
9102
9103In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9104extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9105
9106@node Manually
9107@subsection Setting the Working Language
9108
9109If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9110expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9111your program.
9112
9113@kindex set language
9114If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9115command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9116a language, such as
9117@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9118For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9119
9120Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9121language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9122to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9123source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9124languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9125source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9126command such as:
9127
9128@smallexample
9129print a = b + c
9130@end smallexample
9131
9132@noindent
9133might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9134@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9135printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9136@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9137
9138@node Automatically
9139@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9140
9141To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9142@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9143then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9144frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9145working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9146frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9147or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9148does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9149not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9150
9151This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9152entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9153written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9154a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9155case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9156
9157@node Show
9158@section Displaying the Language
9159
9160The following commands help you find out which language is the
9161working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9162
9163@table @code
9164@item show language
9165@kindex show language
9166Display the current working language. This is the
9167language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9168build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9169
9170@item info frame
9171@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9172Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9173working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9174@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9175information listed here.
9176
9177@item info source
9178@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9179Display the source language of this source file.
9180@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9181information listed here.
9182@end table
9183
9184In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9185not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9186with a language explicitly:
9187
9188@table @code
9189@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9190@kindex set extension-language
9191Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9192assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9193
9194@item info extensions
9195@kindex info extensions
9196List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9197@end table
9198
9199@node Checks
9200@section Type and Range Checking
9201
9202@quotation
9203@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9204checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9205section documents the intended facilities.
9206@end quotation
9207@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9208
9209Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9210errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9211checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9212sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9213these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9214by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9215errors when your program is running.
9216
9217@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9218Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9219it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9220evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9221working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9222automatically based on your program's source language.
9223@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9224settings of supported languages.
9225
9226@menu
9227* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9228* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9229@end menu
9230
9231@cindex type checking
9232@cindex checks, type
9233@node Type Checking
9234@subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9235
9236Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9237arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9238otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9239errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9240
9241@smallexample
92421 + 2 @result{} 3
9243@exdent but
9244@error{} 1 + 2.3
9245@end smallexample
9246
9247The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9248type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9249
9250For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9251@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9252to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9253or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9254but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9255these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9256also issues a warning.
9257
9258Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9259related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9260For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9261a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9262with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9263the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9264
9265Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9266instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9267operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9268represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9269operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9270details on specific languages.
9271
9272@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9273
9274@kindex set check type
9275@kindex show check type
9276@table @code
9277@item set check type auto
9278Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9279@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9280each language.
9281
9282@item set check type on
9283@itemx set check type off
9284Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9285current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9286match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9287evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9288message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9289
9290@item set check type warn
9291Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9292evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9293be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9294numbers and structures.
9295
9296@item show type
9297Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9298is setting it automatically.
9299@end table
9300
9301@cindex range checking
9302@cindex checks, range
9303@node Range Checking
9304@subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9305
9306In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9307bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9308checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9309computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9310not exceed the bounds of the array.
9311
9312For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9313@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9314always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9315warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9316
9317A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9318array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9319of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9320error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9321result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9322the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9323
9324@smallexample
9325@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9326@end smallexample
9327
9328This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9329specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9330Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9331
9332@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9333
9334@kindex set check range
9335@kindex show check range
9336@table @code
9337@item set check range auto
9338Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9339@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9340each language.
9341
9342@item set check range on
9343@itemx set check range off
9344Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9345current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9346match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9347then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9348
9349@item set check range warn
9350Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9351but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9352expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9353memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9354systems).
9355
9356@item show range
9357Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9358being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9359@end table
9360
9361@node Supported Languages
9362@section Supported Languages
9363
9364@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9365assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9366@c This is false ...
9367Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9368language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9369and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9370,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9371language.
9372
9373The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9374supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9375tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9376@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9377formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9378books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9379language reference or tutorial.
9380
9381@menu
9382* C:: C and C@t{++}
9383* Objective-C:: Objective-C
9384* Fortran:: Fortran
9385* Pascal:: Pascal
9386* Modula-2:: Modula-2
9387* Ada:: Ada
9388@end menu
9389
9390@node C
9391@subsection C and C@t{++}
9392
9393@cindex C and C@t{++}
9394@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9395
9396Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9397to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9398together.
9399
9400@cindex C@t{++}
9401@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9402@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9403The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9404compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9405effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9406C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9407compiler (@code{aCC}).
9408
9409For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9410format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9411format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9412command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9413@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9414gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9415
9416@menu
9417* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9418* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9419* C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9420* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9421* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9422* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9423* Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9424* Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9425@end menu
9426
9427@node C Operators
9428@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9429
9430@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9431
9432Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9433@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9434often defined on groups of types.
9435
9436For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9437
9438@itemize @bullet
9439
9440@item
9441@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9442specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9443
9444@item
9445@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9446@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9447
9448@item
9449@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9450
9451@item
9452@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9453
9454@end itemize
9455
9456@noindent
9457The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9458in order of increasing precedence:
9459
9460@table @code
9461@item ,
9462The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9463are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9464expression being the last expression evaluated.
9465
9466@item =
9467Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9468assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9469
9470@item @var{op}=
9471Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9472and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9473@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9474@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9475@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9476
9477@item ?:
9478The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9479of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9480integral type.
9481
9482@item ||
9483Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9484
9485@item &&
9486Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9487
9488@item |
9489Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9490
9491@item ^
9492Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9493
9494@item &
9495Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9496
9497@item ==@r{, }!=
9498Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9499expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9500
9501@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9502Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9503Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9504and non-zero for true.
9505
9506@item <<@r{, }>>
9507left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9508
9509@item @@
9510The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9511
9512@item +@r{, }-
9513Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9514pointer types.
9515
9516@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9517Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9518defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9519integral types.
9520
9521@item ++@r{, }--
9522Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9523operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9524when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9525operation takes place.
9526
9527@item *
9528Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9529@code{++}.
9530
9531@item &
9532Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9533
9534For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9535allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9536to examine the address
9537where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9538stored.
9539
9540@item -
9541Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9542precedence as @code{++}.
9543
9544@item !
9545Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9546@code{++}.
9547
9548@item ~
9549Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9550@code{++}.
9551
9552
9553@item .@r{, }->
9554Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9555@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9556pointer based on the stored type information.
9557Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9558
9559@item .*@r{, }->*
9560Dereferences of pointers to members.
9561
9562@item []
9563Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9564@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9565
9566@item ()
9567Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9568
9569@item ::
9570C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9571and @code{class} types.
9572
9573@item ::
9574Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9575(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9576above.
9577@end table
9578
9579If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9580attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9581predefined meaning.
9582
9583@node C Constants
9584@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9585
9586@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9587
9588@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9589following ways:
9590
9591@itemize @bullet
9592@item
9593Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9594specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9595by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9596@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9597@code{long} value.
9598
9599@item
9600Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9601point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9602exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9603@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9604sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9605A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9606@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9607the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9608a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9609constant.
9610
9611@item
9612Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9613integral equivalents.
9614
9615@item
9616Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9617(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9618(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9619be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9620the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9621of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9622@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9623@samp{\n} for newline.
9624
9625@item
9626String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9627double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9628above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9629a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9630characters.
9631
9632@item
9633Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9634to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9635
9636@item
9637Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9638and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9639integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9640and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9641@end itemize
9642
9643@node C Plus Plus Expressions
9644@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9645
9646@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9647@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9648
9649@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9650@cindex C@t{++} compilers
9651@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9652@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9653@quotation
9654@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9655proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9656works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9657@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9658@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9659stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9660stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9661specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9662are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9663C@t{++} code.
9664@end quotation
9665
9666@enumerate
9667
9668@cindex member functions
9669@item
9670Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9671
9672@smallexample
9673count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9674@end smallexample
9675
9676@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9677@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9678@item
9679While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9680expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9681that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9682pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9683
9684@cindex call overloaded functions
9685@cindex overloaded functions, calling
9686@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9687@item
9688You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9689call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9690perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9691calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9692in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9693default arguments.
9694
9695It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9696promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9697class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9698functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9699number of function arguments.
9700
9701Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9702@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9703,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9704
9705You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9706explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9707@smallexample
9708p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9709@end smallexample
9710
9711The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9712see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9713
9714@cindex reference declarations
9715@item
9716@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9717them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9718dereferenced.
9719
9720In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9721reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9722avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9723The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9724you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9725
9726@item
9727@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9728expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9729one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9730necessary, for example in an expression like
9731@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9732resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9733debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9734@end enumerate
9735
9736In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9737calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9738objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9739invoking user-defined operators.
9740
9741@node C Defaults
9742@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9743
9744@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9745
9746If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9747both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9748C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9749selects the working language.
9750
9751If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9752recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9753@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9754these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9755@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9756for further details.
9757
9758@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9759@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9760@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9761
9762@node C Checks
9763@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9764
9765@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9766
9767By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9768is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9769considers two variables type equivalent if:
9770
9771@itemize @bullet
9772@item
9773The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9774enumerated tag.
9775
9776@item
9777The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9778declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9779
9780@ignore
9781@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9782@c FIXME--beers?
9783@item
9784The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9785declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9786compilers.)
9787@end ignore
9788@end itemize
9789
9790Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9791indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9792that is not itself an array.
9793
9794@node Debugging C
9795@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9796
9797The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9798the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9799inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9800appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9801
9802The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9803with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9804,Expressions}.
9805
9806@node Debugging C Plus Plus
9807@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9808
9809@cindex commands for C@t{++}
9810
9811Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9812designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9813
9814@table @code
9815@cindex break in overloaded functions
9816@item @r{breakpoint menus}
9817When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9818@value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
9819locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
9820@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
9821
9822@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9823@item rbreak @var{regex}
9824Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9825breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9826classes.
9827@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9828
9829@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9830@item catch throw
9831@itemx catch catch
9832Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9833Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9834
9835@cindex inheritance
9836@item ptype @var{typename}
9837Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9838@var{typename}.
9839@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9840
9841@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9842@item set print demangle
9843@itemx show print demangle
9844@itemx set print asm-demangle
9845@itemx show print asm-demangle
9846Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9847displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9848@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9849
9850@item set print object
9851@itemx show print object
9852Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9853@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9854
9855@item set print vtbl
9856@itemx show print vtbl
9857Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9858@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9859(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9860ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9861
9862@kindex set overload-resolution
9863@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9864@item set overload-resolution on
9865Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9866is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9867and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9868using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9869Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9870If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9871
9872@item set overload-resolution off
9873Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9874overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9875chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9876symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9877overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9878searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9879argument types.
9880
9881@kindex show overload-resolution
9882@item show overload-resolution
9883Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9884
9885@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9886You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9887the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9888@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9889also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9890available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9891@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9892@end table
9893
9894@node Decimal Floating Point
9895@subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9896@cindex decimal floating point format
9897
9898@value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9899decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9900@code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
9901specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
9902
9903There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
9904Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
9905PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
9906target.
9907
9908Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
9909to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
9910(using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
9911
9912In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
9913point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
9914underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
9915
9916In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
9917to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
9918@ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
9919
9920@node Objective-C
9921@subsection Objective-C
9922
9923@cindex Objective-C
9924This section provides information about some commands and command
9925options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9926@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9927few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9928
9929@menu
9930* Method Names in Commands::
9931* The Print Command with Objective-C::
9932@end menu
9933
9934@node Method Names in Commands
9935@subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9936
9937The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9938names as line specifications:
9939
9940@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9941@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9942@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9943@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9944@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9945@itemize
9946@item @code{clear}
9947@item @code{break}
9948@item @code{info line}
9949@item @code{jump}
9950@item @code{list}
9951@end itemize
9952
9953A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9954
9955@smallexample
9956-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9957@end smallexample
9958
9959where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9960plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9961name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9962brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9963source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9964instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9965debugged, enter:
9966
9967@smallexample
9968break -[Fruit create]
9969@end smallexample
9970
9971To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9972enter:
9973
9974@smallexample
9975list +[NSText initialize]
9976@end smallexample
9977
9978In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9979required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9980sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9981is also possible to specify just a method name:
9982
9983@smallexample
9984break create
9985@end smallexample
9986
9987You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9988your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9989you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9990method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9991none apply.
9992
9993As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9994@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9995
9996@smallexample
9997clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9998@end smallexample
9999
10000@node The Print Command with Objective-C
10001@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10002@cindex Objective-C, print objects
10003@kindex print-object
10004@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10005
10006The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10007
10008@smallexample
10009print -[@var{object} hash]
10010@end smallexample
10011
10012@cindex print an Objective-C object description
10013@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10014@noindent
10015will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10016and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10017@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10018the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10019with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10020function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10021
10022@node Fortran
10023@subsection Fortran
10024@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10025
10026@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10027currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10028
10029@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10030Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10031among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10032functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10033will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10034underscore.
10035
10036@menu
10037* Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10038* Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10039* Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10040@end menu
10041
10042@node Fortran Operators
10043@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10044
10045@cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10046
10047Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10048@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10049arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10050
10051@table @code
10052@item **
10053The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10054of the second one.
10055
10056@item :
10057The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10058represent a section of array.
10059
10060@item %
10061The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10062types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10063this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10064union type.
10065@end table
10066
10067@node Fortran Defaults
10068@subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10069
10070@cindex Fortran Defaults
10071
10072Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10073default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10074change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10075@ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10076
10077@node Special Fortran Commands
10078@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10079
10080@cindex Special Fortran commands
10081
10082@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10083such as displaying common blocks.
10084
10085@table @code
10086@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10087@kindex info common
10088@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10089This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10090block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10091all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10092printed.
10093@end table
10094
10095@node Pascal
10096@subsection Pascal
10097
10098@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10099Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10100nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10101entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10102syntax.
10103
10104The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10105controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10106@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10107
10108@node Modula-2
10109@subsection Modula-2
10110
10111@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10112
10113The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10114output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10115developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10116attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10117to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10118table.
10119
10120@cindex expressions in Modula-2
10121@menu
10122* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10123* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10124* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10125* M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10126* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10127* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10128* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10129* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10130* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10131@end menu
10132
10133@node M2 Operators
10134@subsubsection Operators
10135@cindex Modula-2 operators
10136
10137Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10138@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10139often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10140following definitions hold:
10141
10142@itemize @bullet
10143
10144@item
10145@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10146their subranges.
10147
10148@item
10149@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10150
10151@item
10152@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10153
10154@item
10155@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10156@var{type}}.
10157
10158@item
10159@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10160
10161@item
10162@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10163
10164@item
10165@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10166@end itemize
10167
10168@noindent
10169The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10170increasing precedence:
10171
10172@table @code
10173@item ,
10174Function argument or array index separator.
10175
10176@item :=
10177Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10178@var{value}.
10179
10180@item <@r{, }>
10181Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10182types.
10183
10184@item <=@r{, }>=
10185Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10186on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10187set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10188
10189@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10190Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10191Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10192available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10193comment character.
10194
10195@item IN
10196Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10197Same precedence as @code{<}.
10198
10199@item OR
10200Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10201
10202@item AND@r{, }&
10203Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10204
10205@item @@
10206The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10207
10208@item +@r{, }-
10209Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10210and difference on set types.
10211
10212@item *
10213Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10214on set types.
10215
10216@item /
10217Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10218types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10219
10220@item DIV@r{, }MOD
10221Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10222precedence as @code{*}.
10223
10224@item -
10225Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10226
10227@item ^
10228Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10229
10230@item NOT
10231Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10232@code{^}.
10233
10234@item .
10235@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10236precedence as @code{^}.
10237
10238@item []
10239Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10240
10241@item ()
10242Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10243as @code{^}.
10244
10245@item ::@r{, }.
10246@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10247@end table
10248
10249@quotation
10250@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10251treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10252@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10253@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10254@end quotation
10255
10256
10257@node Built-In Func/Proc
10258@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10259@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10260
10261Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10262In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10263
10264@table @var
10265
10266@item a
10267represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10268
10269@item c
10270represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10271
10272@item i
10273represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10274
10275@item m
10276represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10277same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10278be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10279
10280@item n
10281represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10282
10283@item r
10284represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10285
10286@item t
10287represents a type.
10288
10289@item v
10290represents a variable.
10291
10292@item x
10293represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10294explanation of the function for details.
10295@end table
10296
10297All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10298
10299@table @code
10300@item ABS(@var{n})
10301Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10302
10303@item CAP(@var{c})
10304If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10305equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10306
10307@item CHR(@var{i})
10308Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10309
10310@item DEC(@var{v})
10311Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10312
10313@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10314Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10315new value.
10316
10317@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10318Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10319set.
10320
10321@item FLOAT(@var{i})
10322Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10323
10324@item HIGH(@var{a})
10325Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10326
10327@item INC(@var{v})
10328Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10329
10330@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10331Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10332new value.
10333
10334@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10335Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10336there. Returns the new set.
10337
10338@item MAX(@var{t})
10339Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10340
10341@item MIN(@var{t})
10342Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10343
10344@item ODD(@var{i})
10345Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10346
10347@item ORD(@var{x})
10348Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10349value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10350@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10351integral, character and enumerated types.
10352
10353@item SIZE(@var{x})
10354Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10355
10356@item TRUNC(@var{r})
10357Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10358
10359@item TSIZE(@var{x})
10360Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10361
10362@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10363Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10364@end table
10365
10366@quotation
10367@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10368@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10369an error.
10370@end quotation
10371
10372@cindex Modula-2 constants
10373@node M2 Constants
10374@subsubsection Constants
10375
10376@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10377ways:
10378
10379@itemize @bullet
10380
10381@item
10382Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10383expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10384rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10385trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10386
10387@item
10388Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10389decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10390then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10391@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10392digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10393digits.
10394
10395@item
10396Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10397like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10398also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10399followed by a @samp{C}.
10400
10401@item
10402String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10403pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10404Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10405Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10406sequences.
10407
10408@item
10409Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10410
10411@item
10412Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10413@code{FALSE}.
10414
10415@item
10416Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10417
10418@item
10419Set constants are not yet supported.
10420@end itemize
10421
10422@node M2 Types
10423@subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10424@cindex Modula-2 types
10425
10426Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10427syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10428types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10429print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10430This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10431sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10432
10433The first example contains the following section of code:
10434
10435@smallexample
10436VAR
10437 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10438 r: [20..40] ;
10439@end smallexample
10440
10441@noindent
10442and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10443@code{r} and @code{s}.
10444
10445@smallexample
10446(@value{GDBP}) print s
10447@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10448(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10449SET OF CHAR
10450(@value{GDBP}) print r
1045121
10452(@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10453[20..40]
10454@end smallexample
10455
10456@noindent
10457Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10458
10459@smallexample
10460VAR
10461 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10462@end smallexample
10463
10464@noindent
10465then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10466
10467@smallexample
10468(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10469type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10470@end smallexample
10471
10472@noindent
10473Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10474expressions using the debugger.
10475
10476The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10477and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10478
10479@smallexample
10480VAR
10481 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10482@end smallexample
10483
10484@smallexample
10485(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10486ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10487@end smallexample
10488
10489Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10490is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10491arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10492above.
10493
10494Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10495
10496@smallexample
10497TYPE
10498 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10499 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10500VAR
10501 s: t ;
10502BEGIN
10503 s := blue ;
10504@end smallexample
10505
10506@noindent
10507The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10508and value of a variable.
10509
10510@smallexample
10511(@value{GDBP}) print s
10512$1 = blue
10513(@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10514type = [blue..yellow]
10515@end smallexample
10516
10517@noindent
10518In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10519displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10520their @code{C} counterparts.
10521
10522@smallexample
10523VAR
10524 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10525BEGIN
10526 s[1] := 1 ;
10527@end smallexample
10528
10529@smallexample
10530(@value{GDBP}) print s
10531$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10532(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10533type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10534@end smallexample
10535
10536The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10537pointer types as shown in this example:
10538
10539@smallexample
10540VAR
10541 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10542BEGIN
10543 NEW(s) ;
10544 s^[1] := 1 ;
10545@end smallexample
10546
10547@noindent
10548and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10549
10550@smallexample
10551(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10552type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10553@end smallexample
10554
10555@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10556Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10557types:
10558
10559@smallexample
10560TYPE
10561 foo = RECORD
10562 f1: CARDINAL ;
10563 f2: CHAR ;
10564 f3: myarray ;
10565 END ;
10566
10567 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10568 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10569VAR
10570 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10571@end smallexample
10572
10573@noindent
10574and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10575below.
10576
10577@smallexample
10578(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10579type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10580 f1 : CARDINAL;
10581 f2 : CHAR;
10582 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10583END
10584@end smallexample
10585
10586@node M2 Defaults
10587@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10588@cindex Modula-2 defaults
10589
10590If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10591both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10592Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10593selected the working language.
10594
10595If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10596code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10597working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10598Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10599
10600@node Deviations
10601@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10602@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10603
10604A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10605This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10606
10607@itemize @bullet
10608@item
10609Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10610integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10611debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10612pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10613through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10614returned a pointer.)
10615
10616@item
10617C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10618non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10619escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10620printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10621
10622@item
10623The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10624argument.
10625
10626@item
10627All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10628@end itemize
10629
10630@node M2 Checks
10631@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10632@cindex Modula-2 checks
10633
10634@quotation
10635@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10636range checking.
10637@end quotation
10638@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10639
10640@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10641
10642@itemize @bullet
10643@item
10644They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10645@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10646
10647@item
10648They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10649@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10650@end itemize
10651
10652As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10653whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10654
10655Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10656index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10657
10658@node M2 Scope
10659@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10660@cindex scope
10661@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10662@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10663@ifinfo
10664@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10665@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10666@end ifinfo
10667@iftex
10668@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10669@end iftex
10670
10671There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10672(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10673similar syntax:
10674
10675@smallexample
10676
10677@var{module} . @var{id}
10678@var{scope} :: @var{id}
10679@end smallexample
10680
10681@noindent
10682where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10683@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10684identifier within your program, except another module.
10685
10686Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10687specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10688found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10689enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10690
10691Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10692the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10693definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10694an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10695module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10696@var{module}.
10697
10698@node GDB/M2
10699@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10700
10701Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10702Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10703specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10704@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10705apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10706analogue in Modula-2.
10707
10708The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10709with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10710intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10711created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10712address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10713@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10714
10715@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10716In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10717interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10718
10719@node Ada
10720@subsection Ada
10721@cindex Ada
10722
10723The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10724output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10725Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10726attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10727to be difficult.
10728
10729
10730@cindex expressions in Ada
10731@menu
10732* Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10733 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10734 in @value{GDBN}.
10735* Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10736* Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10737* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10738* Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10739@end menu
10740
10741@node Ada Mode Intro
10742@subsubsection Introduction
10743@cindex Ada mode, general
10744
10745The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10746syntax, with some extensions.
10747The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10748
10749@itemize @bullet
10750@item
10751That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10752arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10753leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10754program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10755
10756@item
10757That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10758are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10759
10760@item
10761That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10762@end itemize
10763
10764Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10765implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10766packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10767their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10768@value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10769
10770The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10771As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10772was translated from an Ada source file.
10773
10774While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10775mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10776(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10777middle (to allow based literals).
10778
10779The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10780the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10781actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10782the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10783procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10784functions to procedures elsewhere.
10785
10786@node Omissions from Ada
10787@subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10788@cindex Ada, omissions from
10789
10790Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10791
10792@itemize @bullet
10793@item
10794Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10795
10796@itemize @minus
10797@item
10798@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10799 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10800
10801@item
10802@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10803
10804@item
10805@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10806
10807@item
10808@t{'Tag}.
10809
10810@item
10811@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10812operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10813
10814@item
10815@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10816@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10817
10818@item
10819@t{'Address}.
10820@end itemize
10821
10822@item
10823The names in
10824@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10825concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10826not currently available.
10827
10828@item
10829Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10830equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10831for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10832They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10833types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10834(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10835zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10836indeterminate values.
10837
10838@item
10839The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10840@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10841are not implemented.
10842
10843@item
10844@cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10845@cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10846@cindex aggregates (Ada)
10847There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10848permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10849
10850@smallexample
10851set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10852set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10853set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10854set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10855set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10856set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10857@end smallexample
10858
10859Changing a
10860discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10861undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10862However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10863them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10864aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10865declared to have a type such as:
10866
10867@smallexample
10868type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10869 Id : Integer;
10870 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10871end record;
10872@end smallexample
10873
10874you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10875assignments:
10876
10877@smallexample
10878set A_Rec.Len := 4
10879set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10880@end smallexample
10881
10882As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10883rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10884components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10885component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10886original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10887indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10888redundant component associations, although which component values are
10889assigned in such cases is not defined.
10890
10891@item
10892Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10893
10894@item
10895The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10896than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10897which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10898looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10899function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10900the proper resolution.
10901
10902@item
10903The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10904
10905@item
10906Entry calls are not implemented.
10907
10908@item
10909Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10910formats are not supported.
10911
10912@item
10913It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10914@end itemize
10915
10916@node Additions to Ada
10917@subsubsection Additions to Ada
10918@cindex Ada, deviations from
10919
10920As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10921extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10922
10923@itemize @bullet
10924@item
10925If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10926a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10927then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10928@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10929Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10930in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10931Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10932which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10933
10934@item
10935@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10936appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10937you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10938
10939@item
10940The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10941@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10942
10943@item
10944A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10945(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10946@end itemize
10947
10948In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10949additions specific to Ada:
10950
10951@itemize @bullet
10952@item
10953The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10954its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10955
10956@smallexample
10957set x := y + 3
10958print A(tmp := y + 1)
10959@end smallexample
10960
10961@item
10962The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10963the value of its right-hand operand.
10964This allows, for example,
10965complex conditional breaks:
10966
10967@smallexample
10968break f
10969condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10970@end smallexample
10971
10972@item
10973Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10974characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10975which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10976@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10977(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10978sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10979in strings. For example,
10980@smallexample
10981 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10982@end smallexample
10983@noindent
10984contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10985after each period.
10986
10987@item
10988The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10989@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10990to write
10991
10992@smallexample
10993print 'max(x, y)
10994@end smallexample
10995
10996@item
10997When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10998array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10999For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11000of 3 might print as
11001
11002@smallexample
11003(3 => 10, 17, 1)
11004@end smallexample
11005
11006@noindent
11007That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11008clause.
11009
11010@item
11011You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11012multi-character subsequence of
11013their names (an exact match gets preference).
11014For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11015in place of @t{a'length}.
11016
11017@item
11018@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11019Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11020to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11021some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11022For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11023enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11024For example,
11025@smallexample
11026@value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11027@end smallexample
11028
11029@item
11030Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11031access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11032specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11033selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11034object.
11035
11036@end itemize
11037
11038@node Stopping Before Main Program
11039@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11040
11041@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11042It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11043before reaching the main procedure.
11044As defined in the Ada Reference
11045Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11046@code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11047elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11048@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11049
11050@node Ada Glitches
11051@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11052@cindex Ada, problems
11053
11054Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11055we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11056@value{GDBN},
11057some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11058and the GNU Ada compiler.
11059
11060@itemize @bullet
11061@item
11062Currently, the debugger
11063has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11064pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11065Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11066to get it printed properly.
11067
11068@item
11069Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
11070storage are invisible to the debugger.
11071
11072@item
11073Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
11074argument lists are treated as positional).
11075
11076@item
11077Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
11078
11079@item
11080Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
11081floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
11082the host machine.
11083
11084@item
11085The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
11086
11087@item
11088The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
11089the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
11090this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
11091look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
11092symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
11093defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
11094local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
11095GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
11096you can usually resolve the confusion
11097by qualifying the problematic names with package
11098@code{Standard} explicitly.
11099@end itemize
11100
11101@node Unsupported Languages
11102@section Unsupported Languages
11103
11104@cindex unsupported languages
11105@cindex minimal language
11106In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
11107@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
11108It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
11109of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
11110This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
11111an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
11112
11113If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
11114select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
11115language.
11116
11117@node Symbols
11118@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
11119
11120The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
11121symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
11122program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
11123does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
11124program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
11125(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
11126file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
11127
11128@cindex symbol names
11129@cindex names of symbols
11130@cindex quoting names
11131Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11132characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11133most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11134source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11135are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11136ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11137@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11138@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11139
11140@smallexample
11141p 'foo.c'::x
11142@end smallexample
11143
11144@noindent
11145looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11146
11147@table @code
11148@cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11149@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11150@kindex set case-sensitive
11151@item set case-sensitive on
11152@itemx set case-sensitive off
11153@itemx set case-sensitive auto
11154Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11155with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11156Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11157case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11158case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11159you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11160suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11161matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11162case-insensitive matches.
11163
11164@kindex show case-sensitive
11165@item show case-sensitive
11166This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11167lookups.
11168
11169@kindex info address
11170@cindex address of a symbol
11171@item info address @var{symbol}
11172Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11173variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11174local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11175is always stored.
11176
11177Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11178at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11179the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11180
11181@kindex info symbol
11182@cindex symbol from address
11183@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11184@item info symbol @var{addr}
11185Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11186If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11187nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11188
11189@smallexample
11190(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11191_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11192@end smallexample
11193
11194@noindent
11195This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11196it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11197
11198@kindex whatis
11199@item whatis [@var{arg}]
11200Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11201a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11202last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11203not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11204assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11205@var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11206for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11207@samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11208@samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11209@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11210
11211@kindex ptype
11212@item ptype [@var{arg}]
11213@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11214detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11215@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11216
11217For example, for this variable declaration:
11218
11219@smallexample
11220struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11221@end smallexample
11222
11223@noindent
11224the two commands give this output:
11225
11226@smallexample
11227@group
11228(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11229type = struct complex
11230(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11231type = struct complex @{
11232 double real;
11233 double imag;
11234@}
11235@end group
11236@end smallexample
11237
11238@noindent
11239As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11240the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11241
11242@cindex incomplete type
11243Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11244of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11245program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11246the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11247given these declarations:
11248
11249@smallexample
11250 struct foo;
11251 struct foo *fooptr;
11252@end smallexample
11253
11254@noindent
11255but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11256
11257@smallexample
11258 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11259 $1 = <incomplete type>
11260@end smallexample
11261
11262@noindent
11263``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11264completely specified.
11265
11266@kindex info types
11267@item info types @var{regexp}
11268@itemx info types
11269Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11270expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11271no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11272complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11273types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11274@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11275name is @code{value}.
11276
11277This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11278@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11279lists all source files where a type is defined.
11280
11281@kindex info scope
11282@cindex local variables
11283@item info scope @var{location}
11284List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11285accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11286an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11287to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11288details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11289
11290@smallexample
11291(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11292Scope for command_line_handler:
11293Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11294Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11295Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11296Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11297Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11298Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11299Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11300@end smallexample
11301
11302@noindent
11303This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11304during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11305collect}.
11306
11307@kindex info source
11308@item info source
11309Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11310the function containing the current point of execution:
11311@itemize @bullet
11312@item
11313the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11314@item
11315the directory it was compiled in,
11316@item
11317its length, in lines,
11318@item
11319which programming language it is written in,
11320@item
11321whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11322if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11323@item
11324whether the debugging information includes information about
11325preprocessor macros.
11326@end itemize
11327
11328
11329@kindex info sources
11330@item info sources
11331Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11332debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11333have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11334
11335@kindex info functions
11336@item info functions
11337Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11338
11339@item info functions @var{regexp}
11340Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11341whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11342Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11343include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11344start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11345that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11346@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11347
11348@kindex info variables
11349@item info variables
11350Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11351outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11352
11353@item info variables @var{regexp}
11354Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11355variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11356@var{regexp}.
11357
11358@kindex info classes
11359@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11360@item info classes
11361@itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11362Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11363(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11364expression.
11365
11366@kindex info selectors
11367@item info selectors
11368@itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11369Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11370(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11371expression.
11372
11373@ignore
11374This was never implemented.
11375@kindex info methods
11376@item info methods
11377@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11378The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11379methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11380specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11381C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11382from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11383@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11384which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11385@end ignore
11386
11387@cindex reloading symbols
11388Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11389be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11390in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11391running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11392@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11393
11394@table @code
11395@kindex set symbol-reloading
11396@item set symbol-reloading on
11397Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11398object file with a particular name is seen again.
11399
11400@item set symbol-reloading off
11401Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11402same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11403running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11404should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11405may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11406several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11407name.
11408
11409@kindex show symbol-reloading
11410@item show symbol-reloading
11411Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11412@end table
11413
11414@cindex opaque data types
11415@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11416@item set opaque-type-resolution on
11417Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11418declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11419@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11420source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11421another source file. The default is on.
11422
11423A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11424the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11425
11426@item set opaque-type-resolution off
11427Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11428is printed as follows:
11429@smallexample
11430@{<no data fields>@}
11431@end smallexample
11432
11433@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11434@item show opaque-type-resolution
11435Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11436
11437@kindex maint print symbols
11438@cindex symbol dump
11439@kindex maint print psymbols
11440@cindex partial symbol dump
11441@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11442@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11443@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11444Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11445These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11446symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11447symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11448collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11449only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11450command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11451use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11452symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11453files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11454@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11455required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11456@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11457@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11458
11459@kindex maint info symtabs
11460@kindex maint info psymtabs
11461@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11462@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11463@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11464@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11465@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11466@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11467
11468List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11469structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11470given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11471copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11472structure in more detail. For example:
11473
11474@smallexample
11475(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11476@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11477 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11478 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11479 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11480 readin no
11481 fullname (null)
11482 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11483 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11484 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11485 dependencies (none)
11486 @}
11487@}
11488(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11489(@value{GDBP})
11490@end smallexample
11491@noindent
11492We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11493the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11494and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11495If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11496read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11497
11498@smallexample
11499(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11500Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11501line 1574.
11502(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11503@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11504 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11505 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11506 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11507 dirname (null)
11508 fullname (null)
11509 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11510 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11511 debugformat DWARF 2
11512 @}
11513@}
11514(@value{GDBP})
11515@end smallexample
11516@end table
11517
11518
11519@node Altering
11520@chapter Altering Execution
11521
11522Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11523find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11524correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11525experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11526program.
11527
11528For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11529locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11530address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11531
11532@menu
11533* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11534* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11535* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11536* Returning:: Returning from a function
11537* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11538* Patching:: Patching your program
11539@end menu
11540
11541@node Assignment
11542@section Assignment to Variables
11543
11544@cindex assignment
11545@cindex setting variables
11546To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11547@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11548
11549@smallexample
11550print x=4
11551@end smallexample
11552
11553@noindent
11554stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11555value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11556@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11557information on operators in supported languages.
11558
11559@kindex set variable
11560@cindex variables, setting
11561If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11562@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11563really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11564not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11565,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11566
11567If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11568appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11569variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11570to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11571program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11572a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11573command @code{set width}:
11574
11575@smallexample
11576(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11577type = double
11578(@value{GDBP}) p width
11579$4 = 13
11580(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11581Invalid syntax in expression.
11582@end smallexample
11583
11584@noindent
11585The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11586order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11587
11588@smallexample
11589(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11590@end smallexample
11591
11592Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11593with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11594@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11595your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11596to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11597the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11598
11599@smallexample
11600@group
11601(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11602type = double
11603(@value{GDBP}) p g
11604$1 = 1
11605(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11606(@value{GDBP}) p g
11607$2 = 1
11608(@value{GDBP}) r
11609The program being debugged has been started already.
11610Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11611Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11612"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11613 Invalid bfd target.
11614(@value{GDBP}) show g
11615The current BFD target is "=4".
11616@end group
11617@end smallexample
11618
11619@noindent
11620The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11621@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11622@code{g}, use
11623
11624@smallexample
11625(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11626@end smallexample
11627
11628@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11629freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11630and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11631same length or shorter.
11632@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11633@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11634
11635To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11636construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11637(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11638to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11639and representation in memory), and
11640
11641@smallexample
11642set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11643@end smallexample
11644
11645@noindent
11646stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11647
11648@node Jumping
11649@section Continuing at a Different Address
11650
11651Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11652it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11653an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11654
11655@table @code
11656@kindex jump
11657@item jump @var{linespec}
11658@itemx jump @var{location}
11659Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11660@var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11661breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11662different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11663practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11664@code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11665
11666The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11667the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11668register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11669a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11670be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11671of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11672confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11673executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11674well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11675@end table
11676
11677@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11678On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11679command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11680difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11681changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11682example,
11683
11684@smallexample
11685set $pc = 0x485
11686@end smallexample
11687
11688@noindent
11689makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11690address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11691@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11692
11693The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11694up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11695that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11696detail.
11697
11698@c @group
11699@node Signaling
11700@section Giving your Program a Signal
11701@cindex deliver a signal to a program
11702
11703@table @code
11704@kindex signal
11705@item signal @var{signal}
11706Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11707signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11708signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11709SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11710
11711Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11712giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11713a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11714@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11715signal.
11716
11717@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11718after executing the command.
11719@end table
11720@c @end group
11721
11722Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11723@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11724causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11725the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11726passes the signal directly to your program.
11727
11728
11729@node Returning
11730@section Returning from a Function
11731
11732@table @code
11733@cindex returning from a function
11734@kindex return
11735@item return
11736@itemx return @var{expression}
11737You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11738command. If you give an
11739@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11740value.
11741@end table
11742
11743When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11744(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11745discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11746be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11747
11748This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11749Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11750innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11751specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11752of functions.
11753
11754The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11755program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11756returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11757and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11758selected stack frame returns naturally.
11759
11760@node Calling
11761@section Calling Program Functions
11762
11763@table @code
11764@cindex calling functions
11765@cindex inferior functions, calling
11766@item print @var{expr}
11767Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11768@var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11769debugged.
11770
11771@kindex call
11772@item call @var{expr}
11773Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11774returned values.
11775
11776You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11777execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11778(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11779with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11780print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11781value history.
11782@end table
11783
11784It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11785@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11786the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11787in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11788
11789@table @code
11790@item set unwindonsignal
11791@kindex set unwindonsignal
11792@cindex unwind stack in called functions
11793@cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11794Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11795that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11796@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11797the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11798default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11799received.
11800
11801@item show unwindonsignal
11802@kindex show unwindonsignal
11803Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11804@value{GDBN}.
11805@end table
11806
11807@cindex weak alias functions
11808Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11809for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11810the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11811which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11812As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11813even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11814function instead.
11815
11816@node Patching
11817@section Patching Programs
11818
11819@cindex patching binaries
11820@cindex writing into executables
11821@cindex writing into corefiles
11822
11823By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11824executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11825alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11826patching your program's binary.
11827
11828If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11829explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11830want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11831repairs.
11832
11833@table @code
11834@kindex set write
11835@item set write on
11836@itemx set write off
11837If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11838core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11839off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11840
11841If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11842@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11843write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11844
11845@item show write
11846@kindex show write
11847Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11848as well as reading.
11849@end table
11850
11851@node GDB Files
11852@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11853
11854@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11855both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11856program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11857@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11858
11859@menu
11860* Files:: Commands to specify files
11861* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11862* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11863@end menu
11864
11865@node Files
11866@section Commands to Specify Files
11867
11868@cindex symbol table
11869@cindex core dump file
11870
11871You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11872way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11873@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11874Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11875
11876Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11877@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11878specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11879via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11880Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11881new files are useful.
11882
11883@table @code
11884@cindex executable file
11885@kindex file
11886@item file @var{filename}
11887Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11888symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11889executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11890directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11891@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11892directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11893to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11894and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11895
11896@cindex unlinked object files
11897@cindex patching object files
11898You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11899the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11900file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11901if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11902@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11903that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11904case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11905the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11906
11907@item file
11908@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11909has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11910
11911@kindex exec-file
11912@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11913Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11914in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11915if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11916discard information on the executable file.
11917
11918@kindex symbol-file
11919@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11920Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11921searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11922table and program to run from the same file.
11923
11924@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11925program's symbol table.
11926
11927The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11928some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11929contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11930which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11931@value{GDBN}.
11932
11933@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11934executing it once.
11935
11936When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11937understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11938generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11939other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11940Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11941using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11942optimized code.
11943
11944For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11945using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11946symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11947quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11948details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11949
11950The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11951start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11952occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11953file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11954pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11955Warnings and Messages}.)
11956
11957We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11958symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11959symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11960still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11961in stabs format.
11962
11963@kindex readnow
11964@cindex reading symbols immediately
11965@cindex symbols, reading immediately
11966@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11967@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11968You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11969tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11970load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11971entire symbol table available.
11972
11973@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11974@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11975@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11976@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11977@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11978@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11979@c files.
11980
11981@kindex core-file
11982@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11983@itemx core
11984Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11985of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11986address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11987executable file itself for other parts.
11988
11989@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11990to be used.
11991
11992Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11993under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11994wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11995the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11996(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11997
11998@kindex add-symbol-file
11999@cindex dynamic linking
12000@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
12001@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12002@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
12003The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
12004information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
12005when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
12006into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
12007address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
12008this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
12009of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
12010section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
12011@var{address} as an expression.
12012
12013The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
12014originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
12015@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
12016thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
12017instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
12018
12019@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
12020@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
12021@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
12022@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
12023@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
12024Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
12025executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
12026relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
12027information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
12028
12029@itemize @bullet
12030@item
12031the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
12032that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
12033@item
12034every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
12035been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
12036@item
12037you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
12038provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12039@end itemize
12040
12041@noindent
12042Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
12043relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
12044typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
12045important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
12046procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
12047assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
12048general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
12049relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
12050as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
12051way.
12052
12053@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
12054
12055@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
12056@cindex @code{syscall DSO}
12057@cindex load symbols from memory
12058@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
12059Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
12060object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
12061For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
12062process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
12063some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
12064evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
12065For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
12066@code{exec-file} commands in advance.
12067
12068@kindex add-shared-symbol-files
12069@kindex assf
12070@item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
12071@itemx assf @var{library-file}
12072The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
12073in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
12074alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
12075@value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
12076@value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
12077@code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
12078library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
12079@code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
12080
12081@kindex section
12082@item section @var{section} @var{addr}
12083The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
12084@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
12085exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
12086@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
12087itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
12088@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
12089their addresses.
12090
12091@kindex info files
12092@kindex info target
12093@item info files
12094@itemx info target
12095@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
12096current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
12097including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
12098use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
12099command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
12100current ones.
12101
12102@kindex maint info sections
12103@item maint info sections
12104Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
12105is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
12106displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
12107offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
12108@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
12109may be arbitrarily combined):
12110
12111@table @code
12112@item ALLOBJ
12113Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
12114@item @var{sections}
12115Display info only for named @var{sections}.
12116@item @var{section-flags}
12117Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
12118The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
12119@table @code
12120@item ALLOC
12121Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
12122Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
12123@item LOAD
12124Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
12125Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
12126@item RELOC
12127Section needs to be relocated before loading.
12128@item READONLY
12129Section cannot be modified by the child process.
12130@item CODE
12131Section contains executable code only.
12132@item DATA
12133Section contains data only (no executable code).
12134@item ROM
12135Section will reside in ROM.
12136@item CONSTRUCTOR
12137Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
12138@item HAS_CONTENTS
12139Section is not empty.
12140@item NEVER_LOAD
12141An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
12142@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
12143A notification to the linker that the section contains
12144COFF shared library information.
12145@item IS_COMMON
12146Section contains common symbols.
12147@end table
12148@end table
12149@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
12150@cindex read-only sections
12151@item set trust-readonly-sections on
12152Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12153really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12154In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12155out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12156For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12157enhancement to debugging performance.
12158
12159The default is off.
12160
12161@item set trust-readonly-sections off
12162Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12163the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12164and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12165
12166@item show trust-readonly-sections
12167Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12168@end table
12169
12170All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12171as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12172name and remembers it that way.
12173
12174@cindex shared libraries
12175@anchor{Shared Libraries}
12176@value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12177and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12178
12179On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12180shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12181
12182@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12183when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12184(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12185references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12186debugging a core file).
12187
12188On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12189automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12190
12191@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12192@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12193@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12194
12195There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12196symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12197particularly large or there are many of them.
12198
12199To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12200commands:
12201
12202@table @code
12203@kindex set auto-solib-add
12204@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12205If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12206will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12207attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12208informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12209is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12210@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12211
12212@cindex memory used for symbol tables
12213If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12214takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12215memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12216symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12217auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12218library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12219@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12220the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12221
12222@kindex show auto-solib-add
12223@item show auto-solib-add
12224Display the current autoloading mode.
12225@end table
12226
12227@cindex load shared library
12228To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12229command:
12230
12231@table @code
12232@kindex info sharedlibrary
12233@kindex info share
12234@item info share
12235@itemx info sharedlibrary
12236Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12237
12238@kindex sharedlibrary
12239@kindex share
12240@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12241@itemx share @var{regex}
12242Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12243Unix regular expression.
12244As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12245required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12246@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12247loaded.
12248
12249@item nosharedlibrary
12250@kindex nosharedlibrary
12251@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12252Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12253that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12254libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12255discarded.
12256@end table
12257
12258Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12259when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12260stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12261
12262@table @code
12263@item set stop-on-solib-events
12264@kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12265This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12266when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12267The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12268shared library.
12269
12270@item show stop-on-solib-events
12271@kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12272Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12273library events happen.
12274@end table
12275
12276Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12277configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12278host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12279copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12280not.
12281
12282@cindex where to look for shared libraries
12283For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12284libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12285may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12286to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12287
12288@table @code
12289@cindex prefix for shared library file names
12290@cindex system root, alternate
12291@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12292@kindex set sysroot
12293@item set sysroot @var{path}
12294Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12295absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12296runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12297target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12298libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12299the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12300under @var{path}.
12301
12302The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12303sysroot}.
12304
12305@cindex default system root
12306@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12307You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12308@samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12309@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12310@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12311automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12312location.
12313
12314@kindex show sysroot
12315@item show sysroot
12316Display the current shared library prefix.
12317
12318@kindex set solib-search-path
12319@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12320If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12321directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12322is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12323path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12324use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12325@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12326finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12327it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12328of shared library symbols.
12329
12330@kindex show solib-search-path
12331@item show solib-search-path
12332Display the current shared library search path.
12333@end table
12334
12335
12336@node Separate Debug Files
12337@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12338@cindex separate debugging information files
12339@cindex debugging information in separate files
12340@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12341@cindex debugging information directory, global
12342@cindex global debugging information directory
12343@cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12344@cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12345
12346@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12347file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12348@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12349Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12350than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12351information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12352install only when they need to debug a problem.
12353
12354@value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12355file:
12356
12357@itemize @bullet
12358@item
12359The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12360the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12361usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12362name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12363(e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12364debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12365@value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12366came from the same build.
12367
12368@item
12369The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12370also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12371only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12372for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12373this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12374command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12375The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12376explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12377below.
12378@end itemize
12379
12380Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12381uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12382
12383@itemize @bullet
12384@item
12385For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12386the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12387directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12388directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12389directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12390
12391@item
12392For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12393@file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12394named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12395first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12396are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12397hex characters, not 10.)
12398@end itemize
12399
12400So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12401@file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12402file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12403@code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12404@file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12405debug information files, in the indicated order:
12406
12407@itemize @minus
12408@item
12409@file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12410@item
12411@file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12412@item
12413@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12414@item
12415@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12416@end itemize
12417
12418You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12419name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12420
12421@table @code
12422
12423@kindex set debug-file-directory
12424@item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12425Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12426information files to @var{directory}.
12427
12428@kindex show debug-file-directory
12429@item show debug-file-directory
12430Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12431information files.
12432
12433@end table
12434
12435@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12436@cindex debug link sections
12437A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12438@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12439
12440@itemize
12441@item
12442A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12443a zero byte,
12444@item
12445zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12446boundary within the section, and
12447@item
12448a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12449executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12450information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12451zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12452@end itemize
12453
12454Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12455contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12456described above.
12457
12458@cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12459@cindex build ID sections
12460The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12461ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12462often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12463It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12464the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12465algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12466content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12467value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12468stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12469
12470The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12471executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12472debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12473should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12474but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12475in an ordinary executable.
12476
12477The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12478@samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12479the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12480following commands:
12481
12482@smallexample
12483@kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12484@kbd{strip -g foo}
12485@end smallexample
12486
12487@noindent
12488These commands remove the debugging
12489information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12490@file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12491two files:
12492
12493@itemize @bullet
12494@item
12495The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12496behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12497
12498@smallexample
12499@kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12500@end smallexample
12501
12502Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12503a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12504foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12505the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12506
12507@item
12508Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12509the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12510compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12511utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12512@end itemize
12513
12514@noindent
12515
12516Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12517link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12518simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12519sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12520
12521@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12522@smallexample
12523unsigned long
12524gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12525 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12526@{
12527 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12528 @{
12529 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12530 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12531 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12532 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12533 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12534 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12535 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12536 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12537 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12538 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12539 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12540 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12541 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12542 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12543 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12544 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12545 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12546 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12547 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12548 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12549 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12550 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12551 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12552 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12553 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12554 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12555 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12556 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12557 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12558 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12559 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12560 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12561 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12562 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12563 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12564 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12565 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12566 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12567 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12568 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12569 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12570 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12571 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12572 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12573 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12574 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12575 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12576 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12577 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12578 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12579 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12580 0x2d02ef8d
12581 @};
12582 unsigned char *end;
12583
12584 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12585 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12586 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12587 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12588@}
12589@end smallexample
12590
12591@noindent
12592This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12593
12594
12595@node Symbol Errors
12596@section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12597
12598While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12599such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12600output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12601they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12602debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12603about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12604only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12605times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12606to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12607complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12608Messages}).
12609
12610The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12611
12612@table @code
12613@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12614
12615The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12616(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12617error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12618in its outer scope blocks.
12619
12620@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12621the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12622may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12623function.
12624
12625@item block at @var{address} out of order
12626
12627The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12628order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12629do so.
12630
12631@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12632locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12633can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12634@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12635Messages}.)
12636
12637@item bad block start address patched
12638
12639The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12640smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12641to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12642
12643@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12644starting on the previous source line.
12645
12646@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12647
12648@cindex foo
12649Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12650larger than the size of the string table.
12651
12652@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12653name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12654with this name.
12655
12656@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12657
12658The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12659not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12660uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12661
12662@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12663This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12664are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12665debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12666on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12667and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12668
12669@item stub type has NULL name
12670
12671@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12672
12673@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12674The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12675information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12676it.
12677
12678@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12679
12680@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12681
12682@end table
12683
12684@node Targets
12685@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12686
12687@cindex debugging target
12688A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12689
12690Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12691in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12692you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12693flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12694host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12695realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12696command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12697(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12698
12699@cindex target architecture
12700It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12701architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12702one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12703command.
12704
12705@table @code
12706@kindex set architecture
12707@kindex show architecture
12708@item set architecture @var{arch}
12709This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12710value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12711supported architectures.
12712
12713@item show architecture
12714Show the current target architecture.
12715
12716@item set processor
12717@itemx processor
12718@kindex set processor
12719@kindex show processor
12720These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12721and @code{show architecture}.
12722@end table
12723
12724@menu
12725* Active Targets:: Active targets
12726* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12727* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12728@end menu
12729
12730@node Active Targets
12731@section Active Targets
12732
12733@cindex stacking targets
12734@cindex active targets
12735@cindex multiple targets
12736
12737There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12738executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12739active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12740start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12741a core file.
12742
12743For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12744@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12745well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12746@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12747first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12748requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12749are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12750read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12751executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12752
12753When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12754target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12755commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12756an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12757process target is active.
12758
12759Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12760core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12761Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12762the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12763Process}).
12764
12765@node Target Commands
12766@section Commands for Managing Targets
12767
12768@table @code
12769@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12770Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12771process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12772facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12773protocol of the target machine.
12774
12775Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12776typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12777with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12778
12779The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12780after executing the command.
12781
12782@kindex help target
12783@item help target
12784Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12785currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12786(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12787
12788@item help target @var{name}
12789Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12790select it.
12791
12792@kindex set gnutarget
12793@item set gnutarget @var{args}
12794@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12795knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12796a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12797with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12798with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12799
12800@quotation
12801@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12802you must know the actual BFD name.
12803@end quotation
12804
12805@noindent
12806@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12807
12808@kindex show gnutarget
12809@item show gnutarget
12810Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12811@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12812@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12813and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12814@end table
12815
12816@cindex common targets
12817Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12818configuration):
12819
12820@table @code
12821@kindex target
12822@item target exec @var{program}
12823@cindex executable file target
12824An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12825@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12826
12827@item target core @var{filename}
12828@cindex core dump file target
12829A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12830@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12831
12832@item target remote @var{medium}
12833@cindex remote target
12834A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12835connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12836protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12837
12838For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12839machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12840
12841@smallexample
12842target remote /dev/ttya
12843@end smallexample
12844
12845@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12846useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12847system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12848clobbered by the download.
12849
12850@item target sim
12851@cindex built-in simulator target
12852Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12853In general,
12854@smallexample
12855 target sim
12856 load
12857 run
12858@end smallexample
12859@noindent
12860works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12861drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12862provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12863see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12864Processors}.
12865
12866@end table
12867
12868Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12869
12870@table @code
12871
12872@item target nrom @var{dev}
12873@cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12874NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12875
12876@end table
12877
12878Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12879your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12880
12881Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12882you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12883various aspects of this process.
12884
12885@table @code
12886
12887@item set hash
12888@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12889@cindex hash mark while downloading
12890This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12891downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12892displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12893monitor.
12894
12895@item show hash
12896@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12897Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12898
12899@item set debug monitor
12900@kindex set debug monitor
12901@cindex display remote monitor communications
12902Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12903@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12904
12905@item show debug monitor
12906@kindex show debug monitor
12907Show the current status of displaying communications between
12908@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12909@end table
12910
12911@table @code
12912
12913@kindex load @var{filename}
12914@item load @var{filename}
12915@anchor{load}
12916Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12917@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12918is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12919on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12920@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12921the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12922
12923If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12924execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12925target is @dots{}}''
12926
12927The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12928For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12929link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12930specifies a fixed address.
12931@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12932
12933Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12934load programs into flash memory.
12935
12936@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12937@end table
12938
12939@node Byte Order
12940@section Choosing Target Byte Order
12941
12942@cindex choosing target byte order
12943@cindex target byte order
12944
12945Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12946offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12947orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12948designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12949which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12950@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12951
12952@table @code
12953@kindex set endian
12954@item set endian big
12955Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12956
12957@item set endian little
12958Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12959
12960@item set endian auto
12961Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12962executable.
12963
12964@item show endian
12965Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12966
12967@end table
12968
12969Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12970data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12971target system.
12972
12973
12974@node Remote Debugging
12975@chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12976@cindex remote debugging
12977
12978If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12979@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12980For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12981or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12982powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12983
12984Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12985to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12986@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12987but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12988write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12989communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12990
12991Other remote targets may be available in your
12992configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12993
12994@menu
12995* Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12996* File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
12997* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12998* Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12999* Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
13000@end menu
13001
13002@node Connecting
13003@section Connecting to a Remote Target
13004
13005On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
13006your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
13007Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
13008program as the first argument.
13009
13010@cindex @code{target remote}
13011@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
13012over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
13013each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
13014program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
13015@code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
13016Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
13017
13018@table @code
13019
13020@item target remote @var{serial-device}
13021@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
13022Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
13023to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
13024
13025@smallexample
13026target remote /dev/ttyb
13027@end smallexample
13028
13029If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
13030@w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
13031(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
13032@code{target} command.
13033
13034@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
13035@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13036@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
13037Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
13038The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
13039address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
13040the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
13041it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
13042target.
13043
13044For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
13045@code{manyfarms}:
13046
13047@smallexample
13048target remote manyfarms:2828
13049@end smallexample
13050
13051If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
13052debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
13053same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
13054port 1234 on your local machine:
13055
13056@smallexample
13057target remote :1234
13058@end smallexample
13059@noindent
13060
13061Note that the colon is still required here.
13062
13063@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13064@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
13065Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
13066connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
13067
13068@smallexample
13069target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
13070@end smallexample
13071
13072When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
13073keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
13074can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
13075cause havoc with your debugging session.
13076
13077@item target remote | @var{command}
13078@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
13079Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
13080pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
13081by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
13082protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
13083standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
13084that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
13085using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
13086
13087If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
13088@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
13089program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
13090
13091@end table
13092
13093Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
13094commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
13095running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
13096need to use @kbd{run}.
13097
13098@cindex interrupting remote programs
13099@cindex remote programs, interrupting
13100Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
13101interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
13102program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
13103and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
13104interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
13105
13106@smallexample
13107Interrupted while waiting for the program.
13108Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
13109@end smallexample
13110
13111If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
13112(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
13113remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
13114goes back to waiting.
13115
13116@table @code
13117@kindex detach (remote)
13118@item detach
13119When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
13120@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
13121Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
13122will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
13123command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
13124
13125@kindex disconnect
13126@item disconnect
13127The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
13128the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
13129(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
13130the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
13131another target.
13132
13133@cindex send command to remote monitor
13134@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
13135@cindex add new commands for external monitor
13136@kindex monitor
13137@item monitor @var{cmd}
13138This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
13139remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
13140sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
13141can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
13142and implement.
13143@end table
13144
13145@node File Transfer
13146@section Sending files to a remote system
13147@cindex remote target, file transfer
13148@cindex file transfer
13149@cindex sending files to remote systems
13150
13151Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
13152connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13153for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13154running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13155e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13156the only way to upload or download files.
13157
13158Not all remote targets support these commands.
13159
13160@table @code
13161@kindex remote put
13162@item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13163Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13164@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13165
13166@kindex remote get
13167@item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13168Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13169on the host system.
13170
13171@kindex remote delete
13172@item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13173Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13174
13175@end table
13176
13177@node Server
13178@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13179
13180@kindex gdbserver
13181@cindex remote connection without stubs
13182@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13183allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13184@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13185
13186@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13187because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
13188that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
13189@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
13190@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
13191because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
13192also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
13193started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
13194Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
13195the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
13196do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
13197by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
13198choice for debugging.
13199
13200@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13201or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13202protocol.
13203
13204@quotation
13205@emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13206Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13207@value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13208target system with the same privileges as the user running
13209@code{gdbserver}.
13210@end quotation
13211
13212@subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13213@cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13214
13215Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13216program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13217@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13218strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13219system does all the symbol handling.
13220
13221To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13222the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13223syntax is:
13224
13225@smallexample
13226target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13227@end smallexample
13228
13229@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13230hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13231@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13232@file{/dev/com1}:
13233
13234@smallexample
13235target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13236@end smallexample
13237
13238@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13239with it.
13240
13241To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13242
13243@smallexample
13244target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13245@end smallexample
13246
13247The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13248specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13249TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13250expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13251(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13252you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13253TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13254reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13255conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13256and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13257@code{target remote} command.
13258
13259@subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13260
13261On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13262This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13263
13264@smallexample
13265target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13266@end smallexample
13267
13268@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13269to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13270
13271@pindex pidof
13272@cindex attach to a program by name
13273You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13274@code{pidof} utility:
13275
13276@smallexample
13277target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13278@end smallexample
13279
13280In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13281has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13282@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13283
13284@subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13285@cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13286@cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13287
13288When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13289@code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13290program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13291and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13292
13293If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13294enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13295detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13296though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13297commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13298The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13299remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13300arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13301redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13302
13303To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13304or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13305Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13306the program you want to debug.
13307
13308@code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13309You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13310(@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13311
13312@subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13313
13314You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13315@code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13316process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13317for bug reports to the developers.
13318
13319The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
13320for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
13321wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
13322@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
13323
13324@code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
13325command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
13326program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
13327runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
13328
13329You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
13330its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
13331this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
13332with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
13333
13334For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
13335the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
13336environment:
13337
13338@smallexample
13339$ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
13340@end smallexample
13341
13342@subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13343
13344Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13345
13346First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13347your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13348@code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13349was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13350
13351The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13352and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13353system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13354are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13355during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13356files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13357programs.
13358
13359Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13360For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13361the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13362text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13363@samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13364command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13365already on the target.
13366
13367@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13368@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13369@anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13370
13371During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13372@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13373Here are the available commands.
13374
13375@table @code
13376@item monitor help
13377List the available monitor commands.
13378
13379@item monitor set debug 0
13380@itemx monitor set debug 1
13381Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13382
13383@item monitor set remote-debug 0
13384@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13385Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13386protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13387
13388@item monitor exit
13389Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13390@code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13391detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13392Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13393of a multi-process mode debug session.
13394
13395@end table
13396
13397@node Remote Configuration
13398@section Remote Configuration
13399
13400@kindex set remote
13401@kindex show remote
13402This section documents the configuration options available when
13403debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13404extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13405system-call-allowed}.
13406
13407@table @code
13408@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13409@cindex address size for remote targets
13410@cindex bits in remote address
13411Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13412number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13413that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13414default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13415
13416@item show remoteaddresssize
13417Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13418
13419@item set remotebaud @var{n}
13420@cindex baud rate for remote targets
13421Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13422value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13423remote targets.
13424
13425@item show remotebaud
13426Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13427
13428@item set remotebreak
13429@cindex interrupt remote programs
13430@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13431@anchor{set remotebreak}
13432If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13433when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13434on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13435character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13436expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13437
13438@item show remotebreak
13439Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13440interrupt the remote program.
13441
13442@item set remoteflow on
13443@itemx set remoteflow off
13444@kindex set remoteflow
13445Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13446on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13447
13448@item show remoteflow
13449@kindex show remoteflow
13450Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13451
13452@item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13453Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13454communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13455@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13456@code{ascii}.
13457
13458@item show remotelogbase
13459Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13460protocol.
13461
13462@item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13463@cindex record serial communications on file
13464Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13465default is not to record at all.
13466
13467@item show remotelogfile.
13468Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13469serial communications.
13470
13471@item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13472@cindex timeout for serial communications
13473@cindex remote timeout
13474Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13475@var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13476
13477@item show remotetimeout
13478Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13479responses.
13480
13481@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13482@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13483@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13484@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13485@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13486@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13487Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13488watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13489
13490@item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13491@itemx show remote exec-file
13492@anchor{set remote exec-file}
13493@cindex executable file, for remote target
13494Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13495extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13496target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13497filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13498@end table
13499
13500@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13501The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13502your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13503can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13504packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13505packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13506or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13507all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13508see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13509
13510During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13511If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13512in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13513@value{GDBN} developers.
13514
13515For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13516packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13517are:
13518
13519@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13520@item Command Name
13521@tab Remote Packet
13522@tab Related Features
13523
13524@item @code{fetch-register}
13525@tab @code{p}
13526@tab @code{info registers}
13527
13528@item @code{set-register}
13529@tab @code{P}
13530@tab @code{set}
13531
13532@item @code{binary-download}
13533@tab @code{X}
13534@tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13535
13536@item @code{read-aux-vector}
13537@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13538@tab @code{info auxv}
13539
13540@item @code{symbol-lookup}
13541@tab @code{qSymbol}
13542@tab Detecting multiple threads
13543
13544@item @code{attach}
13545@tab @code{vAttach}
13546@tab @code{attach}
13547
13548@item @code{verbose-resume}
13549@tab @code{vCont}
13550@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13551
13552@item @code{run}
13553@tab @code{vRun}
13554@tab @code{run}
13555
13556@item @code{software-breakpoint}
13557@tab @code{Z0}
13558@tab @code{break}
13559
13560@item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13561@tab @code{Z1}
13562@tab @code{hbreak}
13563
13564@item @code{write-watchpoint}
13565@tab @code{Z2}
13566@tab @code{watch}
13567
13568@item @code{read-watchpoint}
13569@tab @code{Z3}
13570@tab @code{rwatch}
13571
13572@item @code{access-watchpoint}
13573@tab @code{Z4}
13574@tab @code{awatch}
13575
13576@item @code{target-features}
13577@tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13578@tab @code{set architecture}
13579
13580@item @code{library-info}
13581@tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13582@tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13583
13584@item @code{memory-map}
13585@tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13586@tab @code{info mem}
13587
13588@item @code{read-spu-object}
13589@tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13590@tab @code{info spu}
13591
13592@item @code{write-spu-object}
13593@tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13594@tab @code{info spu}
13595
13596@item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13597@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13598@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13599
13600@item @code{search-memory}
13601@tab @code{qSearch:memory}
13602@tab @code{find}
13603
13604@item @code{supported-packets}
13605@tab @code{qSupported}
13606@tab Remote communications parameters
13607
13608@item @code{pass-signals}
13609@tab @code{QPassSignals}
13610@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13611
13612@item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13613@tab @code{vFile:close}
13614@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13615
13616@item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13617@tab @code{vFile:open}
13618@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13619
13620@item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13621@tab @code{vFile:pread}
13622@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13623
13624@item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13625@tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13626@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13627
13628@item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13629@tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13630@tab @code{remote delete}
13631@end multitable
13632
13633@node Remote Stub
13634@section Implementing a Remote Stub
13635
13636@cindex debugging stub, example
13637@cindex remote stub, example
13638@cindex stub example, remote debugging
13639The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13640communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13641@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13642these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13643implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13644with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13645organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13646
13647@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13648To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13649@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13650prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13651program, you need:
13652
13653@enumerate
13654@item
13655A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13656have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13657your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13658
13659@item
13660A C subroutine library to support your program's
13661subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13662
13663@item
13664A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13665download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13666manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13667documentation.
13668@end enumerate
13669
13670The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13671communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13672machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13673
13674@table @emph
13675@item On the host,
13676@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13677else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13678(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13679
13680@item On the target,
13681you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13682implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13683subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13684
13685On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13686@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13687@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13688@end table
13689
13690The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13691machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13692@sc{sparc} boards.
13693
13694@cindex remote serial stub list
13695These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13696
13697@table @code
13698
13699@item i386-stub.c
13700@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13701@cindex Intel
13702@cindex i386
13703For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13704
13705@item m68k-stub.c
13706@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13707@cindex Motorola 680x0
13708@cindex m680x0
13709For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13710
13711@item sh-stub.c
13712@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13713@cindex Renesas
13714@cindex SH
13715For Renesas SH architectures.
13716
13717@item sparc-stub.c
13718@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13719@cindex Sparc
13720For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13721
13722@item sparcl-stub.c
13723@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13724@cindex Fujitsu
13725@cindex SparcLite
13726For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13727
13728@end table
13729
13730The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13731recently added stubs.
13732
13733@menu
13734* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13735* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13736* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13737@end menu
13738
13739@node Stub Contents
13740@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13741
13742@cindex remote serial stub
13743The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13744subroutines:
13745
13746@table @code
13747@item set_debug_traps
13748@findex set_debug_traps
13749@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13750This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13751program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13752beginning of your program.
13753
13754@item handle_exception
13755@findex handle_exception
13756@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13757This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13758explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13759run when a trap is triggered.
13760
13761@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13762execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13763with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13764protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13765representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13766information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13767retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13768execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13769@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13770machine.
13771
13772@item breakpoint
13773@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13774Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13775breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13776way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13777machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13778pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13779@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13780simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13781again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13782your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13783@value{GDBN} session gets control.
13784
13785Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13786to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13787start of your debugging session.
13788@end table
13789
13790@node Bootstrapping
13791@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13792
13793@cindex remote stub, support routines
13794The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13795chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13796debugging target machine.
13797
13798First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13799serial port.
13800
13801@table @code
13802@item int getDebugChar()
13803@findex getDebugChar
13804Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13805It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13806different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13807
13808@item void putDebugChar(int)
13809@findex putDebugChar
13810Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13811It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13812different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13813@end table
13814
13815@cindex control C, and remote debugging
13816@cindex interrupting remote targets
13817If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13818running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13819for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13820character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13821remote system to stop.
13822
13823Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13824probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13825is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13826@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13827
13828Other routines you need to supply are:
13829
13830@table @code
13831@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13832@findex exceptionHandler
13833Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13834handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13835way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13836are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13837containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13838@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13839its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13840might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13841exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13842@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13843and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13844you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13845should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13846
13847For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13848gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13849should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13850@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13851help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13852
13853@item void flush_i_cache()
13854@findex flush_i_cache
13855On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13856instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13857instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13858
13859On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13860function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13861@end table
13862
13863@noindent
13864You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13865
13866@table @code
13867@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13868@findex memset
13869This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13870memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13871@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13872either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13873@end table
13874
13875If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13876library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13877but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13878subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13879
13880
13881@node Debug Session
13882@subsection Putting it All Together
13883
13884@cindex remote serial debugging summary
13885In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13886steps.
13887
13888@enumerate
13889@item
13890Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13891(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13892@display
13893@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13894@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13895@end display
13896
13897@item
13898Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13899
13900@smallexample
13901set_debug_traps();
13902breakpoint();
13903@end smallexample
13904
13905@item
13906For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13907@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13908
13909@smallexample
13910void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13911@end smallexample
13912
13913@noindent
13914but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13915function in your program, that function is called when
13916@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13917error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13918one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13919
13920@item
13921Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13922your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13923
13924@item
13925Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13926the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13927
13928@item
13929@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13930@c document that. FIXME.
13931Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13932whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13933
13934@item
13935Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13936(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13937
13938@end enumerate
13939
13940@node Configurations
13941@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13942
13943While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13944cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13945describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13946
13947There are three major categories of configurations: native
13948configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13949operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13950different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13951are quite different from each other.
13952
13953@menu
13954* Native::
13955* Embedded OS::
13956* Embedded Processors::
13957* Architectures::
13958@end menu
13959
13960@node Native
13961@section Native
13962
13963This section describes details specific to particular native
13964configurations.
13965
13966@menu
13967* HP-UX:: HP-UX
13968* BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13969* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13970* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13971* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13972* Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13973* Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13974@end menu
13975
13976@node HP-UX
13977@subsection HP-UX
13978
13979On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13980begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13981name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13982
13983
13984@node BSD libkvm Interface
13985@subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13986
13987@cindex libkvm
13988@cindex kernel memory image
13989@cindex kernel crash dump
13990
13991BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13992interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13993memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13994uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13995dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13996special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13997the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13998@code{kvm} target:
13999
14000@smallexample
14001(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
14002@end smallexample
14003
14004For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
14005argument:
14006
14007@smallexample
14008(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
14009@end smallexample
14010
14011Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
14012available:
14013
14014@table @code
14015@kindex kvm
14016@item kvm pcb
14017Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
14018
14019@item kvm proc
14020Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
14021modern FreeBSD systems.
14022@end table
14023
14024@node SVR4 Process Information
14025@subsection SVR4 Process Information
14026@cindex /proc
14027@cindex examine process image
14028@cindex process info via @file{/proc}
14029
14030Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
14031@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
14032process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
14033for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
14034proc} is available to report information about the process running
14035your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
14036proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
14037This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
14038Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
14039
14040@table @code
14041@kindex info proc
14042@cindex process ID
14043@item info proc
14044@itemx info proc @var{process-id}
14045Summarize available information about any running process. If a
14046process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
14047that process; otherwise display information about the program being
14048debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
14049line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
14050executable file's absolute file name.
14051
14052On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
14053@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
14054within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
14055a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
14056needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
14057a process ID rather than a thread ID).
14058
14059@item info proc mappings
14060@cindex memory address space mappings
14061Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
14062information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
14063rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
14064includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
14065memory access rights to that range.
14066
14067@item info proc stat
14068@itemx info proc status
14069@cindex process detailed status information
14070These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
14071the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
14072how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
14073the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
14074consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
14075value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
14076(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
14077
14078@item info proc all
14079Show all the information about the process described under all of the
14080above @code{info proc} subcommands.
14081
14082@ignore
14083@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
14084@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
14085@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
14086@kindex info proc times
14087@item info proc times
14088Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
14089its children.
14090
14091@kindex info proc id
14092@item info proc id
14093Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
14094the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
14095@end ignore
14096
14097@item set procfs-trace
14098@kindex set procfs-trace
14099@cindex @code{procfs} API calls
14100This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
14101
14102@item show procfs-trace
14103@kindex show procfs-trace
14104Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
14105
14106@item set procfs-file @var{file}
14107@kindex set procfs-file
14108Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
14109@var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
14110contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
14111standard output.
14112
14113@item show procfs-file
14114@kindex show procfs-file
14115Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
14116
14117@item proc-trace-entry
14118@itemx proc-trace-exit
14119@itemx proc-untrace-entry
14120@itemx proc-untrace-exit
14121@kindex proc-trace-entry
14122@kindex proc-trace-exit
14123@kindex proc-untrace-entry
14124@kindex proc-untrace-exit
14125These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
14126from the @code{syscall} interface.
14127
14128@item info pidlist
14129@kindex info pidlist
14130@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
14131For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
14132processes and all the threads within each process.
14133
14134@item info meminfo
14135@kindex info meminfo
14136@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
14137For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
14138@end table
14139
14140@node DJGPP Native
14141@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
14142@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
14143@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
14144@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
14145
14146@cindex DPMI
14147@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
14148MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
14149that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
14150top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
14151
14152@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
14153defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
14154subsection describes those commands.
14155
14156@table @code
14157@kindex info dos
14158@item info dos
14159This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
14160information about the target system and important OS structures.
14161
14162@kindex sysinfo
14163@cindex MS-DOS system info
14164@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
14165@item info dos sysinfo
14166This command displays assorted information about the underlying
14167platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
14168DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
14169
14170@cindex GDT
14171@cindex LDT
14172@cindex IDT
14173@cindex segment descriptor tables
14174@cindex descriptor tables display
14175@item info dos gdt
14176@itemx info dos ldt
14177@itemx info dos idt
14178These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
14179and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
14180tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
14181that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
14182descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
14183descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
14184rights.
14185
14186A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
14187segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
14188allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
14189conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
14190additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
14191
14192@cindex garbled pointers
14193These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
14194Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
14195displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
14196display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
14197example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
14198debugged program's data segment:
14199
14200@smallexample
14201@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
14202@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
14203@end smallexample
14204
14205@noindent
14206This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14207the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14208
14209@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14210@item info dos pde
14211@itemx info dos pte
14212These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14213Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14214data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14215into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14216page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14217may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14218Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14219that is currently in use.
14220
14221Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14222Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14223the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14224@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14225Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14226means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14227the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14228
14229@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14230These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14231Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14232controller.
14233
14234These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14235
14236@cindex physical address from linear address
14237@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14238This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14239address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14240already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14241because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14242segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14243the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14244
14245@smallexample
14246@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14247@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14248@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14249@end smallexample
14250
14251@noindent
14252This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14253whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14254attributes of that page.
14255
14256Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14257since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14258address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14259be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14260declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14261@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14262
14263Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14264transfer buffer:
14265
14266@smallexample
14267@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14268@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14269@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14270@end smallexample
14271
14272@noindent
14273(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
142743rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14275clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14276memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14277linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14278
14279This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14280@end table
14281
14282@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14283In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14284debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14285to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14286
14287@table @code
14288@kindex set com1base
14289@kindex set com1irq
14290@kindex set com2base
14291@kindex set com2irq
14292@kindex set com3base
14293@kindex set com3irq
14294@kindex set com4base
14295@kindex set com4irq
14296@item set com1base @var{addr}
14297This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14298port.
14299
14300@item set com1irq @var{irq}
14301This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14302for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14303
14304There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14305etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14306other 3 COM ports.
14307
14308@kindex show com1base
14309@kindex show com1irq
14310@kindex show com2base
14311@kindex show com2irq
14312@kindex show com3base
14313@kindex show com3irq
14314@kindex show com4base
14315@kindex show com4irq
14316The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14317display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14318lines used by the COM ports.
14319
14320@item info serial
14321@kindex info serial
14322@cindex DOS serial port status
14323This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14324port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14325IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14326counts of various errors encountered so far.
14327@end table
14328
14329
14330@node Cygwin Native
14331@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14332@cindex MS Windows debugging
14333@cindex native Cygwin debugging
14334@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14335
14336@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14337DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14338additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14339Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14340@ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14341
14342@table @code
14343@kindex info w32
14344@item info w32
14345This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14346information about the target system and important OS structures.
14347
14348@item info w32 selector
14349This command displays information returned by
14350the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14351It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14352a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14353Without argument, this command displays information
14354about the six segment registers.
14355
14356@kindex info dll
14357@item info dll
14358This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14359
14360@kindex dll-symbols
14361@item dll-symbols
14362This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14363add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14364
14365@kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14366@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14367@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14368@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14369If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14370happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14371@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14372exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14373``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14374Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14375@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14376
14377@kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14378@item show cygwin-exceptions
14379Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14380inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14381
14382@kindex set new-console
14383@item set new-console @var{mode}
14384If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14385be started in a new console on next start.
14386If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14387be started in the same console as the debugger.
14388
14389@kindex show new-console
14390@item show new-console
14391Displays whether a new console is used
14392when the debuggee is started.
14393
14394@kindex set new-group
14395@item set new-group @var{mode}
14396This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14397start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14398This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14399@samp{Ctrl-C}.
14400
14401@kindex show new-group
14402@item show new-group
14403Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14404
14405@kindex set debugevents
14406@item set debugevents
14407This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14408to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14409signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14410unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14411Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14412
14413@kindex set debugexec
14414@item set debugexec
14415This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14416(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14417
14418@kindex set debugexceptions
14419@item set debugexceptions
14420This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14421debuggee seen by the debugger.
14422
14423@kindex set debugmemory
14424@item set debugmemory
14425This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14426and writes by the debugger.
14427
14428@kindex set shell
14429@item set shell
14430This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14431via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14432
14433@kindex show shell
14434@item show shell
14435Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14436
14437@end table
14438
14439@menu
14440* Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14441@end menu
14442
14443@node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14444@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14445@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14446@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14447
14448Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14449not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14450@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14451symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14452information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14453describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14454``minimal symbols''.
14455
14456Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14457will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14458start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14459program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14460@value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14461see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14462@code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14463explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14464cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14465which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14466
14467@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14468
14469In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14470tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14471DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14472also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14473sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14474(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14475necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14476contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14477exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14478
14479Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14480though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14481symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14482some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14483@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14484(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14485
14486@smallexample
14487(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14488All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14489
14490Non-debugging symbols:
144910x77e885f4 CreateFileA
144920x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14493@end smallexample
14494
14495@smallexample
14496(@value{GDBP}) info function !
14497All functions matching regular expression "!":
14498
14499Non-debugging symbols:
145000x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
145010x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
145020x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14503[etc...]
14504@end smallexample
14505
14506@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14507
14508Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14509type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14510refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14511contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14512contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14513means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14514a function within a DLL without a running program.
14515
14516Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14517automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14518variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14519type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14520problem:
14521
14522@smallexample
14523(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14524$1 = 268572168
14525@end smallexample
14526
14527@smallexample
14528(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
145290x10021610: "\230y\""
14530@end smallexample
14531
14532And two possible solutions:
14533
14534@smallexample
14535(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14536$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14537@end smallexample
14538
14539@smallexample
14540(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
145410x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14542(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
145430x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14544(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
145450x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14546@end smallexample
14547
14548Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14549starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14550examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14551function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14552to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14553
14554@smallexample
14555(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14556Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14557@end smallexample
14558
14559The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14560break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14561safe.
14562
14563@node Hurd Native
14564@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14565@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14566
14567This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14568@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14569
14570@table @code
14571@item set signals
14572@itemx set sigs
14573@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14574@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14575This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14576@value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14577affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14578@code{signals}.
14579
14580@item show signals
14581@itemx show sigs
14582@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14583@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14584Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14585
14586@item set signal-thread
14587@itemx set sigthread
14588@kindex set signal-thread
14589@kindex set sigthread
14590This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14591thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14592process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14593signal-thread}.
14594
14595@item show signal-thread
14596@itemx show sigthread
14597@kindex show signal-thread
14598@kindex show sigthread
14599These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14600delivered a signal.
14601
14602@item set stopped
14603@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14604This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14605as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14606continued by delivering a signal to it.
14607
14608@item show stopped
14609@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14610This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14611stopped.
14612
14613@item set exceptions
14614@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14615Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14616When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14617single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14618trapping on.
14619
14620@item show exceptions
14621@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14622Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14623
14624@item set task pause
14625@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14626@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14627@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14628This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14629Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14630whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14631effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14632to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14633thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14634
14635@item show task pause
14636@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14637Show the current state of task suspension.
14638
14639@item set task detach-suspend-count
14640@cindex task suspend count
14641@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14642This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14643@value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14644
14645@item show task detach-suspend-count
14646Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14647
14648@item set task exception-port
14649@itemx set task excp
14650@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14651This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14652forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14653rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14654
14655@item set noninvasive
14656@cindex noninvasive task options
14657This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14658invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14659is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14660@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14661
14662@item info send-rights
14663@itemx info receive-rights
14664@itemx info port-rights
14665@itemx info port-sets
14666@itemx info dead-names
14667@itemx info ports
14668@itemx info psets
14669@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14670@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14671@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14672@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14673@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14674These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14675receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14676There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14677port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14678
14679@item set thread pause
14680@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14681@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14682@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14683This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14684control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14685thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14686off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14687Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14688control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14689task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14690only the current thread.
14691
14692@item show thread pause
14693@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14694This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14695
14696@item set thread run
14697This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14698
14699@item show thread run
14700Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14701
14702@item set thread detach-suspend-count
14703@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14704@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14705This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14706thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14707found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14708takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14709
14710@item show thread detach-suspend-count
14711Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14712detaching.
14713
14714@item set thread exception-port
14715@itemx set thread excp
14716Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14717overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14718@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14719
14720@item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14721Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14722value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14723changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14724
14725@item set thread default
14726@itemx show thread default
14727@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14728Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14729default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14730thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14731variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14732threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14733the non-default commands.
14734@end table
14735
14736
14737@node Neutrino
14738@subsection QNX Neutrino
14739@cindex QNX Neutrino
14740
14741@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14742Neutrino target:
14743
14744@table @code
14745@item set debug nto-debug
14746@kindex set debug nto-debug
14747When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14748Neutrino support.
14749
14750@item show debug nto-debug
14751@kindex show debug nto-debug
14752Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14753@end table
14754
14755
14756@node Embedded OS
14757@section Embedded Operating Systems
14758
14759This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14760embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14761architectures.
14762
14763@menu
14764* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14765@end menu
14766
14767@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14768various real-time operating systems.
14769
14770@node VxWorks
14771@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14772
14773@cindex VxWorks
14774
14775@table @code
14776
14777@kindex target vxworks
14778@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14779A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14780is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14781
14782@end table
14783
14784On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14785current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14786
14787@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14788VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14789the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14790both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14791@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14792installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14793@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14794
14795@table @code
14796@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14797@kindex vxworks-timeout
14798All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14799This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14800seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14801your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14802of a thin network line.
14803@end table
14804
14805The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14806this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14807procedures.
14808
14809@findex INCLUDE_RDB
14810To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14811to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14812library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14813VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14814kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14815source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14816information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14817manual.
14818@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14819
14820Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14821your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14822run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14823@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14824
14825@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14826
14827@smallexample
14828(vxgdb)
14829@end smallexample
14830
14831@menu
14832* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14833* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14834* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14835@end menu
14836
14837@node VxWorks Connection
14838@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14839
14840The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14841network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14842
14843@smallexample
14844(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14845@end smallexample
14846
14847@need 750
14848@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14849
14850@smallexample
14851Attaching remote machine across net...
14852Connected to tt.
14853@end smallexample
14854
14855@need 1000
14856@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14857loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14858these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14859path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14860to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14861
14862@smallexample
14863prog.o: No such file or directory.
14864@end smallexample
14865
14866When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14867the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14868command again.
14869
14870@node VxWorks Download
14871@subsubsection VxWorks Download
14872
14873@cindex download to VxWorks
14874If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14875object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14876@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14877incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14878command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14879to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14880table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14881the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14882filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14883Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14884to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14885the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14886@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14887and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14888program, type this on VxWorks:
14889
14890@smallexample
14891-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14892@end smallexample
14893
14894@noindent
14895Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14896
14897@smallexample
14898(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14899(vxgdb) load prog.o
14900@end smallexample
14901
14902@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14903
14904@smallexample
14905Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14906@end smallexample
14907
14908You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14909after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14910this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14911auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14912history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14913debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14914table.)
14915
14916@node VxWorks Attach
14917@subsubsection Running Tasks
14918
14919@cindex running VxWorks tasks
14920You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14921follows:
14922
14923@smallexample
14924(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14925@end smallexample
14926
14927@noindent
14928where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14929or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14930the time of attachment.
14931
14932@node Embedded Processors
14933@section Embedded Processors
14934
14935This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14936configurations.
14937
14938@cindex send command to simulator
14939Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14940allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14941
14942@table @code
14943@item sim @var{command}
14944@kindex sim@r{, a command}
14945Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14946documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14947acceptable commands.
14948@end table
14949
14950
14951@menu
14952* ARM:: ARM RDI
14953* M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14954* M68K:: Motorola M68K
14955* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14956* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14957* PA:: HP PA Embedded
14958* PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
14959* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14960* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14961* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14962* AVR:: Atmel AVR
14963* CRIS:: CRIS
14964* Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14965@end menu
14966
14967@node ARM
14968@subsection ARM
14969@cindex ARM RDI
14970
14971@table @code
14972@kindex target rdi
14973@item target rdi @var{dev}
14974ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14975use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14976monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14977
14978@kindex target rdp
14979@item target rdp @var{dev}
14980ARM Demon monitor.
14981
14982@end table
14983
14984@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14985
14986@table @code
14987@item set arm disassembler
14988@kindex set arm
14989This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14990@code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14991
14992@item show arm disassembler
14993@kindex show arm
14994Show the current disassembly style.
14995
14996@item set arm apcs32
14997@cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14998This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14999
15000@item show arm apcs32
15001Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
15002
15003@item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
15004This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
15005argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
15006
15007@table @code
15008@item auto
15009Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
15010@item softfpa
15011Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
15012processors.
15013@item fpa
15014GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
15015@item softvfp
15016Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
15017@item vfp
15018VFP co-processor.
15019@end table
15020
15021@item show arm fpu
15022Show the current type of the FPU.
15023
15024@item set arm abi
15025This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
15026
15027@item show arm abi
15028Show the currently used ABI.
15029
15030@item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15031@value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
15032whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
15033@value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
15034available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
15035use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
15036register).
15037
15038@item show arm fallback-mode
15039Show the current fallback instruction mode.
15040
15041@item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15042This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
15043instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
15044causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
15045of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
15046
15047@item show arm force-mode
15048Show the current forced instruction mode.
15049
15050@item set debug arm
15051Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
15052target support subsystem.
15053
15054@item show debug arm
15055Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
15056@end table
15057
15058The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
15059using the RDI interface:
15060
15061@table @code
15062@item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15063@kindex rdilogfile
15064@cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
15065Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
15066With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
15067no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
15068@file{rdi.log}.
15069
15070@item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
15071@kindex rdilogenable
15072Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
15073enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
15074no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
15075ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
15076are logged to a file.
15077
15078@item set rdiromatzero
15079@kindex set rdiromatzero
15080@cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
15081Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
15082vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
15083(the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
15084effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
15085
15086@item show rdiromatzero
15087@kindex show rdiromatzero
15088Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
15089
15090@item set rdiheartbeat
15091@kindex set rdiheartbeat
15092@cindex RDI heartbeat
15093Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
15094turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
15095well as the Angel monitor.
15096
15097@item show rdiheartbeat
15098@kindex show rdiheartbeat
15099Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
15100@end table
15101
15102
15103@node M32R/D
15104@subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
15105
15106@table @code
15107@kindex target m32r
15108@item target m32r @var{dev}
15109Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
15110
15111@kindex target m32rsdi
15112@item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
15113Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
15114@end table
15115
15116The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
15117
15118@table @code
15119@item set download-path @var{path}
15120@kindex set download-path
15121@cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
15122Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15123
15124@item show download-path
15125@kindex show download-path
15126Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15127
15128@item set board-address @var{addr}
15129@kindex set board-address
15130@cindex M32-EVA target board address
15131Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
15132
15133@item show board-address
15134@kindex show board-address
15135Show the current IP address of the target board.
15136
15137@item set server-address @var{addr}
15138@kindex set server-address
15139@cindex download server address (M32R)
15140Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
15141host machine.
15142
15143@item show server-address
15144@kindex show server-address
15145Display the IP address of the download server.
15146
15147@item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15148@kindex upload@r{, M32R}
15149Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
15150upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
15151executable file is uploaded.
15152
15153@item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15154@kindex tload@r{, M32R}
15155Test the @code{upload} command.
15156@end table
15157
15158The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
15159
15160@table @code
15161@item sdireset
15162@kindex sdireset
15163@cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
15164This command resets the SDI connection.
15165
15166@item sdistatus
15167@kindex sdistatus
15168This command shows the SDI connection status.
15169
15170@item debug_chaos
15171@kindex debug_chaos
15172@cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
15173Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
15174
15175@item use_debug_dma
15176@kindex use_debug_dma
15177Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
15178
15179@item use_mon_code
15180@kindex use_mon_code
15181Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
15182
15183@item use_ib_break
15184@kindex use_ib_break
15185Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
15186
15187@item use_dbt_break
15188@kindex use_dbt_break
15189Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
15190@end table
15191
15192@node M68K
15193@subsection M68k
15194
15195The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
15196target command for the following ROM monitor.
15197
15198@table @code
15199
15200@kindex target dbug
15201@item target dbug @var{dev}
15202dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
15203
15204@end table
15205
15206@node MIPS Embedded
15207@subsection MIPS Embedded
15208
15209@cindex MIPS boards
15210@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
15211MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
15212you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
15213
15214@need 1000
15215Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
15216
15217@table @code
15218@item target mips @var{port}
15219@kindex target mips @var{port}
15220To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
15221name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
15222command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
15223the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
15224been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15225download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15226
15227For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15228port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15229debugger:
15230
15231@smallexample
15232host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15233@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15234(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
15235(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
15236(@value{GDBP}) run
15237@end smallexample
15238
15239@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
15240On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
15241connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
15242concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
15243@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15244
15245@item target pmon @var{port}
15246@kindex target pmon @var{port}
15247PMON ROM monitor.
15248
15249@item target ddb @var{port}
15250@kindex target ddb @var{port}
15251NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
15252
15253@item target lsi @var{port}
15254@kindex target lsi @var{port}
15255LSI variant of PMON.
15256
15257@kindex target r3900
15258@item target r3900 @var{dev}
15259Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
15260
15261@kindex target array
15262@item target array @var{dev}
15263Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
15264
15265@end table
15266
15267
15268@noindent
15269@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
15270
15271@table @code
15272@item set mipsfpu double
15273@itemx set mipsfpu single
15274@itemx set mipsfpu none
15275@itemx set mipsfpu auto
15276@itemx show mipsfpu
15277@kindex set mipsfpu
15278@kindex show mipsfpu
15279@cindex MIPS remote floating point
15280@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
15281If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
15282coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
15283need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
15284file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
15285functions which return floating point values. It also allows
15286@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
15287functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
15288with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
15289processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
15290double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
15291@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
15292
15293In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
15294floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
15295and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15296
15297As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15298@samp{show mipsfpu}.
15299
15300@item set timeout @var{seconds}
15301@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15302@itemx show timeout
15303@itemx show retransmit-timeout
15304@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15305@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15306@kindex set timeout
15307@kindex show timeout
15308@kindex set retransmit-timeout
15309@kindex show retransmit-timeout
15310You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15311remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15312default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15313waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
15314retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15315You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15316retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15317@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15318
15319The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15320is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15321forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15322to run before stopping.
15323
15324@item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15325@kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15326@cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15327Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15328it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15329characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15330
15331@item show syn-garbage-limit
15332@kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15333Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15334trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15335
15336@item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15337@kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15338@cindex remote monitor prompt
15339Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15340remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15341@table @asis
15342@item pmon target
15343@samp{PMON}
15344@item ddb target
15345@samp{NEC010}
15346@item lsi target
15347@samp{PMON>}
15348@end table
15349
15350@item show monitor-prompt
15351@kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15352Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15353remote monitor.
15354
15355@item set monitor-warnings
15356@kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15357Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15358has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15359display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15360PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15361
15362@item show monitor-warnings
15363@kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15364Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15365
15366@item pmon @var{command}
15367@kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15368@cindex send PMON command
15369This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15370monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15371@end table
15372
15373@node OpenRISC 1000
15374@subsection OpenRISC 1000
15375@cindex OpenRISC 1000
15376
15377@cindex or1k boards
15378See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15379about platform and commands.
15380
15381@table @code
15382
15383@kindex target jtag
15384@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15385
15386Connects to remote JTAG server.
15387JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15388connected via parallel port to the board.
15389
15390Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15391
15392@kindex or1ksim
15393@item or1ksim @var{command}
15394If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15395Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15396
15397@kindex info or1k spr
15398@item info or1k spr
15399Displays spr groups.
15400
15401@item info or1k spr @var{group}
15402@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15403Displays register names in selected group.
15404
15405@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15406@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15407@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15408@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15409Shows information about specified spr register.
15410
15411@kindex spr
15412@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15413@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15414@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15415@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15416Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15417@end table
15418
15419Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15420It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15421program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15422triggers can be set using:
15423@table @code
15424@item $LEA/$LDATA
15425Load effective address/data
15426@item $SEA/$SDATA
15427Store effective address/data
15428@item $AEA/$ADATA
15429Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15430@item $FETCH
15431Fetch data
15432@end table
15433
15434When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15435@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15436
15437@code{htrace} commands:
15438@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15439@table @code
15440@kindex hwatch
15441@item hwatch @var{conditional}
15442Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15443or Data. For example:
15444
15445@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15446
15447@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15448
15449@kindex htrace
15450@item htrace info
15451Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15452
15453@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15454Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15455
15456@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15457Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15458
15459@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15460Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15461
15462@item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15463Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15464triggered.
15465
15466@item htrace enable
15467@itemx htrace disable
15468Enables/disables the HW trace.
15469
15470@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15471Clears currently recorded trace data.
15472
15473If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15474will be written there.
15475
15476@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15477Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15478
15479@item htrace mode continuous
15480Set continuous trace mode.
15481
15482@item htrace mode suspend
15483Set suspend trace mode.
15484
15485@end table
15486
15487@node PowerPC Embedded
15488@subsection PowerPC Embedded
15489
15490@value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15491
15492@table @code
15493@kindex set powerpc
15494@item set powerpc soft-float
15495@itemx show powerpc soft-float
15496Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15497convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15498on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15499
15500@item set powerpc vector-abi
15501@itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15502Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15503arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15504@samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15505@samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15506registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15507based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15508
15509@kindex target dink32
15510@item target dink32 @var{dev}
15511DINK32 ROM monitor.
15512
15513@kindex target ppcbug
15514@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15515@kindex target ppcbug1
15516@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15517PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15518
15519@kindex target sds
15520@item target sds @var{dev}
15521SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15522@end table
15523
15524@cindex SDS protocol
15525The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15526by @value{GDBN}:
15527
15528@table @code
15529@item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15530@kindex set sdstimeout
15531Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15532default is 2 seconds.
15533
15534@item show sdstimeout
15535@kindex show sdstimeout
15536Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15537
15538@item sds @var{command}
15539@kindex sds@r{, a command}
15540Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15541@end table
15542
15543
15544@node PA
15545@subsection HP PA Embedded
15546
15547@table @code
15548
15549@kindex target op50n
15550@item target op50n @var{dev}
15551OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15552
15553@kindex target w89k
15554@item target w89k @var{dev}
15555W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15556
15557@end table
15558
15559@node Sparclet
15560@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15561
15562@cindex Sparclet
15563
15564@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15565Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15566@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15567both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15568@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15569
15570@table @code
15571@item remotetimeout @var{args}
15572@kindex remotetimeout
15573@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15574This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15575seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15576@end table
15577
15578@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15579When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15580information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15581load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15582@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15583
15584@smallexample
15585sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15586@end smallexample
15587
15588You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15589
15590@smallexample
15591sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15592@end smallexample
15593
15594@cindex running, on Sparclet
15595Once you have set
15596your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15597run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15598(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15599
15600@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15601
15602@smallexample
15603(gdbslet)
15604@end smallexample
15605
15606@menu
15607* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15608* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15609* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15610* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15611@end menu
15612
15613@node Sparclet File
15614@subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15615
15616The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15617
15618@smallexample
15619(gdbslet) file prog
15620@end smallexample
15621
15622@need 1000
15623@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15624@value{GDBN} locates
15625the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15626path.
15627If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15628files will be searched as well.
15629@value{GDBN} locates
15630the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15631path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15632If it fails
15633to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15634
15635@smallexample
15636prog: No such file or directory.
15637@end smallexample
15638
15639When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15640the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15641@code{target} command again.
15642
15643@node Sparclet Connection
15644@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15645
15646The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15647To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15648
15649@smallexample
15650(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15651Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15652main () at ../prog.c:3
15653@end smallexample
15654
15655@need 750
15656@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15657
15658@smallexample
15659Connected to ttya.
15660@end smallexample
15661
15662@node Sparclet Download
15663@subsubsection Sparclet Download
15664
15665@cindex download to Sparclet
15666Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15667you can use the @value{GDBN}
15668@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15669The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15670command.
15671Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15672address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15673offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15674of each of the file's sections.
15675For instance, if the program
15676@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15677and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15678
15679@smallexample
15680(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15681Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15682@end smallexample
15683
15684If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15685to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15686to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15687
15688@node Sparclet Execution
15689@subsubsection Running and Debugging
15690
15691@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15692You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15693commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15694manual for the list of commands.
15695
15696@smallexample
15697(gdbslet) b main
15698Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15699(gdbslet) run
15700Starting program: prog
15701Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
157023 char *symarg = 0;
15703(gdbslet) step
157044 char *execarg = "hello!";
15705(gdbslet)
15706@end smallexample
15707
15708@node Sparclite
15709@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15710
15711@table @code
15712
15713@kindex target sparclite
15714@item target sparclite @var{dev}
15715Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15716You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15717For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15718remote protocol.
15719
15720@end table
15721
15722@node Z8000
15723@subsection Zilog Z8000
15724
15725@cindex Z8000
15726@cindex simulator, Z8000
15727@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15728
15729When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15730a Z8000 simulator.
15731
15732For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15733unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15734segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15735appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15736
15737@table @code
15738@item target sim @var{args}
15739@kindex sim
15740@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15741Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15742options, specify them via @var{args}.
15743@end table
15744
15745@noindent
15746After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15747CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15748@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15749to run your program, and so on.
15750
15751As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15752(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15753additional items of information as specially named registers:
15754
15755@table @code
15756
15757@item cycles
15758Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15759
15760@item insts
15761Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15762
15763@item time
15764Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15765
15766@end table
15767
15768You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15769conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15770conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15771simulated clock ticks.
15772
15773@node AVR
15774@subsection Atmel AVR
15775@cindex AVR
15776
15777When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15778following AVR-specific commands:
15779
15780@table @code
15781@item info io_registers
15782@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15783@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15784This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15785each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15786@end table
15787
15788@node CRIS
15789@subsection CRIS
15790@cindex CRIS
15791
15792When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15793following CRIS-specific commands:
15794
15795@table @code
15796@item set cris-version @var{ver}
15797@cindex CRIS version
15798Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15799The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15800case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15801
15802@item show cris-version
15803Show the current CRIS version.
15804
15805@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15806@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15807Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15808Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15809@code{R59}.
15810
15811@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15812Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15813
15814@item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15815@cindex CRIS mode
15816Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15817debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15818@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15819
15820@item show cris-mode
15821Show the current CRIS mode.
15822@end table
15823
15824@node Super-H
15825@subsection Renesas Super-H
15826@cindex Super-H
15827
15828For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15829commands:
15830
15831@table @code
15832@item regs
15833@kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15834Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15835
15836@item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
15837@kindex set sh calling-convention
15838Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
15839Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
15840With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
15841convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
15842that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
15843is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
15844is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
15845regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
15846default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
15847does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
15848
15849@item show sh calling-convention
15850@kindex show sh calling-convention
15851Show the current calling convention setting.
15852
15853@end table
15854
15855
15856@node Architectures
15857@section Architectures
15858
15859This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15860all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15861
15862@menu
15863* i386::
15864* A29K::
15865* Alpha::
15866* MIPS::
15867* HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15868* SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15869* PowerPC::
15870@end menu
15871
15872@node i386
15873@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15874
15875@table @code
15876@item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15877@kindex set struct-convention
15878@cindex struct return convention
15879@cindex struct/union returned in registers
15880Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15881@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15882@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15883default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15884are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15885@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15886be returned in a register.
15887
15888@item show struct-convention
15889@kindex show struct-convention
15890Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15891from functions.
15892@end table
15893
15894@node A29K
15895@subsection A29K
15896
15897@table @code
15898
15899@kindex set rstack_high_address
15900@cindex AMD 29K register stack
15901@cindex register stack, AMD29K
15902@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15903On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15904@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15905extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15906stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15907memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15908this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15909the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15910address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15911hexadecimal.
15912
15913@kindex show rstack_high_address
15914@item show rstack_high_address
15915Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15916processors.
15917
15918@end table
15919
15920@node Alpha
15921@subsection Alpha
15922
15923See the following section.
15924
15925@node MIPS
15926@subsection MIPS
15927
15928@cindex stack on Alpha
15929@cindex stack on MIPS
15930@cindex Alpha stack
15931@cindex MIPS stack
15932Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15933sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15934find the beginning of a function.
15935
15936@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15937To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15938@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15939you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15940commands:
15941
15942@table @code
15943@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15944@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15945Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15946search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15947default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15948larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15949and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15950this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15951
15952@item show heuristic-fence-post
15953Display the current limit.
15954@end table
15955
15956@noindent
15957These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15958for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15959
15960Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15961programs:
15962
15963@table @code
15964@item set mips abi @var{arg}
15965@kindex set mips abi
15966@cindex set ABI for MIPS
15967Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15968values of @var{arg} are:
15969
15970@table @samp
15971@item auto
15972The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15973default).
15974@item o32
15975@item o64
15976@item n32
15977@item n64
15978@item eabi32
15979@item eabi64
15980@item auto
15981@end table
15982
15983@item show mips abi
15984@kindex show mips abi
15985Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15986
15987@item set mipsfpu
15988@itemx show mipsfpu
15989@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15990
15991@item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15992@kindex set mips mask-address
15993@cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15994This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15995MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15996@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15997setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15998
15999@item show mips mask-address
16000@kindex show mips mask-address
16001Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
16002not.
16003
16004@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16005@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16006This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
16007transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
16008that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
16009and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
16010
16011@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16012@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16013Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
16014
16015@item set debug mips
16016@kindex set debug mips
16017This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
16018target code in @value{GDBN}.
16019
16020@item show debug mips
16021@kindex show debug mips
16022Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
16023@end table
16024
16025
16026@node HPPA
16027@subsection HPPA
16028@cindex HPPA support
16029
16030When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
16031following special commands:
16032
16033@table @code
16034@item set debug hppa
16035@kindex set debug hppa
16036This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
16037messages are to be displayed.
16038
16039@item show debug hppa
16040Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
16041
16042@item maint print unwind @var{address}
16043@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
16044This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
16045given @var{address}.
16046
16047@end table
16048
16049
16050@node SPU
16051@subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16052@cindex Cell Broadband Engine
16053@cindex SPU
16054
16055When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
16056it provides the following special commands:
16057
16058@table @code
16059@item info spu event
16060@kindex info spu
16061Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
16062and pending event status.
16063
16064@item info spu signal
16065Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
16066signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
16067notification channels.
16068
16069@item info spu mailbox
16070Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
16071in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
16072SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
16073
16074@item info spu dma
16075Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16076DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16077and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16078
16079@item info spu proxydma
16080Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16081Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16082and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16083
16084@end table
16085
16086@node PowerPC
16087@subsection PowerPC
16088@cindex PowerPC architecture
16089
16090When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
16091pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
16092numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
16093in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
16094@code{f0} or @code{f2}.
16095
16096The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
16097by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
16098@code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
16099
16100
16101@node Controlling GDB
16102@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
16103
16104You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
16105@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
16106data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
16107described here.
16108
16109@menu
16110* Prompt:: Prompt
16111* Editing:: Command editing
16112* Command History:: Command history
16113* Screen Size:: Screen size
16114* Numbers:: Numbers
16115* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
16116* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
16117* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
16118@end menu
16119
16120@node Prompt
16121@section Prompt
16122
16123@cindex prompt
16124
16125@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
16126called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
16127can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
16128instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
16129the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
16130which one you are talking to.
16131
16132@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
16133prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
16134or a prompt that does not.
16135
16136@table @code
16137@kindex set prompt
16138@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
16139Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
16140
16141@kindex show prompt
16142@item show prompt
16143Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
16144@end table
16145
16146@node Editing
16147@section Command Editing
16148@cindex readline
16149@cindex command line editing
16150
16151@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
16152@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
16153command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
16154or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
16155substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
16156debugging sessions.
16157
16158You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
16159command @code{set}.
16160
16161@table @code
16162@kindex set editing
16163@cindex editing
16164@item set editing
16165@itemx set editing on
16166Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
16167
16168@item set editing off
16169Disable command line editing.
16170
16171@kindex show editing
16172@item show editing
16173Show whether command line editing is enabled.
16174@end table
16175
16176@xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
16177interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
16178encouraged to read that chapter.
16179
16180@node Command History
16181@section Command History
16182@cindex command history
16183
16184@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
16185debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
16186happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
16187history facility.
16188
16189@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
16190package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
16191Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
16192
16193To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
16194the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
16195(@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
16196means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
16197affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
16198pressed on a line by itself.
16199
16200@cindex @code{server}, command prefix
16201The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
16202history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
16203use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
16204
16205Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
16206history.
16207
16208@table @code
16209@cindex history substitution
16210@cindex history file
16211@kindex set history filename
16212@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
16213@item set history filename @var{fname}
16214Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
16215This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
16216list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
16217exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
16218the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
16219to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
16220@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
16221is not set.
16222
16223@cindex save command history
16224@kindex set history save
16225@item set history save
16226@itemx set history save on
16227Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
16228@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
16229
16230@item set history save off
16231Stop recording command history in a file.
16232
16233@cindex history size
16234@kindex set history size
16235@cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
16236@item set history size @var{size}
16237Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
16238This defaults to the value of the environment variable
16239@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
16240@end table
16241
16242History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
16243@xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
16244
16245@cindex history expansion, turn on/off
16246Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
16247is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
16248@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
16249follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
16250a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
16251history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
16252@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
16253
16254The commands to control history expansion are:
16255
16256@table @code
16257@item set history expansion on
16258@itemx set history expansion
16259@kindex set history expansion
16260Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
16261
16262@item set history expansion off
16263Disable history expansion.
16264
16265@c @group
16266@kindex show history
16267@item show history
16268@itemx show history filename
16269@itemx show history save
16270@itemx show history size
16271@itemx show history expansion
16272These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
16273@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
16274@c @end group
16275@end table
16276
16277@table @code
16278@kindex show commands
16279@cindex show last commands
16280@cindex display command history
16281@item show commands
16282Display the last ten commands in the command history.
16283
16284@item show commands @var{n}
16285Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
16286
16287@item show commands +
16288Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
16289@end table
16290
16291@node Screen Size
16292@section Screen Size
16293@cindex size of screen
16294@cindex pauses in output
16295
16296Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
16297information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
16298@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
16299output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
16300to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
16301determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
16302printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
16303rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
16304
16305Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
16306driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
16307together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
16308@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
16309you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
16310width} commands:
16311
16312@table @code
16313@kindex set height
16314@kindex set width
16315@kindex show width
16316@kindex show height
16317@item set height @var{lpp}
16318@itemx show height
16319@itemx set width @var{cpl}
16320@itemx show width
16321These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
16322a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
16323commands display the current settings.
16324
16325If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
16326output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
16327file or to an editor buffer.
16328
16329Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16330from wrapping its output.
16331
16332@item set pagination on
16333@itemx set pagination off
16334@kindex set pagination
16335Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16336pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16337
16338@item show pagination
16339@kindex show pagination
16340Show the current pagination mode.
16341@end table
16342
16343@node Numbers
16344@section Numbers
16345@cindex number representation
16346@cindex entering numbers
16347
16348You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16349@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16350@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16351begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16352@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
1635310; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16354format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16355both input and output with the commands described below.
16356
16357@table @code
16358@kindex set input-radix
16359@item set input-radix @var{base}
16360Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16361for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16362specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16363example, any of
16364
16365@smallexample
16366set input-radix 012
16367set input-radix 10.
16368set input-radix 0xa
16369@end smallexample
16370
16371@noindent
16372sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16373leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16374@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16375interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16376@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16377change the radix.
16378
16379@kindex set output-radix
16380@item set output-radix @var{base}
16381Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16382for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16383specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16384
16385@kindex show input-radix
16386@item show input-radix
16387Display the current default base for numeric input.
16388
16389@kindex show output-radix
16390@item show output-radix
16391Display the current default base for numeric display.
16392
16393@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16394@itemx show radix
16395@kindex set radix
16396@kindex show radix
16397These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16398of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16399the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16400default value of 10.
16401
16402@end table
16403
16404@node ABI
16405@section Configuring the Current ABI
16406
16407@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16408application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16409conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16410current ABI.
16411
16412@cindex OS ABI
16413@kindex set osabi
16414@kindex show osabi
16415
16416One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16417system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16418@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16419but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16420One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16421an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16422not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16423platform provides.
16424
16425@table @code
16426@item show osabi
16427Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16428
16429@item set osabi
16430With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16431
16432@item set osabi @var{abi}
16433Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16434@end table
16435
16436@cindex float promotion
16437
16438Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16439function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16440(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16441according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16442(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16443@code{double} and then passed.
16444
16445Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16446a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16447as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16448
16449@table @code
16450@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16451@item set coerce-float-to-double
16452@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16453Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16454to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16455
16456@item set coerce-float-to-double off
16457Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16458functions.
16459
16460@kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16461@item show coerce-float-to-double
16462Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16463@end table
16464
16465@kindex set cp-abi
16466@kindex show cp-abi
16467@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16468objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16469used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16470programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16471multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16472program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16473Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16474before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16475``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16476use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16477``auto''.
16478
16479@table @code
16480@item show cp-abi
16481Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16482
16483@item set cp-abi
16484With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16485
16486@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16487@itemx set cp-abi auto
16488Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16489@end table
16490
16491@node Messages/Warnings
16492@section Optional Warnings and Messages
16493
16494@cindex verbose operation
16495@cindex optional warnings
16496By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16497running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16498command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16499internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16500
16501Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16502which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16503see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16504
16505@table @code
16506@kindex set verbose
16507@item set verbose on
16508Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16509
16510@item set verbose off
16511Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16512
16513@kindex show verbose
16514@item show verbose
16515Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16516@end table
16517
16518By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16519object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16520find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16521Symbol Files}).
16522
16523@table @code
16524
16525@kindex set complaints
16526@item set complaints @var{limit}
16527Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16528unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16529@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16530to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16531
16532@kindex show complaints
16533@item show complaints
16534Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16535
16536@end table
16537
16538By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16539lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16540you try to run a program which is already running:
16541
16542@smallexample
16543(@value{GDBP}) run
16544The program being debugged has been started already.
16545Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16546@end smallexample
16547
16548If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16549commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16550
16551@table @code
16552
16553@kindex set confirm
16554@cindex flinching
16555@cindex confirmation
16556@cindex stupid questions
16557@item set confirm off
16558Disables confirmation requests.
16559
16560@item set confirm on
16561Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16562
16563@kindex show confirm
16564@item show confirm
16565Displays state of confirmation requests.
16566
16567@end table
16568
16569@cindex command tracing
16570If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16571useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16572printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16573quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16574
16575@table @code
16576@kindex set trace-commands
16577@cindex command scripts, debugging
16578@item set trace-commands on
16579Enable command tracing.
16580@item set trace-commands off
16581Disable command tracing.
16582@item show trace-commands
16583Display the current state of command tracing.
16584@end table
16585
16586@node Debugging Output
16587@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16588@cindex optional debugging messages
16589
16590@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16591various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16592interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16593section documents those commands.
16594
16595@table @code
16596@kindex set exec-done-display
16597@item set exec-done-display
16598Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16599completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16600asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16601@kindex show exec-done-display
16602@item show exec-done-display
16603Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16604notification.
16605@kindex set debug
16606@cindex gdbarch debugging info
16607@cindex architecture debugging info
16608@item set debug arch
16609Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16610@kindex show debug
16611@item show debug arch
16612Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16613@item set debug aix-thread
16614@cindex AIX threads
16615Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16616module.
16617@item show debug aix-thread
16618Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16619@item set debug displaced
16620@cindex displaced stepping debugging info
16621Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
16622displaced stepping support. The default is off.
16623@item show debug displaced
16624Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
16625related to displaced stepping.
16626@item set debug event
16627@cindex event debugging info
16628Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16629default is off.
16630@item show debug event
16631Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16632info.
16633@item set debug expression
16634@cindex expression debugging info
16635Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16636expression parsing. The default is off.
16637@item show debug expression
16638Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16639@value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16640@item set debug frame
16641@cindex frame debugging info
16642Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16643default is off.
16644@item show debug frame
16645Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16646info.
16647@item set debug infrun
16648@cindex inferior debugging info
16649Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16650The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16651for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16652@item show debug infrun
16653Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16654@item set debug lin-lwp
16655@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16656@cindex Linux lightweight processes
16657Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16658@item show debug lin-lwp
16659Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16660@item set debug lin-lwp-async
16661@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
16662@cindex Linux lightweight processes
16663Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
16664@item show debug lin-lwp-async
16665Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
16666@item set debug observer
16667@cindex observer debugging info
16668Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16669includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16670@item show debug observer
16671Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16672@item set debug overload
16673@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16674Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16675info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16676is off.
16677@item show debug overload
16678Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16679debugging info.
16680@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16681@cindex serial connections, debugging
16682@cindex debug remote protocol
16683@cindex remote protocol debugging
16684@cindex display remote packets
16685@item set debug remote
16686Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16687the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16688@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16689@item show debug remote
16690Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16691@item set debug serial
16692Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16693default is off.
16694@item show debug serial
16695Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16696info.
16697@item set debug solib-frv
16698@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16699Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16700@item show debug solib-frv
16701Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16702messages.
16703@item set debug target
16704@cindex target debugging info
16705Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16706includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16707default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16708value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16709until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16710@item show debug target
16711Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16712info.
16713@item set debug timestamp
16714@cindex timestampping debugging info
16715Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
16716When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
16717message.
16718@item show debug timestamp
16719Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
16720debugging info.
16721@item set debugvarobj
16722@cindex variable object debugging info
16723Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16724info. The default is off.
16725@item show debugvarobj
16726Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16727debugging info.
16728@item set debug xml
16729@cindex XML parser debugging
16730Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16731@item show debug xml
16732Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16733@end table
16734
16735@node Sequences
16736@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16737
16738Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16739Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16740commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16741files.
16742
16743@menu
16744* Define:: How to define your own commands
16745* Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16746* Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16747* Output:: Commands for controlled output
16748@end menu
16749
16750@node Define
16751@section User-defined Commands
16752
16753@cindex user-defined command
16754@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16755A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16756which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16757@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16758separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16759via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16760
16761@smallexample
16762define adder
16763 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16764end
16765@end smallexample
16766
16767@noindent
16768To execute the command use:
16769
16770@smallexample
16771adder 1 2 3
16772@end smallexample
16773
16774@noindent
16775This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16776its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16777reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16778functions calls.
16779
16780@cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16781@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16782In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16783been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16784
16785@smallexample
16786define adder
16787 if $argc == 2
16788 print $arg0 + $arg1
16789 end
16790 if $argc == 3
16791 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16792 end
16793end
16794@end smallexample
16795
16796@table @code
16797
16798@kindex define
16799@item define @var{commandname}
16800Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16801by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16802
16803The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16804which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16805commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16806
16807@kindex document
16808@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16809@item document @var{commandname}
16810Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16811accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16812defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16813reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16814After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16815@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16816
16817You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16818documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16819does not change the documentation.
16820
16821@kindex dont-repeat
16822@cindex don't repeat command
16823@item dont-repeat
16824Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16825command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16826(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16827
16828@kindex help user-defined
16829@item help user-defined
16830List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16831(if any) for each.
16832
16833@kindex show user
16834@item show user
16835@itemx show user @var{commandname}
16836Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16837not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16838definitions for all user-defined commands.
16839
16840@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16841@kindex show max-user-call-depth
16842@kindex set max-user-call-depth
16843@item show max-user-call-depth
16844@itemx set max-user-call-depth
16845The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16846levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16847infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16848@end table
16849
16850In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16851use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16852
16853When user-defined commands are executed, the
16854commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16855stops execution of the user-defined command.
16856
16857If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16858without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16859commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16860messages when used in a user-defined command.
16861
16862@node Hooks
16863@section User-defined Command Hooks
16864@cindex command hooks
16865@cindex hooks, for commands
16866@cindex hooks, pre-command
16867
16868@kindex hook
16869You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16870command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16871command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16872before that command.
16873
16874@cindex hooks, post-command
16875@kindex hookpost
16876A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16877Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16878@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16879that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16880pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16881
16882It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16883occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16884
16885@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16886@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16887
16888@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16889In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16890(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16891execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16892displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16893
16894For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16895single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16896you could define:
16897
16898@smallexample
16899define hook-stop
16900handle SIGALRM nopass
16901end
16902
16903define hook-run
16904handle SIGALRM pass
16905end
16906
16907define hook-continue
16908handle SIGALRM pass
16909end
16910@end smallexample
16911
16912As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16913command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16914you could define:
16915
16916@smallexample
16917define hook-echo
16918echo <<<---
16919end
16920
16921define hookpost-echo
16922echo --->>>\n
16923end
16924
16925(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16926<<<---Hello World--->>>
16927(@value{GDBP})
16928
16929@end smallexample
16930
16931You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16932not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16933name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16934@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16935@c or not?
16936If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16937@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16938(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16939
16940If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16941get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16942
16943@node Command Files
16944@section Command Files
16945
16946@cindex command files
16947@cindex scripting commands
16948A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16949@value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16950also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16951does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16952terminal.
16953
16954You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16955command:
16956
16957@table @code
16958@kindex source
16959@cindex execute commands from a file
16960@item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16961Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16962@end table
16963
16964The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16965unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16966@emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16967printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16968execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16969
16970@value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16971on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16972
16973If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16974each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16975@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16976
16977Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16978without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16979normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16980when called from command files.
16981
16982@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16983mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16984standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16985not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16986the next command.
16987
16988@smallexample
16989gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16990@end smallexample
16991
16992(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16993will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16994would be directed to @file{log}.
16995
16996Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16997commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16998complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16999variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
17000built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
17001deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
17002complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
17003conditionally, etc.
17004
17005@table @code
17006@kindex if
17007@kindex else
17008@item if
17009@itemx else
17010This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
17011commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
17012expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
17013are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
17014There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
17015of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
17016end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17017
17018@kindex while
17019@item while
17020This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
17021@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
17022to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
17023line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
17024@dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
17025executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
17026
17027@kindex loop_break
17028@item loop_break
17029This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
17030Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
17031line.
17032
17033@kindex loop_continue
17034@item loop_continue
17035This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
17036in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
17037branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
17038the controlling expression.
17039
17040@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
17041@item end
17042Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
17043@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
17044@end table
17045
17046
17047@node Output
17048@section Commands for Controlled Output
17049
17050During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
17051@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
17052explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
17053describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
17054want.
17055
17056@table @code
17057@kindex echo
17058@item echo @var{text}
17059@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
17060@c because it is not in ANSI.
17061Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
17062@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
17063newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
17064In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
17065by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
17066string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
17067trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
17068To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
17069@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
17070
17071A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
17072the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
17073
17074@smallexample
17075echo This is some text\n\
17076which is continued\n\
17077onto several lines.\n
17078@end smallexample
17079
17080produces the same output as
17081
17082@smallexample
17083echo This is some text\n
17084echo which is continued\n
17085echo onto several lines.\n
17086@end smallexample
17087
17088@kindex output
17089@item output @var{expression}
17090Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
17091newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
17092value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
17093on expressions.
17094
17095@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
17096Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
17097the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
17098Formats}, for more information.
17099
17100@kindex printf
17101@item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
17102Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
17103the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
17104@var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
17105which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
17106specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
17107executing the code below:
17108
17109@smallexample
17110printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
17111@end smallexample
17112
17113As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
17114are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
17115by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
17116evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
17117style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
17118printed.
17119
17120For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
17121
17122@smallexample
17123printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
17124@end smallexample
17125
17126@code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
17127specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
17128character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
17129
17130@itemize @bullet
17131@item
17132The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
17133
17134@item
17135The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
17136width.
17137
17138@item
17139The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
17140@code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
17141
17142@item
17143The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
17144supported.
17145
17146@item
17147The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
17148
17149@item
17150The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
17151@end itemize
17152
17153@noindent
17154Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
17155underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
17156the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
17157supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
17158
17159As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
17160sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
17161@samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
17162single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
17163supported.
17164
17165Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
17166(@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
17167together with a floating point specifier.
17168letters:
17169
17170@itemize @bullet
17171@item
17172@samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
17173
17174@item
17175@samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
17176
17177@item
17178@samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
17179@end itemize
17180
17181If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
17182support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
17183such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
17184
17185In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
17186available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
17187
17188Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
17189@smallexample
17190printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
17191@end smallexample
17192
17193@end table
17194
17195@node Interpreters
17196@chapter Command Interpreters
17197@cindex command interpreters
17198
17199@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
17200infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
17201between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
17202
17203@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
17204interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
17205and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
17206describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
17207
17208By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
17209However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
17210interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
17211startup options. Defined interpreters include:
17212
17213@table @code
17214@item console
17215@cindex console interpreter
17216The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
17217used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
17218@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
17219
17220@item mi
17221@cindex mi interpreter
17222The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
17223by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
17224or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
17225Interface}.
17226
17227@item mi2
17228@cindex mi2 interpreter
17229The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
17230
17231@item mi1
17232@cindex mi1 interpreter
17233The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
17234
17235@end table
17236
17237@cindex invoke another interpreter
17238The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
17239switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
17240precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
17241enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
17242@value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
17243the IDE inoperable!
17244
17245@kindex interpreter-exec
17246Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
17247commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
17248command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
17249@code{interpreter-exec} command:
17250
17251@smallexample
17252interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
17253@end smallexample
17254
17255@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
17256@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
17257
17258@node TUI
17259@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
17260@cindex TUI
17261@cindex Text User Interface
17262
17263@menu
17264* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
17265* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
17266* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
17267* TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
17268* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
17269@end menu
17270
17271The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
17272interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
17273file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
17274commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
17275on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
17276is available.
17277
17278@pindex @value{GDBTUI}
17279The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
17280either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
17281You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
17282using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
17283@xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
17284
17285@node TUI Overview
17286@section TUI Overview
17287
17288In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
17289
17290@table @emph
17291@item command
17292This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
17293prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
17294managed using readline.
17295
17296@item source
17297The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
17298line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
17299
17300@item assembly
17301The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
17302
17303@item register
17304This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
17305when their values change.
17306@end table
17307
17308The source and assembly windows show the current program position
17309by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
17310Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
17311indicates the breakpoint type:
17312
17313@table @code
17314@item B
17315Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17316
17317@item b
17318Breakpoint which was never hit.
17319
17320@item H
17321Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17322
17323@item h
17324Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
17325@end table
17326
17327The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
17328
17329@table @code
17330@item +
17331Breakpoint is enabled.
17332
17333@item -
17334Breakpoint is disabled.
17335@end table
17336
17337The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
17338thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
17339changes.
17340
17341These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
17342window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
17343layouts:
17344
17345@itemize @bullet
17346@item
17347source only,
17348
17349@item
17350assembly only,
17351
17352@item
17353source and assembly,
17354
17355@item
17356source and registers, or
17357
17358@item
17359assembly and registers.
17360@end itemize
17361
17362A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17363
17364@table @emph
17365@item target
17366Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
17367(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17368
17369@item process
17370Gives the current process or thread number.
17371When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
17372
17373@item function
17374Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
17375The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
17376When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
17377the string @code{??} is displayed.
17378
17379@item line
17380Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
17381When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
17382
17383@item pc
17384Indicates the current program counter address.
17385@end table
17386
17387@node TUI Keys
17388@section TUI Key Bindings
17389@cindex TUI key bindings
17390
17391The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
17392(@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
17393are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
17394
17395@table @kbd
17396@kindex C-x C-a
17397@item C-x C-a
17398@kindex C-x a
17399@itemx C-x a
17400@kindex C-x A
17401@itemx C-x A
17402Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
17403the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
17404its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
17405the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
17406The screen is then refreshed.
17407
17408@kindex C-x 1
17409@item C-x 1
17410Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
17411either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
17412is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
17413
17414Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
17415
17416@kindex C-x 2
17417@item C-x 2
17418Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
17419layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
17420When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
17421previous layout and the new one.
17422
17423Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17424
17425@kindex C-x o
17426@item C-x o
17427Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17428(like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17429gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17430
17431Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17432
17433@kindex C-x s
17434@item C-x s
17435Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17436keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17437@end table
17438
17439The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17440
17441@table @asis
17442@kindex PgUp
17443@item @key{PgUp}
17444Scroll the active window one page up.
17445
17446@kindex PgDn
17447@item @key{PgDn}
17448Scroll the active window one page down.
17449
17450@kindex Up
17451@item @key{Up}
17452Scroll the active window one line up.
17453
17454@kindex Down
17455@item @key{Down}
17456Scroll the active window one line down.
17457
17458@kindex Left
17459@item @key{Left}
17460Scroll the active window one column left.
17461
17462@kindex Right
17463@item @key{Right}
17464Scroll the active window one column right.
17465
17466@kindex C-L
17467@item @kbd{C-L}
17468Refresh the screen.
17469@end table
17470
17471Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17472are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17473window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17474other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17475and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17476
17477@node TUI Single Key Mode
17478@section TUI Single Key Mode
17479@cindex TUI single key mode
17480
17481The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17482frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17483switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17484
17485@table @kbd
17486@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17487@item c
17488continue
17489
17490@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17491@item d
17492down
17493
17494@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17495@item f
17496finish
17497
17498@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17499@item n
17500next
17501
17502@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17503@item q
17504exit the SingleKey mode.
17505
17506@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17507@item r
17508run
17509
17510@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17511@item s
17512step
17513
17514@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17515@item u
17516up
17517
17518@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17519@item v
17520info locals
17521
17522@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17523@item w
17524where
17525@end table
17526
17527Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17528The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17529it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17530with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17531SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17532this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17533
17534
17535@node TUI Commands
17536@section TUI-specific Commands
17537@cindex TUI commands
17538
17539The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17540These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17541the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17542of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17543
17544@table @code
17545@item info win
17546@kindex info win
17547List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17548
17549@item layout next
17550@kindex layout
17551Display the next layout.
17552
17553@item layout prev
17554Display the previous layout.
17555
17556@item layout src
17557Display the source window only.
17558
17559@item layout asm
17560Display the assembly window only.
17561
17562@item layout split
17563Display the source and assembly window.
17564
17565@item layout regs
17566Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17567
17568@item focus next
17569@kindex focus
17570Make the next window active for scrolling.
17571
17572@item focus prev
17573Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17574
17575@item focus src
17576Make the source window active for scrolling.
17577
17578@item focus asm
17579Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17580
17581@item focus regs
17582Make the register window active for scrolling.
17583
17584@item focus cmd
17585Make the command window active for scrolling.
17586
17587@item refresh
17588@kindex refresh
17589Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17590
17591@item tui reg float
17592@kindex tui reg
17593Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17594
17595@item tui reg general
17596Show the general registers in the register window.
17597
17598@item tui reg next
17599Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17600their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17601following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17602@code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17603
17604@item tui reg system
17605Show the system registers in the register window.
17606
17607@item update
17608@kindex update
17609Update the source window and the current execution point.
17610
17611@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17612@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17613@kindex winheight
17614Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17615lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17616decrease it.
17617
17618@item tabset @var{nchars}
17619@kindex tabset
17620Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17621@end table
17622
17623@node TUI Configuration
17624@section TUI Configuration Variables
17625@cindex TUI configuration variables
17626
17627Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17628
17629@table @code
17630@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17631@kindex set tui border-kind
17632Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17633The possible values are the following:
17634@table @code
17635@item space
17636Use a space character to draw the border.
17637
17638@item ascii
17639Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17640
17641@item acs
17642Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17643drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17644@end table
17645
17646@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17647@kindex set tui border-mode
17648@itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17649@kindex set tui active-border-mode
17650Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17651or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17652@table @code
17653@item normal
17654Use normal attributes to display the border.
17655
17656@item standout
17657Use standout mode.
17658
17659@item reverse
17660Use reverse video mode.
17661
17662@item half
17663Use half bright mode.
17664
17665@item half-standout
17666Use half bright and standout mode.
17667
17668@item bold
17669Use extra bright or bold mode.
17670
17671@item bold-standout
17672Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17673@end table
17674@end table
17675
17676@node Emacs
17677@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17678
17679@cindex Emacs
17680@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17681A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17682edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17683@value{GDBN}.
17684
17685To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17686executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17687@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17688created Emacs buffer.
17689@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17690
17691Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17692things:
17693
17694@itemize @bullet
17695@item
17696All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17697the GUD buffer.
17698
17699This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17700and output done by the program you are debugging.
17701
17702This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17703commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17704in this way.
17705
17706All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17707with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17708way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17709stop.
17710
17711@item
17712@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17713
17714Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17715source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17716left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17717source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17718and the source.
17719
17720Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17721usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17722@end itemize
17723
17724We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17725a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17726that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17727@xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17728
17729If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17730gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17731your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17732sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17733with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17734program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17735some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17736@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17737buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17738
17739The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17740line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17741that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17742,Commands to Specify Files}.
17743
17744By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17745need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17746keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17747customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17748one you want.
17749
17750In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17751addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17752
17753@table @kbd
17754@item C-h m
17755Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17756
17757@item C-c C-s
17758Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17759update the display window to show the current file and location.
17760
17761@item C-c C-n
17762Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17763calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17764to show the current file and location.
17765
17766@item C-c C-i
17767Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17768display window accordingly.
17769
17770@item C-c C-f
17771Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17772@code{finish} command.
17773
17774@item C-c C-r
17775Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17776command.
17777
17778@item C-c <
17779Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17780(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17781like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17782
17783@item C-c >
17784Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17785@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17786@end table
17787
17788In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17789tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17790
17791In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17792separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17793Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17794become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17795source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17796selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17797speedbar displays watch expressions.
17798
17799If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17800it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17801request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17802the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17803frame.
17804
17805The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17806which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17807the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17808communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17809delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17810to correspond properly with the code.
17811
17812A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17813given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17814Emacs Manual}).
17815
17816@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17817@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17818@ignore
17819@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17820@kindex Epoch
17821@kindex inspect
17822
17823Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17824called the @code{epoch}
17825environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17826@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17827each value is printed in its own window.
17828@end ignore
17829
17830
17831@node GDB/MI
17832@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17833
17834@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17835
17836@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17837@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17838@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17839@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17840is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17841use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17842
17843This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17844in the form of a reference manual.
17845
17846Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17847features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17848(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17849
17850@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17851
17852@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17853This chapter uses the following notation:
17854
17855@itemize @bullet
17856@item
17857@code{|} separates two alternatives.
17858
17859@item
17860@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17861it may or may not be given.
17862
17863@item
17864@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17865may repeat zero or more times.
17866
17867@item
17868@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17869may repeat one or more times.
17870
17871@item
17872@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17873@end itemize
17874
17875@ignore
17876@heading Dependencies
17877@end ignore
17878
17879@menu
17880* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17881* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17882* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17883* GDB/MI Output Records::
17884* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17885* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17886* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17887* GDB/MI Program Context::
17888* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17889* GDB/MI Program Execution::
17890* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17891* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17892* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17893* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17894* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17895* GDB/MI File Commands::
17896@ignore
17897* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17898* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17899* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17900@end ignore
17901* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17902* GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
17903* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17904@end menu
17905
17906@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17907@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17908@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17909
17910@menu
17911* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17912* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17913@end menu
17914
17915@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17916@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17917
17918@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17919@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17920@table @code
17921@item @var{command} @expansion{}
17922@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17923
17924@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17925@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17926@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17927
17928@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17929@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17930@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17931
17932@item @var{token} @expansion{}
17933"any sequence of digits"
17934
17935@item @var{option} @expansion{}
17936@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17937
17938@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17939@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17940
17941@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17942@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17943
17944@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17945@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17946"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17947
17948@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17949@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17950
17951@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17952@code{CR | CR-LF}
17953@end table
17954
17955@noindent
17956Notes:
17957
17958@itemize @bullet
17959@item
17960The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17961output is described below.
17962
17963@item
17964The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17965finishes.
17966
17967@item
17968Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17969list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17970followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17971parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17972@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17973@end itemize
17974
17975Pragmatics:
17976
17977@itemize @bullet
17978@item
17979We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17980
17981@item
17982We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17983@end itemize
17984
17985@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17986@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17987
17988@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17989@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17990The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17991followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17992is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17993terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17994
17995If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17996corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17997@var{token}.
17998
17999@table @code
18000@item @var{output} @expansion{}
18001@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
18002
18003@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
18004@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18005
18006@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
18007@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
18008
18009@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
18010@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
18011
18012@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
18013@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
18014
18015@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
18016@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
18017
18018@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
18019@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
18020
18021@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
18022@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18023
18024@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
18025@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
18026
18027@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
18028@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
18029depending on the needs---this is still in development).
18030
18031@item @var{result} @expansion{}
18032@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
18033
18034@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
18035@code{ @var{string} }
18036
18037@item @var{value} @expansion{}
18038@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
18039
18040@item @var{const} @expansion{}
18041@code{@var{c-string}}
18042
18043@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
18044@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
18045
18046@item @var{list} @expansion{}
18047@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
18048@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
18049
18050@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
18051@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
18052
18053@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
18054@code{"~" @var{c-string}}
18055
18056@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
18057@code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
18058
18059@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
18060@code{"&" @var{c-string}}
18061
18062@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
18063@code{CR | CR-LF}
18064
18065@item @var{token} @expansion{}
18066@emph{any sequence of digits}.
18067@end table
18068
18069@noindent
18070Notes:
18071
18072@itemize @bullet
18073@item
18074All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
18075
18076@item
18077The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
18078for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
18079may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
18080output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
18081all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
18082target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
18083prior command.
18084
18085@item
18086@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18087@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
18088progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
18089prefixed by @samp{+}.
18090
18091@item
18092@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18093@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
18094(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
18095@samp{*}.
18096
18097@item
18098@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18099@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
18100client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
18101output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
18102
18103@item
18104@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18105@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
18106console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
18107output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
18108
18109@item
18110@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18111@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
18112All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
18113
18114@item
18115@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18116@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
18117instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
18118the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
18119
18120@item
18121@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18122New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
18123@var{values}.
18124
18125
18126@end itemize
18127
18128@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
18129details about the various output records.
18130
18131@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18132@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
18133@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
18134
18135@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
18136@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
18137
18138For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
18139but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
18140that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
18141command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
18142@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
18143@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
18144
18145This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
18146recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
18147(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
18148
18149@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18150@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
18151@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
18152@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
18153
18154The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
18155program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
18156
18157Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
18158by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
18159to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
18160section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
18161might change.
18162
18163Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
18164for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
18165list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
18166parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
18167
18168@itemize @bullet
18169@item
18170New MI commands may be added.
18171
18172@item
18173New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
18174
18175@item
18176The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
18177@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
18178
18179@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
18180@c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
18181
18182@c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
18183@c resolve inconsistencies.
18184@end itemize
18185
18186If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
18187will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
18188output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
18189@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
18190responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
18191
18192@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
18193@c version?
18194
18195The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
18196end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
18197follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
18198@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
18199@cindex mailing lists
18200
18201@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18202@node GDB/MI Output Records
18203@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
18204
18205@menu
18206* GDB/MI Result Records::
18207* GDB/MI Stream Records::
18208* GDB/MI Async Records::
18209@end menu
18210
18211@node GDB/MI Result Records
18212@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
18213
18214@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18215@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
18216In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
18217@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
18218
18219@table @code
18220@findex ^done
18221@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
18222The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
18223values.
18224
18225@item "^running"
18226@findex ^running
18227@c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
18228The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
18229running.
18230
18231@item "^connected"
18232@findex ^connected
18233@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
18234
18235@item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
18236@findex ^error
18237The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
18238error message.
18239
18240@item "^exit"
18241@findex ^exit
18242@value{GDBN} has terminated.
18243
18244@end table
18245
18246@node GDB/MI Stream Records
18247@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
18248
18249@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
18250@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18251@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
18252target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
18253funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
18254
18255Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
18256identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
18257Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
18258@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
18259line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
18260
18261@table @code
18262@item "~" @var{string-output}
18263The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
18264CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
18265
18266@item "@@" @var{string-output}
18267The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
18268target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
18269asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
18270
18271@item "&" @var{string-output}
18272The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
18273internals.
18274@end table
18275
18276@node GDB/MI Async Records
18277@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
18278
18279@cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18280@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
18281@dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
18282additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
18283consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
18284target activity (e.g., target stopped).
18285
18286The following is the list of possible async records:
18287
18288@table @code
18289
18290@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
18291The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
18292following values:
18293
18294@table @code
18295@item breakpoint-hit
18296A breakpoint was reached.
18297@item watchpoint-trigger
18298A watchpoint was triggered.
18299@item read-watchpoint-trigger
18300A read watchpoint was triggered.
18301@item access-watchpoint-trigger
18302An access watchpoint was triggered.
18303@item function-finished
18304An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18305@item location-reached
18306An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18307@item watchpoint-scope
18308A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
18309@item end-stepping-range
18310An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
18311similar CLI command was accomplished.
18312@item exited-signalled
18313The inferior exited because of a signal.
18314@item exited
18315The inferior exited.
18316@item exited-normally
18317The inferior exited normally.
18318@item signal-received
18319A signal was received by the inferior.
18320@end table
18321
18322@item =thread-created,id="@var{id}"
18323@itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}"
18324A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
18325contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread.
18326@end table
18327
18328
18329
18330@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18331@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
18332@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
18333@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
18334
18335This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
18336the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
18337following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
18338the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
18339
18340Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
18341readability, they don't appear in the real output.
18342
18343@subheading Setting a Breakpoint
18344
18345Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
18346information of the breakpoint.
18347
18348@smallexample
18349-> -break-insert main
18350<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18351 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
18352 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
18353<- (gdb)
18354@end smallexample
18355
18356@subheading Program Execution
18357
18358Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
18359reason that execution stopped.
18360
18361@smallexample
18362-> -exec-run
18363<- ^running
18364<- (gdb)
18365<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
18366 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
18367 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
18368 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
18369<- (gdb)
18370-> -exec-continue
18371<- ^running
18372<- (gdb)
18373<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18374<- (gdb)
18375@end smallexample
18376
18377@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
18378
18379Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
18380
18381@smallexample
18382-> (gdb)
18383<- -gdb-exit
18384<- ^exit
18385@end smallexample
18386
18387@subheading A Bad Command
18388
18389Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
18390
18391@smallexample
18392-> -rubbish
18393<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
18394<- (gdb)
18395@end smallexample
18396
18397
18398@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18399@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
18400@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
18401
18402The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
18403commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
18404
18405@subheading Motivation
18406
18407The motivation for this collection of commands.
18408
18409@subheading Introduction
18410
18411A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
18412
18413@subheading Commands
18414
18415For each command in the block, the following is described:
18416
18417@subsubheading Synopsis
18418
18419@smallexample
18420 -command @var{args}@dots{}
18421@end smallexample
18422
18423@subsubheading Result
18424
18425@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18426
18427The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
18428
18429@subsubheading Example
18430
18431Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
18432not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18433
18434
18435@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18436@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18437@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18438
18439@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18440@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18441This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18442breakpoints.
18443
18444@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18445@findex -break-after
18446
18447@subsubheading Synopsis
18448
18449@smallexample
18450 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18451@end smallexample
18452
18453The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18454hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18455the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18456@samp{-break-list} command below.
18457
18458@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18459
18460The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18461
18462@subsubheading Example
18463
18464@smallexample
18465(gdb)
18466-break-insert main
18467^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18468enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
18469fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18470(gdb)
18471-break-after 1 3
18472~
18473^done
18474(gdb)
18475-break-list
18476^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18477hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18478@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18479@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18480@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18481@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18482@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18483body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18484addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18485line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18486(gdb)
18487@end smallexample
18488
18489@ignore
18490@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18491@findex -break-catch
18492
18493@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18494@findex -break-commands
18495@end ignore
18496
18497
18498@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18499@findex -break-condition
18500
18501@subsubheading Synopsis
18502
18503@smallexample
18504 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18505@end smallexample
18506
18507Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18508@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18509@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18510command below).
18511
18512@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18513
18514The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18515
18516@subsubheading Example
18517
18518@smallexample
18519(gdb)
18520-break-condition 1 1
18521^done
18522(gdb)
18523-break-list
18524^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18525hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18526@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18527@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18528@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18529@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18530@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18531body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18532addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18533line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18534(gdb)
18535@end smallexample
18536
18537@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18538@findex -break-delete
18539
18540@subsubheading Synopsis
18541
18542@smallexample
18543 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18544@end smallexample
18545
18546Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18547list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18548
18549@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18550
18551The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18552
18553@subsubheading Example
18554
18555@smallexample
18556(gdb)
18557-break-delete 1
18558^done
18559(gdb)
18560-break-list
18561^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18562hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18563@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18564@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18565@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18566@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18567@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18568body=[]@}
18569(gdb)
18570@end smallexample
18571
18572@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18573@findex -break-disable
18574
18575@subsubheading Synopsis
18576
18577@smallexample
18578 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18579@end smallexample
18580
18581Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18582break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18583
18584@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18585
18586The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18587
18588@subsubheading Example
18589
18590@smallexample
18591(gdb)
18592-break-disable 2
18593^done
18594(gdb)
18595-break-list
18596^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18597hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18598@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18599@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18600@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18601@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18602@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18603body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18604addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18605line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18606(gdb)
18607@end smallexample
18608
18609@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18610@findex -break-enable
18611
18612@subsubheading Synopsis
18613
18614@smallexample
18615 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18616@end smallexample
18617
18618Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18619
18620@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18621
18622The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18623
18624@subsubheading Example
18625
18626@smallexample
18627(gdb)
18628-break-enable 2
18629^done
18630(gdb)
18631-break-list
18632^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18633hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18634@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18635@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18636@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18637@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18638@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18639body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18640addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18641line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18642(gdb)
18643@end smallexample
18644
18645@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18646@findex -break-info
18647
18648@subsubheading Synopsis
18649
18650@smallexample
18651 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18652@end smallexample
18653
18654@c REDUNDANT???
18655Get information about a single breakpoint.
18656
18657@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18658
18659The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18660
18661@subsubheading Example
18662N.A.
18663
18664@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18665@findex -break-insert
18666
18667@subsubheading Synopsis
18668
18669@smallexample
18670 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18671 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18672 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18673@end smallexample
18674
18675@noindent
18676If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18677
18678@itemize @bullet
18679@item function
18680@c @item +offset
18681@c @item -offset
18682@c @item linenum
18683@item filename:linenum
18684@item filename:function
18685@item *address
18686@end itemize
18687
18688The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18689
18690@table @samp
18691@item -t
18692Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18693@item -h
18694Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18695@item -c @var{condition}
18696Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18697@item -i @var{ignore-count}
18698Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18699@item -f
18700If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18701refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18702breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18703an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18704cannot be parsed.
18705@end table
18706
18707@subsubheading Result
18708
18709The result is in the form:
18710
18711@smallexample
18712^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18713enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18714fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18715times="@var{times}"@}
18716@end smallexample
18717
18718@noindent
18719where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18720@var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18721inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18722this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18723and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18724(always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18725which use the same output).
18726
18727Note: this format is open to change.
18728@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18729
18730@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18731
18732The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18733@samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18734
18735@subsubheading Example
18736
18737@smallexample
18738(gdb)
18739-break-insert main
18740^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18741fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18742(gdb)
18743-break-insert -t foo
18744^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18745fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18746(gdb)
18747-break-list
18748^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18749hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18750@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18751@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18752@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18753@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18754@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18755body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18756addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18757fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18758bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18759addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18760fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18761(gdb)
18762-break-insert -r foo.*
18763~int foo(int, int);
18764^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18765"fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18766(gdb)
18767@end smallexample
18768
18769@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18770@findex -break-list
18771
18772@subsubheading Synopsis
18773
18774@smallexample
18775 -break-list
18776@end smallexample
18777
18778Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18779
18780@table @samp
18781@item Number
18782number of the breakpoint
18783@item Type
18784type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18785@item Disposition
18786should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18787or @samp{nokeep}
18788@item Enabled
18789is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18790@item Address
18791memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18792@item What
18793logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18794name, line number
18795@item Times
18796number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18797@end table
18798
18799If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18800@code{body} field is an empty list.
18801
18802@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18803
18804The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18805
18806@subsubheading Example
18807
18808@smallexample
18809(gdb)
18810-break-list
18811^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18812hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18813@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18814@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18815@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18816@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18817@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18818body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18819addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18820bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18821addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18822line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18823(gdb)
18824@end smallexample
18825
18826Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18827
18828@smallexample
18829(gdb)
18830-break-list
18831^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18832hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18833@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18834@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18835@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18836@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18837@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18838body=[]@}
18839(gdb)
18840@end smallexample
18841
18842@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18843@findex -break-watch
18844
18845@subsubheading Synopsis
18846
18847@smallexample
18848 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18849@end smallexample
18850
18851Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18852@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18853read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18854option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18855trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18856either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18857i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18858@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18859
18860Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18861breakpoints inserted.
18862
18863@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18864
18865The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18866@samp{rwatch}.
18867
18868@subsubheading Example
18869
18870Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18871
18872@smallexample
18873(gdb)
18874-break-watch x
18875^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18876(gdb)
18877-exec-continue
18878^running
18879(gdb)
18880*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18881value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18882frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18883fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18884(gdb)
18885@end smallexample
18886
18887Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18888the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18889for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18890
18891@smallexample
18892(gdb)
18893-break-watch C
18894^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18895(gdb)
18896-exec-continue
18897^running
18898(gdb)
18899*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18900wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18901frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18902file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18903fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18904(gdb)
18905-exec-continue
18906^running
18907(gdb)
18908*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18909frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18910value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18911file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18912fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18913(gdb)
18914@end smallexample
18915
18916Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18917execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18918deleted.
18919
18920@smallexample
18921(gdb)
18922-break-watch C
18923^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18924(gdb)
18925-break-list
18926^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18927hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18928@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18929@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18930@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18931@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18932@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18933body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18934addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18935file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18936fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18937bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18938enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18939(gdb)
18940-exec-continue
18941^running
18942(gdb)
18943*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18944value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18945frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18946file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18947fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18948(gdb)
18949-break-list
18950^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18951hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18952@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18953@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18954@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18955@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18956@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18957body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18958addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18959file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18960fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18961bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18962enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18963(gdb)
18964-exec-continue
18965^running
18966^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18967frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18968value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18969file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18970fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18971(gdb)
18972-break-list
18973^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18974hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18975@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18976@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18977@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18978@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18979@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18980body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18981addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18982file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18983fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18984times="1"@}]@}
18985(gdb)
18986@end smallexample
18987
18988@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18989@node GDB/MI Program Context
18990@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18991
18992@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18993@findex -exec-arguments
18994
18995
18996@subsubheading Synopsis
18997
18998@smallexample
18999 -exec-arguments @var{args}
19000@end smallexample
19001
19002Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
19003@samp{-exec-run}.
19004
19005@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19006
19007The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
19008
19009@subsubheading Example
19010
19011@c FIXME!
19012Don't have one around.
19013
19014
19015@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
19016@findex -exec-show-arguments
19017
19018@subsubheading Synopsis
19019
19020@smallexample
19021 -exec-show-arguments
19022@end smallexample
19023
19024Print the arguments of the program.
19025
19026@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19027
19028The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
19029
19030@subsubheading Example
19031N.A.
19032
19033
19034@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
19035@findex -environment-cd
19036
19037@subsubheading Synopsis
19038
19039@smallexample
19040 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
19041@end smallexample
19042
19043Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
19044
19045@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19046
19047The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
19048
19049@subsubheading Example
19050
19051@smallexample
19052(gdb)
19053-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19054^done
19055(gdb)
19056@end smallexample
19057
19058
19059@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
19060@findex -environment-directory
19061
19062@subsubheading Synopsis
19063
19064@smallexample
19065 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19066@end smallexample
19067
19068Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
19069If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
19070search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
19071@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19072occurs as normal.
19073Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19074multiple directories in a single command
19075results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19076search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19077If blanks are needed as
19078part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19079the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19080by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19081character must not be used
19082in any directory name.
19083If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
19084
19085@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19086
19087The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
19088
19089@subsubheading Example
19090
19091@smallexample
19092(gdb)
19093-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19094^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19095(gdb)
19096-environment-directory ""
19097^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19098(gdb)
19099-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
19100^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
19101(gdb)
19102-environment-directory -r
19103^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
19104(gdb)
19105@end smallexample
19106
19107
19108@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
19109@findex -environment-path
19110
19111@subsubheading Synopsis
19112
19113@smallexample
19114 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19115@end smallexample
19116
19117Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
19118If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
19119search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
19120supplied in addition to the
19121@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19122occurs as normal.
19123Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19124multiple directories in a single command
19125results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19126search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19127If blanks are needed as
19128part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19129the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19130by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19131character must not be used
19132in any directory name.
19133If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
19134
19135
19136@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19137
19138The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
19139
19140@subsubheading Example
19141
19142@smallexample
19143(gdb)
19144-environment-path
19145^done,path="/usr/bin"
19146(gdb)
19147-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
19148^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
19149(gdb)
19150-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
19151^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
19152(gdb)
19153@end smallexample
19154
19155
19156@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
19157@findex -environment-pwd
19158
19159@subsubheading Synopsis
19160
19161@smallexample
19162 -environment-pwd
19163@end smallexample
19164
19165Show the current working directory.
19166
19167@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19168
19169The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
19170
19171@subsubheading Example
19172
19173@smallexample
19174(gdb)
19175-environment-pwd
19176^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
19177(gdb)
19178@end smallexample
19179
19180@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19181@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
19182@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
19183
19184
19185@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
19186@findex -thread-info
19187
19188@subsubheading Synopsis
19189
19190@smallexample
19191 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
19192@end smallexample
19193
19194Reports information about either a specific thread, if
19195the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
19196threads. When printing information about all threads,
19197also reports the current thread.
19198
19199@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19200
19201The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
19202about all threads.
19203
19204@subsubheading Example
19205
19206@smallexample
19207-thread-info
19208^done,threads=[
19209@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
19210 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},
19211@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
19212 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
19213 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}@}],
19214current-thread-id="1"
19215(gdb)
19216@end smallexample
19217
19218@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
19219@findex -thread-list-ids
19220
19221@subsubheading Synopsis
19222
19223@smallexample
19224 -thread-list-ids
19225@end smallexample
19226
19227Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
19228end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
19229
19230@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19231
19232Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
19233
19234@subsubheading Example
19235
19236No threads present, besides the main process:
19237
19238@smallexample
19239(gdb)
19240-thread-list-ids
19241^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
19242(gdb)
19243@end smallexample
19244
19245
19246Several threads:
19247
19248@smallexample
19249(gdb)
19250-thread-list-ids
19251^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19252number-of-threads="3"
19253(gdb)
19254@end smallexample
19255
19256
19257@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
19258@findex -thread-select
19259
19260@subsubheading Synopsis
19261
19262@smallexample
19263 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
19264@end smallexample
19265
19266Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
19267current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
19268
19269@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19270
19271The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
19272
19273@subsubheading Example
19274
19275@smallexample
19276(gdb)
19277-exec-next
19278^running
19279(gdb)
19280*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
19281file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
19282(gdb)
19283-thread-list-ids
19284^done,
19285thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19286number-of-threads="3"
19287(gdb)
19288-thread-select 3
19289^done,new-thread-id="3",
19290frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
19291args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
19292@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
19293(gdb)
19294@end smallexample
19295
19296@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19297@node GDB/MI Program Execution
19298@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
19299
19300These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
19301record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
19302asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
19303other cases.
19304
19305@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
19306@findex -exec-continue
19307
19308@subsubheading Synopsis
19309
19310@smallexample
19311 -exec-continue
19312@end smallexample
19313
19314Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
19315encountered, or until the inferior exits.
19316
19317@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19318
19319The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
19320
19321@subsubheading Example
19322
19323@smallexample
19324-exec-continue
19325^running
19326(gdb)
19327@@Hello world
19328*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
19329func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
19330line="13"@}
19331(gdb)
19332@end smallexample
19333
19334
19335@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
19336@findex -exec-finish
19337
19338@subsubheading Synopsis
19339
19340@smallexample
19341 -exec-finish
19342@end smallexample
19343
19344Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
19345function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
19346
19347@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19348
19349The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
19350
19351@subsubheading Example
19352
19353Function returning @code{void}.
19354
19355@smallexample
19356-exec-finish
19357^running
19358(gdb)
19359@@hello from foo
19360*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19361file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
19362(gdb)
19363@end smallexample
19364
19365Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
19366@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
19367value itself.
19368
19369@smallexample
19370-exec-finish
19371^running
19372(gdb)
19373*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
19374args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
19375file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19376gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
19377(gdb)
19378@end smallexample
19379
19380
19381@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
19382@findex -exec-interrupt
19383
19384@subsubheading Synopsis
19385
19386@smallexample
19387 -exec-interrupt
19388@end smallexample
19389
19390Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
19391associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
19392that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
19393appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
19394interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
19395
19396@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19397
19398The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
19399
19400@subsubheading Example
19401
19402@smallexample
19403(gdb)
19404111-exec-continue
19405111^running
19406
19407(gdb)
19408222-exec-interrupt
19409222^done
19410(gdb)
19411111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
19412frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19413fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
19414(gdb)
19415
19416(gdb)
19417-exec-interrupt
19418^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
19419(gdb)
19420@end smallexample
19421
19422
19423@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
19424@findex -exec-next
19425
19426@subsubheading Synopsis
19427
19428@smallexample
19429 -exec-next
19430@end smallexample
19431
19432Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19433of the next source line is reached.
19434
19435@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19436
19437The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19438
19439@subsubheading Example
19440
19441@smallexample
19442-exec-next
19443^running
19444(gdb)
19445*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19446(gdb)
19447@end smallexample
19448
19449
19450@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19451@findex -exec-next-instruction
19452
19453@subsubheading Synopsis
19454
19455@smallexample
19456 -exec-next-instruction
19457@end smallexample
19458
19459Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19460call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19461instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19462printed as well.
19463
19464@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19465
19466The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19467
19468@subsubheading Example
19469
19470@smallexample
19471(gdb)
19472-exec-next-instruction
19473^running
19474
19475(gdb)
19476*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19477addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19478(gdb)
19479@end smallexample
19480
19481
19482@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19483@findex -exec-return
19484
19485@subsubheading Synopsis
19486
19487@smallexample
19488 -exec-return
19489@end smallexample
19490
19491Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19492Displays the new current frame.
19493
19494@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19495
19496The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19497
19498@subsubheading Example
19499
19500@smallexample
19501(gdb)
19502200-break-insert callee4
19503200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19504file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19505(gdb)
19506000-exec-run
19507000^running
19508(gdb)
19509000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
19510frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19511file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19512fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19513(gdb)
19514205-break-delete
19515205^done
19516(gdb)
19517111-exec-return
19518111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19519args=[@{name="strarg",
19520value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19521file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19522fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19523(gdb)
19524@end smallexample
19525
19526
19527@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19528@findex -exec-run
19529
19530@subsubheading Synopsis
19531
19532@smallexample
19533 -exec-run
19534@end smallexample
19535
19536Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19537executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19538exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19539the program has exited exceptionally.
19540
19541@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19542
19543The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19544
19545@subsubheading Examples
19546
19547@smallexample
19548(gdb)
19549-break-insert main
19550^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19551(gdb)
19552-exec-run
19553^running
19554(gdb)
19555*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
19556frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19557fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19558(gdb)
19559@end smallexample
19560
19561@noindent
19562Program exited normally:
19563
19564@smallexample
19565(gdb)
19566-exec-run
19567^running
19568(gdb)
19569x = 55
19570*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19571(gdb)
19572@end smallexample
19573
19574@noindent
19575Program exited exceptionally:
19576
19577@smallexample
19578(gdb)
19579-exec-run
19580^running
19581(gdb)
19582x = 55
19583*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19584(gdb)
19585@end smallexample
19586
19587Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19588@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19589
19590@smallexample
19591(gdb)
19592*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19593signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19594@end smallexample
19595
19596
19597@c @subheading -exec-signal
19598
19599
19600@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19601@findex -exec-step
19602
19603@subsubheading Synopsis
19604
19605@smallexample
19606 -exec-step
19607@end smallexample
19608
19609Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19610of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19611function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19612function.
19613
19614@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19615
19616The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19617
19618@subsubheading Example
19619
19620Stepping into a function:
19621
19622@smallexample
19623-exec-step
19624^running
19625(gdb)
19626*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19627frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19628@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19629fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19630(gdb)
19631@end smallexample
19632
19633Regular stepping:
19634
19635@smallexample
19636-exec-step
19637^running
19638(gdb)
19639*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19640(gdb)
19641@end smallexample
19642
19643
19644@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19645@findex -exec-step-instruction
19646
19647@subsubheading Synopsis
19648
19649@smallexample
19650 -exec-step-instruction
19651@end smallexample
19652
19653Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19654output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19655we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19656case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19657well.
19658
19659@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19660
19661The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19662
19663@subsubheading Example
19664
19665@smallexample
19666(gdb)
19667-exec-step-instruction
19668^running
19669
19670(gdb)
19671*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19672frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19673fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19674(gdb)
19675-exec-step-instruction
19676^running
19677
19678(gdb)
19679*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19680frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19681fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19682(gdb)
19683@end smallexample
19684
19685
19686@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19687@findex -exec-until
19688
19689@subsubheading Synopsis
19690
19691@smallexample
19692 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19693@end smallexample
19694
19695Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19696argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19697until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19698reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19699
19700@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19701
19702The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19703
19704@subsubheading Example
19705
19706@smallexample
19707(gdb)
19708-exec-until recursive2.c:6
19709^running
19710(gdb)
19711x = 55
19712*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19713file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19714(gdb)
19715@end smallexample
19716
19717@ignore
19718@subheading -file-clear
19719Is this going away????
19720@end ignore
19721
19722@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19723@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19724@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19725
19726
19727@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19728@findex -stack-info-frame
19729
19730@subsubheading Synopsis
19731
19732@smallexample
19733 -stack-info-frame
19734@end smallexample
19735
19736Get info on the selected frame.
19737
19738@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19739
19740The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19741(without arguments).
19742
19743@subsubheading Example
19744
19745@smallexample
19746(gdb)
19747-stack-info-frame
19748^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19749file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19750fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19751(gdb)
19752@end smallexample
19753
19754@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19755@findex -stack-info-depth
19756
19757@subsubheading Synopsis
19758
19759@smallexample
19760 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19761@end smallexample
19762
19763Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19764is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19765
19766@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19767
19768There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19769
19770@subsubheading Example
19771
19772For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19773
19774@smallexample
19775(gdb)
19776-stack-info-depth
19777^done,depth="12"
19778(gdb)
19779-stack-info-depth 4
19780^done,depth="4"
19781(gdb)
19782-stack-info-depth 12
19783^done,depth="12"
19784(gdb)
19785-stack-info-depth 11
19786^done,depth="11"
19787(gdb)
19788-stack-info-depth 13
19789^done,depth="12"
19790(gdb)
19791@end smallexample
19792
19793@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19794@findex -stack-list-arguments
19795
19796@subsubheading Synopsis
19797
19798@smallexample
19799 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19800 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19801@end smallexample
19802
19803Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19804and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19805@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19806call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19807at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19808larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19809@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19810which case only existing frames will be returned.
19811
19812The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
198130 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19814means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19815
19816@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19817
19818@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19819@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19820functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19821
19822@subsubheading Example
19823
19824@smallexample
19825(gdb)
19826-stack-list-frames
19827^done,
19828stack=[
19829frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19830file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19831fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19832frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19833file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19834fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19835frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19836file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19837fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19838frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19839file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19840fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19841frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19842file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19843fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19844(gdb)
19845-stack-list-arguments 0
19846^done,
19847stack-args=[
19848frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19849frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19850frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19851frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19852frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19853(gdb)
19854-stack-list-arguments 1
19855^done,
19856stack-args=[
19857frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19858frame=@{level="1",
19859 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19860frame=@{level="2",args=[
19861@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19862@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19863@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19864@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19865@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19866@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19867frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19868(gdb)
19869-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19870^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19871(gdb)
19872-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19873^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19874args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19875@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19876(gdb)
19877@end smallexample
19878
19879@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19880
19881
19882@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19883@findex -stack-list-frames
19884
19885@subsubheading Synopsis
19886
19887@smallexample
19888 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19889@end smallexample
19890
19891List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19892following info:
19893
19894@table @samp
19895@item @var{level}
19896The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19897@item @var{addr}
19898The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19899@item @var{func}
19900Function name.
19901@item @var{file}
19902File name of the source file where the function lives.
19903@item @var{line}
19904Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19905@end table
19906
19907If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19908whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19909levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19910are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19911an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19912frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19913actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19914
19915@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19916
19917The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19918
19919@subsubheading Example
19920
19921Full stack backtrace:
19922
19923@smallexample
19924(gdb)
19925-stack-list-frames
19926^done,stack=
19927[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19928 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19929frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19930 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19931frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19932 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19933frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19934 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19935frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19936 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19937frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19938 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19939frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19940 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19941frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19942 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19943frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19944 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19945frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19946 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19947frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19948 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19949frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19950 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19951(gdb)
19952@end smallexample
19953
19954Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19955
19956@smallexample
19957(gdb)
19958-stack-list-frames 3 5
19959^done,stack=
19960[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19961 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19962frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19963 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19964frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19965 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19966(gdb)
19967@end smallexample
19968
19969Show a single frame:
19970
19971@smallexample
19972(gdb)
19973-stack-list-frames 3 3
19974^done,stack=
19975[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19976 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19977(gdb)
19978@end smallexample
19979
19980
19981@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19982@findex -stack-list-locals
19983
19984@subsubheading Synopsis
19985
19986@smallexample
19987 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19988@end smallexample
19989
19990Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19991@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19992the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19993values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19994type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19995structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19996display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19997other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19998more detail.
19999
20000@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20001
20002@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
20003
20004@subsubheading Example
20005
20006@smallexample
20007(gdb)
20008-stack-list-locals 0
20009^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
20010(gdb)
20011-stack-list-locals --all-values
20012^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
20013 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
20014-stack-list-locals --simple-values
20015^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
20016 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
20017(gdb)
20018@end smallexample
20019
20020
20021@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
20022@findex -stack-select-frame
20023
20024@subsubheading Synopsis
20025
20026@smallexample
20027 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
20028@end smallexample
20029
20030Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
20031the stack.
20032
20033@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20034
20035The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
20036@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
20037
20038@subsubheading Example
20039
20040@smallexample
20041(gdb)
20042-stack-select-frame 2
20043^done
20044(gdb)
20045@end smallexample
20046
20047@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20048@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
20049@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
20050
20051@ignore
20052
20053@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20054
20055For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
20056expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
20057used by @code{Insight}.
20058
20059The two main reasons for that are:
20060
20061@enumerate 1
20062@item
20063It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
20064
20065@item
20066It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
20067now).
20068@end enumerate
20069
20070The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
20071slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
20072describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
20073hints about their use.
20074
20075@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
20076expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
20077least, the following operations:
20078
20079@itemize @bullet
20080@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
20081@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
20082@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
20083@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
20084@end itemize
20085
20086@end ignore
20087
20088@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
20089
20090@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20091
20092Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
20093changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
20094work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
20095simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
20096is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
20097frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
20098expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
20099expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
20100variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
20101operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
20102object, or to change display format.
20103
20104Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
20105that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
20106a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
20107element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
20108children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
20109leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
20110objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
20111is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
20112child will be created.
20113
20114For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
20115string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
20116obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
20117that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
20118contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
20119
20120A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
20121the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
20122variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
20123operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
20124be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
20125objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
20126real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
20127variables that frontend has created.
20128
20129The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
20130might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
20131and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
20132relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
20133to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
20134visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
20135called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
20136implicitly updated.
20137
20138The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
20139access this functionality:
20140
20141@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
20142@item @strong{Operation}
20143@tab @strong{Description}
20144
20145@item @code{-var-create}
20146@tab create a variable object
20147@item @code{-var-delete}
20148@tab delete the variable object and/or its children
20149@item @code{-var-set-format}
20150@tab set the display format of this variable
20151@item @code{-var-show-format}
20152@tab show the display format of this variable
20153@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
20154@tab tells how many children this object has
20155@item @code{-var-list-children}
20156@tab return a list of the object's children
20157@item @code{-var-info-type}
20158@tab show the type of this variable object
20159@item @code{-var-info-expression}
20160@tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
20161@item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
20162@tab print full expression that this variable object represents
20163@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
20164@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
20165@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
20166@tab get the value of this variable
20167@item @code{-var-assign}
20168@tab set the value of this variable
20169@item @code{-var-update}
20170@tab update the variable and its children
20171@item @code{-var-set-frozen}
20172@tab set frozeness attribute
20173@end multitable
20174
20175In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
20176how it can be used.
20177
20178@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
20179
20180@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
20181@findex -var-create
20182
20183@subsubheading Synopsis
20184
20185@smallexample
20186 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
20187 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
20188@end smallexample
20189
20190This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
20191a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
20192register.
20193
20194The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
20195referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
20196system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
20197unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
20198The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
20199
20200The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
20201specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
20202frame should be used.
20203
20204@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
20205begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
20206
20207@itemize @bullet
20208@item
20209@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20210
20211@item
20212@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20213
20214@item
20215@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20216@end itemize
20217
20218@subsubheading Result
20219
20220This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20221object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20222the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20223
20224@smallexample
20225 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20226@end smallexample
20227
20228
20229@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20230@findex -var-delete
20231
20232@subsubheading Synopsis
20233
20234@smallexample
20235 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
20236@end smallexample
20237
20238Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20239With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
20240
20241Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20242
20243
20244@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20245@findex -var-set-format
20246
20247@subsubheading Synopsis
20248
20249@smallexample
20250 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20251@end smallexample
20252
20253Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20254@var{format-spec}.
20255
20256@anchor{-var-set-format}
20257The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20258
20259@smallexample
20260 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20261 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20262@end smallexample
20263
20264The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
20265based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20266for pointers, etc.).
20267
20268For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
20269variable itself, and the children are not affected.
20270
20271@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20272@findex -var-show-format
20273
20274@subsubheading Synopsis
20275
20276@smallexample
20277 -var-show-format @var{name}
20278@end smallexample
20279
20280Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20281
20282@smallexample
20283 @var{format} @expansion{}
20284 @var{format-spec}
20285@end smallexample
20286
20287
20288@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20289@findex -var-info-num-children
20290
20291@subsubheading Synopsis
20292
20293@smallexample
20294 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20295@end smallexample
20296
20297Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20298
20299@smallexample
20300 numchild=@var{n}
20301@end smallexample
20302
20303
20304@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20305@findex -var-list-children
20306
20307@subsubheading Synopsis
20308
20309@smallexample
20310 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20311@end smallexample
20312@anchor{-var-list-children}
20313
20314Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20315create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20316a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20317@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20318@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20319values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20320value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20321and unions.
20322
20323@subsubheading Example
20324
20325@smallexample
20326(gdb)
20327 -var-list-children n
20328 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20329 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20330(gdb)
20331 -var-list-children --all-values n
20332 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20333 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20334@end smallexample
20335
20336
20337@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20338@findex -var-info-type
20339
20340@subsubheading Synopsis
20341
20342@smallexample
20343 -var-info-type @var{name}
20344@end smallexample
20345
20346Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20347returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20348@value{GDBN} CLI:
20349
20350@smallexample
20351 type=@var{typename}
20352@end smallexample
20353
20354
20355@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20356@findex -var-info-expression
20357
20358@subsubheading Synopsis
20359
20360@smallexample
20361 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20362@end smallexample
20363
20364Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
20365variable object in user interface. The string is generally
20366not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
20367
20368For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
20369@code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
20370
20371@smallexample
20372(gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
20373^done,lang="C",exp="1"
20374@end smallexample
20375
20376@noindent
20377Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20378
20379Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
20380includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
20381is of limited use.
20382
20383@subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
20384@findex -var-info-path-expression
20385
20386@subsubheading Synopsis
20387
20388@smallexample
20389 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
20390@end smallexample
20391
20392Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
20393context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
20394Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
20395result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
20396the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
20397watchpoint from a variable object.
20398
20399For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
20400@code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
20401@code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
20402@code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
20403@code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
20404@smallexample
20405(gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
20406^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
20407@end smallexample
20408
20409@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20410@findex -var-show-attributes
20411
20412@subsubheading Synopsis
20413
20414@smallexample
20415 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20416@end smallexample
20417
20418List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20419
20420@smallexample
20421 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20422@end smallexample
20423
20424@noindent
20425where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20426
20427@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20428@findex -var-evaluate-expression
20429
20430@subsubheading Synopsis
20431
20432@smallexample
20433 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
20434@end smallexample
20435
20436Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20437object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
20438can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
20439this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
20440(@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
20441the current display format will be used. The current display format
20442can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20443
20444@smallexample
20445 value=@var{value}
20446@end smallexample
20447
20448Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20449before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20450
20451@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20452@findex -var-assign
20453
20454@subsubheading Synopsis
20455
20456@smallexample
20457 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20458@end smallexample
20459
20460Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20461by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20462value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20463subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20464
20465@subsubheading Example
20466
20467@smallexample
20468(gdb)
20469-var-assign var1 3
20470^done,value="3"
20471(gdb)
20472-var-update *
20473^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20474(gdb)
20475@end smallexample
20476
20477@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20478@findex -var-update
20479
20480@subsubheading Synopsis
20481
20482@smallexample
20483 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20484@end smallexample
20485
20486Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20487@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20488list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20489be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20490@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20491@code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20492object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20493for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20494@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20495names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
20496as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20497recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20498number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20499
20500
20501@subsubheading Example
20502
20503@smallexample
20504(gdb)
20505-var-assign var1 3
20506^done,value="3"
20507(gdb)
20508-var-update --all-values var1
20509^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20510type_changed="false"@}]
20511(gdb)
20512@end smallexample
20513
20514@anchor{-var-update}
20515The field in_scope may take three values:
20516
20517@table @code
20518@item "true"
20519The variable object's current value is valid.
20520
20521@item "false"
20522The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20523hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20524scope.
20525
20526@item "invalid"
20527The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20528This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20529either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20530command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20531objects.
20532@end table
20533
20534In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20535be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20536
20537@subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20538@findex -var-set-frozen
20539@anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20540
20541@subsubheading Synopsis
20542
20543@smallexample
20544 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20545@end smallexample
20546
20547Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20548@var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20549frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20550frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20551implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20552a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20553@code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20554values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20555implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20556Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20557@code{-var-update} does.
20558
20559@subsubheading Example
20560
20561@smallexample
20562(gdb)
20563-var-set-frozen V 1
20564^done
20565(gdb)
20566@end smallexample
20567
20568
20569@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20570@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20571@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20572
20573@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20574@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20575This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20576examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20577
20578@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20579@c @subheading -data-assign
20580@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20581@c @subsubheading GDB Command
20582@c set variable
20583@c @subsubheading Example
20584@c N.A.
20585
20586@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20587@findex -data-disassemble
20588
20589@subsubheading Synopsis
20590
20591@smallexample
20592 -data-disassemble
20593 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20594 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20595 -- @var{mode}
20596@end smallexample
20597
20598@noindent
20599Where:
20600
20601@table @samp
20602@item @var{start-addr}
20603is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20604@item @var{end-addr}
20605is the end address
20606@item @var{filename}
20607is the name of the file to disassemble
20608@item @var{linenum}
20609is the line number to disassemble around
20610@item @var{lines}
20611is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20612the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20613specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20614@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20615@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20616displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20617@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20618are displayed.
20619@item @var{mode}
20620is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20621disassembly).
20622@end table
20623
20624@subsubheading Result
20625
20626The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20627
20628@itemize @bullet
20629@item Address
20630@item Func-name
20631@item Offset
20632@item Instruction
20633@end itemize
20634
20635Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20636directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20637
20638@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20639
20640There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20641
20642@subsubheading Example
20643
20644Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20645
20646@smallexample
20647(gdb)
20648-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20649^done,
20650asm_insns=[
20651@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20652inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20653@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20654inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20655@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20656inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20657@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20658inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20659@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20660inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20661(gdb)
20662@end smallexample
20663
20664Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20665@code{main}.
20666
20667@smallexample
20668-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20669^done,asm_insns=[
20670@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20671inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20672@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20673inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20674@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20675inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20676[@dots{}]
20677@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20678@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20679(gdb)
20680@end smallexample
20681
20682Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20683
20684@smallexample
20685(gdb)
20686-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20687^done,asm_insns=[
20688@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20689inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20690@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20691inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20692@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20693inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20694(gdb)
20695@end smallexample
20696
20697Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20698
20699@smallexample
20700(gdb)
20701-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20702^done,asm_insns=[
20703src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20704file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20705 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20706@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20707inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20708src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20709file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20710 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20711@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20712inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20713@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20714inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20715(gdb)
20716@end smallexample
20717
20718
20719@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20720@findex -data-evaluate-expression
20721
20722@subsubheading Synopsis
20723
20724@smallexample
20725 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20726@end smallexample
20727
20728Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20729inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20730If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20731
20732@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20733
20734The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20735@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20736@samp{gdb_eval} command.
20737
20738@subsubheading Example
20739
20740In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20741@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20742Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20743output.
20744
20745@smallexample
20746211-data-evaluate-expression A
20747211^done,value="1"
20748(gdb)
20749311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20750311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20751(gdb)
20752411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20753411^done,value="4"
20754(gdb)
20755511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20756511^done,value="4"
20757(gdb)
20758@end smallexample
20759
20760
20761@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20762@findex -data-list-changed-registers
20763
20764@subsubheading Synopsis
20765
20766@smallexample
20767 -data-list-changed-registers
20768@end smallexample
20769
20770Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20771
20772@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20773
20774@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20775has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20776
20777@subsubheading Example
20778
20779On a PPC MBX board:
20780
20781@smallexample
20782(gdb)
20783-exec-continue
20784^running
20785
20786(gdb)
20787*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
20788func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
20789line="5"@}
20790(gdb)
20791-data-list-changed-registers
20792^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20793"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20794"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20795(gdb)
20796@end smallexample
20797
20798
20799@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20800@findex -data-list-register-names
20801
20802@subsubheading Synopsis
20803
20804@smallexample
20805 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20806@end smallexample
20807
20808Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20809are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20810integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20811names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20812consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20813include empty register names.
20814
20815@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20816
20817@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20818@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20819corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20820
20821@subsubheading Example
20822
20823For the PPC MBX board:
20824@smallexample
20825(gdb)
20826-data-list-register-names
20827^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20828"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20829"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20830"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20831"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20832"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20833"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20834(gdb)
20835-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20836^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20837(gdb)
20838@end smallexample
20839
20840@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20841@findex -data-list-register-values
20842
20843@subsubheading Synopsis
20844
20845@smallexample
20846 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20847@end smallexample
20848
20849Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20850which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20851list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20852numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20853
20854Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20855
20856@table @code
20857@item x
20858Hexadecimal
20859@item o
20860Octal
20861@item t
20862Binary
20863@item d
20864Decimal
20865@item r
20866Raw
20867@item N
20868Natural
20869@end table
20870
20871@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20872
20873The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20874all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20875
20876@subsubheading Example
20877
20878For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20879don't appear in the actual output):
20880
20881@smallexample
20882(gdb)
20883-data-list-register-values r 64 65
20884^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20885@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20886(gdb)
20887-data-list-register-values x
20888^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20889@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20890@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20891@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20892@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20893@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20894@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20895@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20896@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20897@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20898@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20899@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20900@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20901@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20902@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20903@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20904@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20905@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20906@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20907@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20908@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20909@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20910@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20911@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20912@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20913@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20914@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20915@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20916@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20917@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20918@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20919@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20920@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20921@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20922@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20923@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20924(gdb)
20925@end smallexample
20926
20927
20928@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20929@findex -data-read-memory
20930
20931@subsubheading Synopsis
20932
20933@smallexample
20934 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20935 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20936 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20937@end smallexample
20938
20939@noindent
20940where:
20941
20942@table @samp
20943@item @var{address}
20944An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20945read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20946quoted using the C convention.
20947
20948@item @var{word-format}
20949The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20950same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20951,Output Formats}).
20952
20953@item @var{word-size}
20954The size of each memory word in bytes.
20955
20956@item @var{nr-rows}
20957The number of rows in the output table.
20958
20959@item @var{nr-cols}
20960The number of columns in the output table.
20961
20962@item @var{aschar}
20963If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20964value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20965member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20966characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20967
20968@item @var{byte-offset}
20969An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20970@end table
20971
20972This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20973@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20974@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20975(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20976of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20977using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20978in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20979@samp{addr}.
20980
20981The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20982@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20983@samp{prev-page}.
20984
20985@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20986
20987The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20988@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20989
20990@subsubheading Example
20991
20992Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20993@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20994word. Display each word in hex.
20995
20996@smallexample
20997(gdb)
209989-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
209999^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
21000next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
21001prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
21002@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
21003@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
21004@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
21005(gdb)
21006@end smallexample
21007
21008Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
21009display as a single word formatted in decimal.
21010
21011@smallexample
21012(gdb)
210135-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
210145^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
21015next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
21016next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
21017@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
21018(gdb)
21019@end smallexample
21020
21021Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
21022as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
21023used as the non-printable character.
21024
21025@smallexample
21026(gdb)
210274-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
210284^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
21029next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
21030next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
21031@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21032@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21033@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21034@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21035@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
21036@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
21037@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
21038@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
21039(gdb)
21040@end smallexample
21041
21042@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21043@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
21044@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
21045
21046The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
21047
21048@c @subheading -trace-actions
21049
21050@c @subheading -trace-delete
21051
21052@c @subheading -trace-disable
21053
21054@c @subheading -trace-dump
21055
21056@c @subheading -trace-enable
21057
21058@c @subheading -trace-exists
21059
21060@c @subheading -trace-find
21061
21062@c @subheading -trace-frame-number
21063
21064@c @subheading -trace-info
21065
21066@c @subheading -trace-insert
21067
21068@c @subheading -trace-list
21069
21070@c @subheading -trace-pass-count
21071
21072@c @subheading -trace-save
21073
21074@c @subheading -trace-start
21075
21076@c @subheading -trace-stop
21077
21078
21079@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21080@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
21081@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
21082
21083
21084@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
21085@findex -symbol-info-address
21086
21087@subsubheading Synopsis
21088
21089@smallexample
21090 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
21091@end smallexample
21092
21093Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
21094
21095@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21096
21097The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
21098
21099@subsubheading Example
21100N.A.
21101
21102
21103@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
21104@findex -symbol-info-file
21105
21106@subsubheading Synopsis
21107
21108@smallexample
21109 -symbol-info-file
21110@end smallexample
21111
21112Show the file for the symbol.
21113
21114@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21115
21116There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
21117@samp{gdb_find_file}.
21118
21119@subsubheading Example
21120N.A.
21121
21122
21123@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
21124@findex -symbol-info-function
21125
21126@subsubheading Synopsis
21127
21128@smallexample
21129 -symbol-info-function
21130@end smallexample
21131
21132Show which function the symbol lives in.
21133
21134@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21135
21136@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
21137
21138@subsubheading Example
21139N.A.
21140
21141
21142@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
21143@findex -symbol-info-line
21144
21145@subsubheading Synopsis
21146
21147@smallexample
21148 -symbol-info-line
21149@end smallexample
21150
21151Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
21152
21153@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21154
21155The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
21156@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
21157
21158@subsubheading Example
21159N.A.
21160
21161
21162@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
21163@findex -symbol-info-symbol
21164
21165@subsubheading Synopsis
21166
21167@smallexample
21168 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
21169@end smallexample
21170
21171Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
21172
21173@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21174
21175The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
21176
21177@subsubheading Example
21178N.A.
21179
21180
21181@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
21182@findex -symbol-list-functions
21183
21184@subsubheading Synopsis
21185
21186@smallexample
21187 -symbol-list-functions
21188@end smallexample
21189
21190List the functions in the executable.
21191
21192@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21193
21194@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
21195@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21196
21197@subsubheading Example
21198N.A.
21199
21200
21201@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
21202@findex -symbol-list-lines
21203
21204@subsubheading Synopsis
21205
21206@smallexample
21207 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
21208@end smallexample
21209
21210Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
21211addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
21212ascending PC order.
21213
21214@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21215
21216There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
21217
21218@subsubheading Example
21219@smallexample
21220(gdb)
21221-symbol-list-lines basics.c
21222^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
21223(gdb)
21224@end smallexample
21225
21226
21227@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
21228@findex -symbol-list-types
21229
21230@subsubheading Synopsis
21231
21232@smallexample
21233 -symbol-list-types
21234@end smallexample
21235
21236List all the type names.
21237
21238@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21239
21240The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
21241@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21242
21243@subsubheading Example
21244N.A.
21245
21246
21247@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
21248@findex -symbol-list-variables
21249
21250@subsubheading Synopsis
21251
21252@smallexample
21253 -symbol-list-variables
21254@end smallexample
21255
21256List all the global and static variable names.
21257
21258@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21259
21260@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21261
21262@subsubheading Example
21263N.A.
21264
21265
21266@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
21267@findex -symbol-locate
21268
21269@subsubheading Synopsis
21270
21271@smallexample
21272 -symbol-locate
21273@end smallexample
21274
21275@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21276
21277@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
21278
21279@subsubheading Example
21280N.A.
21281
21282
21283@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
21284@findex -symbol-type
21285
21286@subsubheading Synopsis
21287
21288@smallexample
21289 -symbol-type @var{variable}
21290@end smallexample
21291
21292Show type of @var{variable}.
21293
21294@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21295
21296The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
21297@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
21298
21299@subsubheading Example
21300N.A.
21301
21302
21303@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21304@node GDB/MI File Commands
21305@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
21306
21307This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
21308and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
21309
21310@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
21311@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
21312
21313@subsubheading Synopsis
21314
21315@smallexample
21316 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
21317@end smallexample
21318
21319Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
21320which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
21321command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
21322are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
21323error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
21324notification.
21325
21326@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21327
21328The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
21329
21330@subsubheading Example
21331
21332@smallexample
21333(gdb)
21334-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21335^done
21336(gdb)
21337@end smallexample
21338
21339
21340@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
21341@findex -file-exec-file
21342
21343@subsubheading Synopsis
21344
21345@smallexample
21346 -file-exec-file @var{file}
21347@end smallexample
21348
21349Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
21350@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
21351from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
21352about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
21353notification.
21354
21355@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21356
21357The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
21358
21359@subsubheading Example
21360
21361@smallexample
21362(gdb)
21363-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21364^done
21365(gdb)
21366@end smallexample
21367
21368
21369@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
21370@findex -file-list-exec-sections
21371
21372@subsubheading Synopsis
21373
21374@smallexample
21375 -file-list-exec-sections
21376@end smallexample
21377
21378List the sections of the current executable file.
21379
21380@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21381
21382The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
21383information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
21384@samp{gdb_load_info}.
21385
21386@subsubheading Example
21387N.A.
21388
21389
21390@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
21391@findex -file-list-exec-source-file
21392
21393@subsubheading Synopsis
21394
21395@smallexample
21396 -file-list-exec-source-file
21397@end smallexample
21398
21399List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
21400to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
21401information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
21402whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
21403
21404@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21405
21406The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
21407
21408@subsubheading Example
21409
21410@smallexample
21411(gdb)
21412123-file-list-exec-source-file
21413123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
21414(gdb)
21415@end smallexample
21416
21417
21418@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
21419@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
21420
21421@subsubheading Synopsis
21422
21423@smallexample
21424 -file-list-exec-source-files
21425@end smallexample
21426
21427List the source files for the current executable.
21428
21429It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
21430the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
21431
21432@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21433
21434The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
21435@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
21436
21437@subsubheading Example
21438@smallexample
21439(gdb)
21440-file-list-exec-source-files
21441^done,files=[
21442@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21443@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21444@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21445(gdb)
21446@end smallexample
21447
21448@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21449@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21450
21451@subsubheading Synopsis
21452
21453@smallexample
21454 -file-list-shared-libraries
21455@end smallexample
21456
21457List the shared libraries in the program.
21458
21459@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21460
21461The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21462
21463@subsubheading Example
21464N.A.
21465
21466
21467@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21468@findex -file-list-symbol-files
21469
21470@subsubheading Synopsis
21471
21472@smallexample
21473 -file-list-symbol-files
21474@end smallexample
21475
21476List symbol files.
21477
21478@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21479
21480The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21481
21482@subsubheading Example
21483N.A.
21484
21485
21486@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21487@findex -file-symbol-file
21488
21489@subsubheading Synopsis
21490
21491@smallexample
21492 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21493@end smallexample
21494
21495Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21496used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21497produced, except for a completion notification.
21498
21499@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21500
21501The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21502
21503@subsubheading Example
21504
21505@smallexample
21506(gdb)
21507-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21508^done
21509(gdb)
21510@end smallexample
21511
21512@ignore
21513@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21514@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21515@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21516
21517The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21518
21519@c @subheading -overlay-auto
21520
21521@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21522
21523@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21524
21525@c @subheading -overlay-map
21526
21527@c @subheading -overlay-off
21528
21529@c @subheading -overlay-on
21530
21531@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21532
21533@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21534@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21535@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21536
21537Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21538
21539@c @subheading -signal-handle
21540
21541@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21542
21543@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21544@end ignore
21545
21546
21547@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21548@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21549@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21550
21551
21552@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21553@findex -target-attach
21554
21555@subsubheading Synopsis
21556
21557@smallexample
21558 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21559@end smallexample
21560
21561Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21562
21563@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21564
21565The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21566
21567@subsubheading Example
21568N.A.
21569
21570
21571@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21572@findex -target-compare-sections
21573
21574@subsubheading Synopsis
21575
21576@smallexample
21577 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21578@end smallexample
21579
21580Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21581Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21582
21583@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21584
21585The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21586
21587@subsubheading Example
21588N.A.
21589
21590
21591@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21592@findex -target-detach
21593
21594@subsubheading Synopsis
21595
21596@smallexample
21597 -target-detach
21598@end smallexample
21599
21600Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21601There's no output.
21602
21603@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21604
21605The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21606
21607@subsubheading Example
21608
21609@smallexample
21610(gdb)
21611-target-detach
21612^done
21613(gdb)
21614@end smallexample
21615
21616
21617@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21618@findex -target-disconnect
21619
21620@subsubheading Synopsis
21621
21622@smallexample
21623 -target-disconnect
21624@end smallexample
21625
21626Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21627generally not resumed.
21628
21629@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21630
21631The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21632
21633@subsubheading Example
21634
21635@smallexample
21636(gdb)
21637-target-disconnect
21638^done
21639(gdb)
21640@end smallexample
21641
21642
21643@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21644@findex -target-download
21645
21646@subsubheading Synopsis
21647
21648@smallexample
21649 -target-download
21650@end smallexample
21651
21652Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21653It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21654
21655@table @samp
21656@item section
21657The name of the section.
21658@item section-sent
21659The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21660@item section-size
21661The size of the section.
21662@item total-sent
21663The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21664@item total-size
21665The size of the overall executable to download.
21666@end table
21667
21668@noindent
21669Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21670@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21671
21672In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21673downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21674
21675@table @samp
21676@item section
21677The name of the section.
21678@item section-size
21679The size of the section.
21680@item total-size
21681The size of the overall executable to download.
21682@end table
21683
21684@noindent
21685At the end, a summary is printed.
21686
21687@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21688
21689The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21690
21691@subsubheading Example
21692
21693Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21694have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21695
21696@smallexample
21697(gdb)
21698-target-download
21699+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21700+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21701total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21702+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21703total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21704+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21705total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21706+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21707total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21708+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21709total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21710+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21711total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21712+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21713total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21714+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21715total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21716+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21717total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21718+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21719total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21720+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21721total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21722+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21723total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21724+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21725total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21726+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21727+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21728+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21729+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21730total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21731+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21732total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21733+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21734total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21735+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21736total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21737+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21738total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21739+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21740total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21741^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21742write-rate="429"
21743(gdb)
21744@end smallexample
21745
21746
21747@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21748@findex -target-exec-status
21749
21750@subsubheading Synopsis
21751
21752@smallexample
21753 -target-exec-status
21754@end smallexample
21755
21756Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21757not, for instance).
21758
21759@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21760
21761There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21762
21763@subsubheading Example
21764N.A.
21765
21766
21767@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21768@findex -target-list-available-targets
21769
21770@subsubheading Synopsis
21771
21772@smallexample
21773 -target-list-available-targets
21774@end smallexample
21775
21776List the possible targets to connect to.
21777
21778@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21779
21780The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21781
21782@subsubheading Example
21783N.A.
21784
21785
21786@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21787@findex -target-list-current-targets
21788
21789@subsubheading Synopsis
21790
21791@smallexample
21792 -target-list-current-targets
21793@end smallexample
21794
21795Describe the current target.
21796
21797@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21798
21799The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21800other things).
21801
21802@subsubheading Example
21803N.A.
21804
21805
21806@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21807@findex -target-list-parameters
21808
21809@subsubheading Synopsis
21810
21811@smallexample
21812 -target-list-parameters
21813@end smallexample
21814
21815@c ????
21816
21817@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21818
21819No equivalent.
21820
21821@subsubheading Example
21822N.A.
21823
21824
21825@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21826@findex -target-select
21827
21828@subsubheading Synopsis
21829
21830@smallexample
21831 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21832@end smallexample
21833
21834Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21835
21836@table @samp
21837@item @var{type}
21838The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21839@item @var{parameters}
21840Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21841Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21842@end table
21843
21844The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21845which the target program is, in the following form:
21846
21847@smallexample
21848^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21849 args=[@var{arg list}]
21850@end smallexample
21851
21852@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21853
21854The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21855
21856@subsubheading Example
21857
21858@smallexample
21859(gdb)
21860-target-select async /dev/ttya
21861^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21862(gdb)
21863@end smallexample
21864
21865@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21866@node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
21867@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
21868
21869
21870@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21871@findex -target-file-put
21872
21873@subsubheading Synopsis
21874
21875@smallexample
21876 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21877@end smallexample
21878
21879Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21880@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21881
21882@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21883
21884The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
21885
21886@subsubheading Example
21887
21888@smallexample
21889(gdb)
21890-target-file-put localfile remotefile
21891^done
21892(gdb)
21893@end smallexample
21894
21895
21896@subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
21897@findex -target-file-get
21898
21899@subsubheading Synopsis
21900
21901@smallexample
21902 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21903@end smallexample
21904
21905Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21906on the host system.
21907
21908@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21909
21910The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
21911
21912@subsubheading Example
21913
21914@smallexample
21915(gdb)
21916-target-file-get remotefile localfile
21917^done
21918(gdb)
21919@end smallexample
21920
21921
21922@subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
21923@findex -target-file-delete
21924
21925@subsubheading Synopsis
21926
21927@smallexample
21928 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
21929@end smallexample
21930
21931Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21932
21933@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21934
21935The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
21936
21937@subsubheading Example
21938
21939@smallexample
21940(gdb)
21941-target-file-delete remotefile
21942^done
21943(gdb)
21944@end smallexample
21945
21946
21947@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21948@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21949@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21950
21951@c @subheading -gdb-complete
21952
21953@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21954@findex -gdb-exit
21955
21956@subsubheading Synopsis
21957
21958@smallexample
21959 -gdb-exit
21960@end smallexample
21961
21962Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21963
21964@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21965
21966Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21967
21968@subsubheading Example
21969
21970@smallexample
21971(gdb)
21972-gdb-exit
21973^exit
21974@end smallexample
21975
21976
21977@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21978@findex -exec-abort
21979
21980@subsubheading Synopsis
21981
21982@smallexample
21983 -exec-abort
21984@end smallexample
21985
21986Kill the inferior running program.
21987
21988@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21989
21990The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21991
21992@subsubheading Example
21993N.A.
21994
21995
21996@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21997@findex -gdb-set
21998
21999@subsubheading Synopsis
22000
22001@smallexample
22002 -gdb-set
22003@end smallexample
22004
22005Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
22006@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
22007
22008@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22009
22010The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
22011
22012@subsubheading Example
22013
22014@smallexample
22015(gdb)
22016-gdb-set $foo=3
22017^done
22018(gdb)
22019@end smallexample
22020
22021
22022@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
22023@findex -gdb-show
22024
22025@subsubheading Synopsis
22026
22027@smallexample
22028 -gdb-show
22029@end smallexample
22030
22031Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
22032
22033@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22034
22035The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
22036
22037@subsubheading Example
22038
22039@smallexample
22040(gdb)
22041-gdb-show annotate
22042^done,value="0"
22043(gdb)
22044@end smallexample
22045
22046@c @subheading -gdb-source
22047
22048
22049@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
22050@findex -gdb-version
22051
22052@subsubheading Synopsis
22053
22054@smallexample
22055 -gdb-version
22056@end smallexample
22057
22058Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
22059
22060@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22061
22062The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
22063default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
22064
22065@subsubheading Example
22066
22067@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
22068@c box in TeX.
22069@smallexample
22070(gdb)
22071-gdb-version
22072~GNU gdb 5.2.1
22073~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22074~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
22075~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
22076~ certain conditions.
22077~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22078~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
22079~ details.
22080~This GDB was configured as
22081 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
22082^done
22083(gdb)
22084@end smallexample
22085
22086@subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
22087@findex -list-features
22088
22089Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
22090this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
22091or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
22092important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
22093of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
22094startup.
22095
22096The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
22097available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
22098have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
22099is given below.
22100
22101Example output:
22102
22103@smallexample
22104(gdb) -list-features
22105^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
22106@end smallexample
22107
22108The current list of features is:
22109
22110@itemize @minus
22111@item
22112@samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
22113@code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
22114@code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
22115@item
22116@samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
22117option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
22118@item
22119@samp{thread-info}---indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
22120
22121@end itemize
22122
22123@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
22124@findex -interpreter-exec
22125
22126@subheading Synopsis
22127
22128@smallexample
22129-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
22130@end smallexample
22131@anchor{-interpreter-exec}
22132
22133Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
22134
22135@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22136
22137The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
22138
22139@subheading Example
22140
22141@smallexample
22142(gdb)
22143-interpreter-exec console "break main"
22144&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
22145&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
22146~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
22147^done
22148(gdb)
22149@end smallexample
22150
22151@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
22152@findex -inferior-tty-set
22153
22154@subheading Synopsis
22155
22156@smallexample
22157-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22158@end smallexample
22159
22160Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
22161
22162@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22163
22164The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
22165
22166@subheading Example
22167
22168@smallexample
22169(gdb)
22170-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22171^done
22172(gdb)
22173@end smallexample
22174
22175@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
22176@findex -inferior-tty-show
22177
22178@subheading Synopsis
22179
22180@smallexample
22181-inferior-tty-show
22182@end smallexample
22183
22184Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
22185
22186@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22187
22188The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
22189
22190@subheading Example
22191
22192@smallexample
22193(gdb)
22194-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22195^done
22196(gdb)
22197-inferior-tty-show
22198^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
22199(gdb)
22200@end smallexample
22201
22202@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
22203@findex -enable-timings
22204
22205@subheading Synopsis
22206
22207@smallexample
22208-enable-timings [yes | no]
22209@end smallexample
22210
22211Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
22212command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
22213developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
22214equivalent to @samp{yes}.
22215
22216@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22217
22218No equivalent.
22219
22220@subheading Example
22221
22222@smallexample
22223(gdb)
22224-enable-timings
22225^done
22226(gdb)
22227-break-insert main
22228^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22229addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
22230fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
22231time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
22232(gdb)
22233-enable-timings no
22234^done
22235(gdb)
22236-exec-run
22237^running
22238(gdb)
22239*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
22240frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
22241@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
22242fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
22243(gdb)
22244@end smallexample
22245
22246@node Annotations
22247@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
22248
22249This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
22250designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
22251similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
22252relatively high level.
22253
22254The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
22255(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
22256
22257@ignore
22258This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
22259@end ignore
22260
22261@menu
22262* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
22263* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
22264* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
22265* Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
22266* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
22267* Annotations for Running::
22268 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
22269* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
22270@end menu
22271
22272@node Annotations Overview
22273@section What is an Annotation?
22274@cindex annotations
22275
22276Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
22277characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
22278information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
22279is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
22280information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
22281additional information, and a newline. The additional information
22282cannot contain newline characters.
22283
22284Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
22285characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
22286no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
22287@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
22288annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
22289means those three characters as output.
22290
22291The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
22292@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
22293how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
22294values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
22295is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
22296subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
22297for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
22298been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
22299Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
22300
22301@table @code
22302@kindex set annotate
22303@item set annotate @var{level}
22304The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
22305annotations to the specified @var{level}.
22306
22307@item show annotate
22308@kindex show annotate
22309Show the current annotation level.
22310@end table
22311
22312This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
22313
22314A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
22315
22316@smallexample
22317$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
22318GNU gdb 6.0
22319Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22320GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
22321and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
22322under certain conditions.
22323Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22324There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
22325for details.
22326This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
22327
22328^Z^Zpre-prompt
22329(@value{GDBP})
22330^Z^Zprompt
22331@kbd{quit}
22332
22333^Z^Zpost-prompt
22334$
22335@end smallexample
22336
22337Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
22338@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
22339denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
22340output from @value{GDBN}.
22341
22342@node Server Prefix
22343@section The Server Prefix
22344@cindex server prefix
22345
22346If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
22347the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
22348command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
22349means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
22350a transparent manner.
22351
22352The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22353history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22354use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22355
22356@node Prompting
22357@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
22358
22359@cindex annotations for prompts
22360When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
22361to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
22362over, etc.
22363
22364Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
22365input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
22366denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
22367annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
22368annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
22369associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
22370features the following annotations:
22371
22372@smallexample
22373^Z^Zpre-prompt
22374^Z^Zprompt
22375^Z^Zpost-prompt
22376@end smallexample
22377
22378The input types are
22379
22380@table @code
22381@findex pre-prompt annotation
22382@findex prompt annotation
22383@findex post-prompt annotation
22384@item prompt
22385When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
22386
22387@findex pre-commands annotation
22388@findex commands annotation
22389@findex post-commands annotation
22390@item commands
22391When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
22392command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
22393
22394@findex pre-overload-choice annotation
22395@findex overload-choice annotation
22396@findex post-overload-choice annotation
22397@item overload-choice
22398When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
22399
22400@findex pre-query annotation
22401@findex query annotation
22402@findex post-query annotation
22403@item query
22404When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
22405
22406@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
22407@findex prompt-for-continue annotation
22408@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
22409@item prompt-for-continue
22410When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
22411expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
22412prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
22413presence of annotations.
22414@end table
22415
22416@node Errors
22417@section Errors
22418@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
22419
22420@findex quit annotation
22421@smallexample
22422^Z^Zquit
22423@end smallexample
22424
22425This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
22426
22427@findex error annotation
22428@smallexample
22429^Z^Zerror
22430@end smallexample
22431
22432This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
22433
22434Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
22435in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
22436@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
22437cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
22438cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
22439does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
22440to the top level.
22441
22442@findex error-begin annotation
22443A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22444
22445@smallexample
22446^Z^Zerror-begin
22447@end smallexample
22448
22449Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22450message.
22451
22452Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22453@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22454@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22455
22456@node Invalidation
22457@section Invalidation Notices
22458
22459@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22460The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22461changed.
22462
22463@table @code
22464@findex frames-invalid annotation
22465@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22466
22467The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22468have changed.
22469
22470@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22471@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22472
22473The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22474deleted a breakpoint.
22475@end table
22476
22477@node Annotations for Running
22478@section Running the Program
22479@cindex annotations for running programs
22480
22481@findex starting annotation
22482@findex stopping annotation
22483When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
22484@code{step} or @code{continue},
22485
22486@smallexample
22487^Z^Zstarting
22488@end smallexample
22489
22490is output. When the program stops,
22491
22492@smallexample
22493^Z^Zstopped
22494@end smallexample
22495
22496is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22497annotations describe how the program stopped.
22498
22499@table @code
22500@findex exited annotation
22501@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22502The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22503successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22504
22505@findex signalled annotation
22506@findex signal-name annotation
22507@findex signal-name-end annotation
22508@findex signal-string annotation
22509@findex signal-string-end annotation
22510@item ^Z^Zsignalled
22511The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22512annotation continues:
22513
22514@smallexample
22515@var{intro-text}
22516^Z^Zsignal-name
22517@var{name}
22518^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22519@var{middle-text}
22520^Z^Zsignal-string
22521@var{string}
22522^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22523@var{end-text}
22524@end smallexample
22525
22526@noindent
22527where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22528@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22529as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22530@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22531user's benefit and have no particular format.
22532
22533@findex signal annotation
22534@item ^Z^Zsignal
22535The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22536just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22537terminated with it.
22538
22539@findex breakpoint annotation
22540@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22541The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22542
22543@findex watchpoint annotation
22544@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22545The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22546@end table
22547
22548@node Source Annotations
22549@section Displaying Source
22550@cindex annotations for source display
22551
22552@findex source annotation
22553The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22554
22555@smallexample
22556^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22557@end smallexample
22558
22559where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22560file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22561first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22562within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22563debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22564@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22565line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22566@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22567source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22568followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22569depend on the language).
22570
22571@node GDB Bugs
22572@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22573@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22574@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22575
22576Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22577
22578Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22579may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22580the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22581reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22582
22583In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22584information that enables us to fix the bug.
22585
22586@menu
22587* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22588* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22589@end menu
22590
22591@node Bug Criteria
22592@section Have You Found a Bug?
22593@cindex bug criteria
22594
22595If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22596
22597@itemize @bullet
22598@cindex fatal signal
22599@cindex debugger crash
22600@cindex crash of debugger
22601@item
22602If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22603@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22604
22605@cindex error on valid input
22606@item
22607If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22608bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22609somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22610
22611@cindex invalid input
22612@item
22613If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22614that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22615``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22616for traditional practice''.
22617
22618@item
22619If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22620for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22621@end itemize
22622
22623@node Bug Reporting
22624@section How to Report Bugs
22625@cindex bug reports
22626@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22627
22628A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22629If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22630contact that organization first.
22631
22632You can find contact information for many support companies and
22633individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22634distribution.
22635@c should add a web page ref...
22636
22637In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22638@value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22639@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22640page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22641be used.
22642
22643@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22644@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22645not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22646@samp{bug-gdb}.
22647
22648The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22649serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22650the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22651newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22652problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22653path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22654we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22655bug reports to the mailing list.
22656
22657The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22658@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22659fact or leave it out, state it!
22660
22661Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22662problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22663assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22664Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22665stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22666name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22667of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22668the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22669easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22670
22671Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22672bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22673you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22674self-contained.
22675
22676Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22677bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22678@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22679bugs properly.
22680
22681To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22682
22683@itemize @bullet
22684@item
22685The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22686with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22687version}.
22688
22689Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22690the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22691
22692@item
22693The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22694version number.
22695
22696@item
22697What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22698``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22699
22700@item
22701What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22702debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22703C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22704to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22705those compilers.
22706
22707@item
22708The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22709observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22710you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22711Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22712
22713If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22714and then we might not encounter the bug.
22715
22716@item
22717A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22718reproduce the bug.
22719
22720@item
22721A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22722incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22723
22724Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22725will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22726not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22727a chance to make a mistake.
22728
22729Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22730say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22731copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22732the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22733crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22734ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22735us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22736to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22737
22738@pindex script
22739@cindex recording a session script
22740To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22741such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22742Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22743include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22744
22745Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22746inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22747
22748@item
22749If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22750diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22751it by context, not by line number.
22752
22753The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22754sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22755
22756@end itemize
22757
22758Here are some things that are not necessary:
22759
22760@itemize @bullet
22761@item
22762A description of the envelope of the bug.
22763
22764Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22765which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22766changes will not affect it.
22767
22768This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22769will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22770with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22771We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22772
22773Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22774of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22775output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22776less time, and so on.
22777
22778However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22779report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22780
22781@item
22782A patch for the bug.
22783
22784A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22785the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22786a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22787to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22788
22789Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22790construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22791through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22792to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22793
22794And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22795patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22796help us to understand.
22797
22798@item
22799A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22800
22801Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22802things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22803@end itemize
22804
22805@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22806@c and consists of the two following files:
22807@c rluser.texinfo
22808@c inc-hist.texinfo
22809@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22810@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22811@include rluser.texi
22812@include inc-hist.texinfo
22813
22814
22815@node Formatting Documentation
22816@appendix Formatting Documentation
22817
22818@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22819@cindex reference card
22820The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22821for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22822subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22823@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22824release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22825you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22826
22827The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22828can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22829
22830@smallexample
22831make refcard.dvi
22832@end smallexample
22833
22834The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22835mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22836that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22837high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22838your @sc{dvi} output program.
22839
22840@cindex documentation
22841
22842All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22843distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22844a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22845on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22846formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22847and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22848
22849@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22850version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22851file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22852subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22853necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22854but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22855Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22856@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22857
22858If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22859Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22860@code{makeinfo}.
22861
22862If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22863@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22864version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22865
22866@smallexample
22867cd gdb
22868make gdb.info
22869@end smallexample
22870
22871If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22872a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22873Texinfo definitions file.
22874
22875@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22876produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22877document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22878has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22879command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22880(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22881require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22882
22883@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22884@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22885written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22886typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22887and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22888directory.
22889
22890If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22891typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22892subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22893@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22894
22895@smallexample
22896make gdb.dvi
22897@end smallexample
22898
22899Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22900
22901@node Installing GDB
22902@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22903@cindex installation
22904
22905@menu
22906* Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22907* Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22908* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22909* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22910* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22911@end menu
22912
22913@node Requirements
22914@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22915@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22916
22917Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22918Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22919
22920@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22921@table @asis
22922@item ISO C90 compiler
22923@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22924working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22925
22926@end table
22927
22928@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22929@table @asis
22930@item Expat
22931@anchor{Expat}
22932@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22933included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22934can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22935The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22936standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22937use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22938
22939Expat is used for:
22940
22941@itemize @bullet
22942@item
22943Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22944@item
22945Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22946@item
22947Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22948@item
22949MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22950@end itemize
22951
22952@item zlib
22953@cindex compressed debug sections
22954@value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
22955compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
22956of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
22957is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
22958information in such binaries.
22959
22960The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
22961distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
22962@url{http://zlib.net}.
22963
22964@end table
22965
22966@node Running Configure
22967@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22968@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22969@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22970of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22971build the @code{gdb} program.
22972@iftex
22973@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22974@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22975look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22976installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22977@end iftex
22978
22979The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22980@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22981appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22982
22983For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22984@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22985
22986@table @code
22987@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22988script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22989
22990@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22991the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22992
22993@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22994source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22995
22996@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22997@sc{gnu} include files
22998
22999@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
23000source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
23001
23002@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
23003source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
23004
23005@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
23006source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
23007
23008@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
23009source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
23010
23011@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
23012source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
23013@end table
23014
23015The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
23016from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
23017this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
23018
23019First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
23020if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
23021identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
23022argument.
23023
23024For example:
23025
23026@smallexample
23027cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23028./configure @var{host}
23029make
23030@end smallexample
23031
23032@noindent
23033where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
23034@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
23035(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
23036correct value by examining your system.)
23037
23038Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
23039@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
23040libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
23041binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
23042
23043@need 750
23044@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
23045system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
23046shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
23047
23048@smallexample
23049sh configure @var{host}
23050@end smallexample
23051
23052If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
23053directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
23054@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
23055@file{configure}
23056creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
23057you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
23058
23059You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
23060source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
23061@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
23062that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
23063if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
23064of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
23065configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
23066directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
23067about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23068
23069You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
23070However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
23071the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
23072that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
23073let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
23074
23075@node Separate Objdir
23076@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
23077
23078If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
23079you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
23080host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
23081allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
23082rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
23083handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
23084@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
23085program specified there.
23086
23087To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
23088with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
23089(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
23090itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
23091would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
23092the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
23093
23094For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
23095separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
23096
23097@smallexample
23098@group
23099cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23100mkdir ../gdb-sun4
23101cd ../gdb-sun4
23102../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
23103make
23104@end group
23105@end smallexample
23106
23107When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
23108directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
23109(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
23110the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
23111directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
23112@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
23113
23114Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
23115instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
23116like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
23117one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
23118build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23119
23120One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
23121directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
23122@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
23123programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
23124You specify a cross-debugging target by
23125giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
23126
23127When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
23128it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
23129called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
23130
23131The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
23132directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
23133directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
23134directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
23135will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
23136
23137When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
23138directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
23139if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
23140with each other.
23141
23142@node Config Names
23143@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
23144
23145The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
23146script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
23147aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
23148of information in the following pattern:
23149
23150@smallexample
23151@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
23152@end smallexample
23153
23154For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
23155or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
23156option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
23157
23158The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
23159any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
23160aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
23161@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
23162script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
23163abbreviations---for example:
23164
23165@smallexample
23166% sh config.sub i386-linux
23167i386-pc-linux-gnu
23168% sh config.sub alpha-linux
23169alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
23170% sh config.sub hp9k700
23171hppa1.1-hp-hpux
23172% sh config.sub sun4
23173sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
23174% sh config.sub sun3
23175m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
23176% sh config.sub i986v
23177Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
23178@end smallexample
23179
23180@noindent
23181@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
23182directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
23183
23184@node Configure Options
23185@section @file{configure} Options
23186
23187Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
23188are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
23189several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
23190Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
23191
23192@smallexample
23193configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
23194 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23195 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23196 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
23197 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
23198 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
23199 @var{host}
23200@end smallexample
23201
23202@noindent
23203You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
23204@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
23205@samp{--}.
23206
23207@table @code
23208@item --help
23209Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
23210
23211@item --prefix=@var{dir}
23212Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
23213@file{@var{dir}}.
23214
23215@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
23216Configure the source to install programs under directory
23217@file{@var{dir}}.
23218
23219@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
23220@need 2000
23221@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
23222@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
23223@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
23224Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
23225@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
23226build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
23227directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
23228the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
23229directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
23230the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
23231@var{dirname}.
23232
23233@item --norecursion
23234Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
23235propagate configuration to subdirectories.
23236
23237@item --target=@var{target}
23238Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
23239@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
23240programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
23241
23242There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
23243
23244@item @var{host} @dots{}
23245Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
23246
23247There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
23248@end table
23249
23250There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
23251needed for special purposes only.
23252
23253@node Maintenance Commands
23254@appendix Maintenance Commands
23255@cindex maintenance commands
23256@cindex internal commands
23257
23258In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
23259includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
23260that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
23261provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
23262messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
23263
23264@table @code
23265@kindex maint agent
23266@item maint agent @var{expression}
23267Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
23268This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
23269(@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
23270
23271@kindex maint info breakpoints
23272@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
23273Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
23274breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
23275internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
23276breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
23277is shown:
23278
23279@table @code
23280@item breakpoint
23281Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
23282
23283@item watchpoint
23284Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
23285
23286@item longjmp
23287Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
23288@code{longjmp} calls.
23289
23290@item longjmp resume
23291Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
23292
23293@item until
23294Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
23295
23296@item finish
23297Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
23298
23299@item shlib events
23300Shared library events.
23301
23302@end table
23303
23304@kindex maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23305@kindex maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23306@cindex displaced stepping support
23307@cindex out-of-line single-stepping
23308@item maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23309@itemx maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23310Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
23311if the target supports it. The default is on. Displaced stepping is
23312a way to single-step over breakpoints without removing them from the
23313inferior, by executing an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was
23314originally at the breakpoint location. It is also known as
23315out-of-line single-stepping.
23316
23317@kindex maint check-symtabs
23318@item maint check-symtabs
23319Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
23320
23321@kindex maint cplus first_component
23322@item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
23323Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
23324
23325@kindex maint cplus namespace
23326@item maint cplus namespace
23327Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
23328
23329@kindex maint demangle
23330@item maint demangle @var{name}
23331Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
23332
23333@kindex maint deprecate
23334@kindex maint undeprecate
23335@cindex deprecated commands
23336@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
23337@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
23338Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
23339cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
23340argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
23341favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
23342the replacement as part of the warning.
23343
23344@kindex maint dump-me
23345@item maint dump-me
23346@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
23347Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
23348This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
23349with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
23350
23351@kindex maint internal-error
23352@kindex maint internal-warning
23353@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23354@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23355Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
23356or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
23357or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
23358internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
23359either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
23360@value{GDBN} session.
23361
23362These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
23363used as the text of the error or warning message.
23364
23365Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
23366
23367@smallexample
23368(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
23369@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
23370A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
23371debugging may prove unreliable.
23372Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23373Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23374(@value{GDBP})
23375@end smallexample
23376
23377@kindex maint packet
23378@item maint packet @var{text}
23379If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
23380then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
23381displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
23382@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
23383checksum.
23384
23385@kindex maint print architecture
23386@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23387Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
23388@var{file} names the file where the output goes.
23389
23390@kindex maint print c-tdesc
23391@item maint print c-tdesc
23392Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
23393a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
23394when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
23395
23396@kindex maint print dummy-frames
23397@item maint print dummy-frames
23398Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
23399
23400@smallexample
23401(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
23402@dots{}
23403(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
23404Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
2340558 return (a + b);
23406The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
23407@dots{}
23408(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
234090x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
23410 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
23411 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
23412(@value{GDBP})
23413@end smallexample
23414
23415Takes an optional file parameter.
23416
23417@kindex maint print registers
23418@kindex maint print raw-registers
23419@kindex maint print cooked-registers
23420@kindex maint print register-groups
23421@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23422@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23423@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23424@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23425Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
23426
23427The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
23428the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
23429includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
23430@code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
23431register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
23432@value{GDBN} Internals}.
23433
23434These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
23435write the information.
23436
23437@kindex maint print reggroups
23438@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23439Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
23440optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
23441information.
23442
23443The register groups info looks like this:
23444
23445@smallexample
23446(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
23447 Group Type
23448 general user
23449 float user
23450 all user
23451 vector user
23452 system user
23453 save internal
23454 restore internal
23455@end smallexample
23456
23457@kindex flushregs
23458@item flushregs
23459This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
23460
23461@kindex maint print objfiles
23462@cindex info for known object files
23463@item maint print objfiles
23464Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
23465command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
23466and symtabs.
23467
23468@kindex maint print statistics
23469@cindex bcache statistics
23470@item maint print statistics
23471This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23472about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23473statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23474of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
23475defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
23476the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
23477used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
23478sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
23479average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
23480savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
23481lengths.
23482
23483@kindex maint print target-stack
23484@cindex target stack description
23485@item maint print target-stack
23486A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
23487kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
23488so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
23489In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
23490until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
23491address.
23492
23493This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
23494the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
23495
23496@kindex maint print type
23497@cindex type chain of a data type
23498@item maint print type @var{expr}
23499Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
23500can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
23501that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
23502a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
23503data structures, including its flags and contained types.
23504
23505@kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23506@kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23507@item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23508@itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23509Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
23510
23511@cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23512In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23513produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23514reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23515This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23516cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23517compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23518memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23519slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23520
23521@kindex maint set profile
23522@kindex maint show profile
23523@cindex profiling GDB
23524@item maint set profile
23525@itemx maint show profile
23526Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23527
23528Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23529command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23530collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23531exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23532if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23533(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23534data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23535
23536Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23537compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23538
23539@kindex maint set linux-async
23540@kindex maint show linux-async
23541@cindex asynchronous support
23542@item maint set linux-async
23543@itemx maint show linux-async
23544Control the GNU/Linux native asynchronous support of @value{GDBN}.
23545
23546GNU/Linux native asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
23547the @samp{maint set linux-async} command to enable it.
23548
23549@kindex maint show-debug-regs
23550@cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23551@item maint show-debug-regs
23552Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23553registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23554enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23555removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23556triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23557
23558@kindex maint space
23559@cindex memory used by commands
23560@item maint space
23561Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23562nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23563took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23564by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23565switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23566
23567@kindex maint time
23568@cindex time of command execution
23569@item maint time
23570Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23571set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23572took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23573The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
23574there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
23575by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
23576it's not possibly currently
23577This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23578@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23579
23580@kindex maint translate-address
23581@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23582Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23583@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23584@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23585the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23586the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23587command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23588
23589@end table
23590
23591The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23592@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23593
23594@table @code
23595@item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23596@kindex set watchdog
23597@cindex watchdog timer
23598@cindex timeout for commands
23599Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23600target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23601reports and error and the command is aborted.
23602
23603@item show watchdog
23604Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23605@end table
23606
23607@node Remote Protocol
23608@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23609
23610@menu
23611* Overview::
23612* Packets::
23613* Stop Reply Packets::
23614* General Query Packets::
23615* Register Packet Format::
23616* Tracepoint Packets::
23617* Host I/O Packets::
23618* Interrupts::
23619* Examples::
23620* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23621* Library List Format::
23622* Memory Map Format::
23623@end menu
23624
23625@node Overview
23626@section Overview
23627
23628There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23629protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23630machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23631recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23632
23633In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23634transmitted and received data, respectively.
23635
23636@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23637@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23638@cindex remote serial protocol
23639All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23640sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23641@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23642@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23643
23644@smallexample
23645@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23646@end smallexample
23647@noindent
23648
23649@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23650@noindent
23651The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23652characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23653eight bit unsigned checksum).
23654
23655Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23656specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23657
23658@smallexample
23659@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23660@end smallexample
23661
23662@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23663@noindent
23664That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23665has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23666since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23667
23668@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23669When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23670response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23671the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23672retransmission):
23673
23674@smallexample
23675-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23676<- @code{+}
23677@end smallexample
23678@noindent
23679
23680The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23681debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23682the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23683when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23684
23685@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23686exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23687exceptions).
23688
23689@cindex remote protocol, field separator
23690Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23691@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23692@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23693
23694Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23695@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23696would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23697
23698@cindex remote protocol, binary data
23699@anchor{Binary Data}
23700Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23701digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23702protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23703Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23704connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23705binary data.
23706
23707The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23708as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23709character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23710For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23711bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23712@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23713@samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23714must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23715is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23716(described next).
23717
23718Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23719Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23720instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23721repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23722binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23723@code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23724produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23725code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23726encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23727@samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23728after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
237293}} more times.
23730
23731The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23732greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23733seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23734five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23735@samp{0*"00}.
23736
23737The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23738error number. That number is not well defined.
23739
23740@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23741For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23742(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23743protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23744on that response.
23745
23746A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23747@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23748optional.
23749
23750@node Packets
23751@section Packets
23752
23753The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23754@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23755@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23756I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23757
23758Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23759syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23760include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23761part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23762separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23763@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23764bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23765@var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23766@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23767@var{baz}.
23768
23769Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23770letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23771
23772Here are the packet descriptions.
23773
23774@table @samp
23775
23776@item !
23777@cindex @samp{!} packet
23778@anchor{extended mode}
23779Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23780persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23781debugged.
23782
23783Reply:
23784@table @samp
23785@item OK
23786The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23787@end table
23788
23789@item ?
23790@cindex @samp{?} packet
23791Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23792step and continue.
23793
23794Reply:
23795@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23796
23797@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23798@cindex @samp{A} packet
23799Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23800specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23801@var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23802
23803Reply:
23804@table @samp
23805@item OK
23806The arguments were set.
23807@item E @var{NN}
23808An error occurred.
23809@end table
23810
23811@item b @var{baud}
23812@cindex @samp{b} packet
23813(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23814Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23815
23816JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23817received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23818problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23819
23820Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23821it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23822some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23823switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23824of view, nothing actually happened.}
23825
23826@item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23827@cindex @samp{B} packet
23828Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23829breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23830
23831Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23832(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23833
23834@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23835@cindex @samp{c} packet
23836Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23837resume at current address.
23838
23839Reply:
23840@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23841
23842@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23843@cindex @samp{C} packet
23844Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23845@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23846
23847Reply:
23848@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23849
23850@item d
23851@cindex @samp{d} packet
23852Toggle debug flag.
23853
23854Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23855(@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23856
23857@item D
23858@cindex @samp{D} packet
23859Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23860before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23861
23862Reply:
23863@table @samp
23864@item OK
23865for success
23866@item E @var{NN}
23867for an error
23868@end table
23869
23870@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23871@cindex @samp{F} packet
23872A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23873This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23874Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23875
23876@item g
23877@anchor{read registers packet}
23878@cindex @samp{g} packet
23879Read general registers.
23880
23881Reply:
23882@table @samp
23883@item @var{XX@dots{}}
23884Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23885with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23886each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23887determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23888@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23889specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23890@item E @var{NN}
23891for an error.
23892@end table
23893
23894@item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23895@cindex @samp{G} packet
23896Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23897description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23898
23899Reply:
23900@table @samp
23901@item OK
23902for success
23903@item E @var{NN}
23904for an error
23905@end table
23906
23907@item H @var{c} @var{t}
23908@cindex @samp{H} packet
23909Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23910@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23911should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23912operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23913the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23914
23915Reply:
23916@table @samp
23917@item OK
23918for success
23919@item E @var{NN}
23920for an error
23921@end table
23922
23923@c FIXME: JTC:
23924@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23925@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23926@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23927@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23928@c described. For example:
23929@c
23930@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23931@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23932@c otherwise returns current registers.
23933@c
23934@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23935@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23936@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23937
23938@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23939@anchor{cycle step packet}
23940@cindex @samp{i} packet
23941Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23942present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23943step starting at that address.
23944
23945@item I
23946@cindex @samp{I} packet
23947Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23948step packet}.
23949
23950@item k
23951@cindex @samp{k} packet
23952Kill request.
23953
23954FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23955thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23956thread?)}.
23957
23958@item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23959@cindex @samp{m} packet
23960Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23961Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23962
23963The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23964data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23965and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23966use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23967suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23968@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23969@cindex size of remote memory accesses
23970@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23971
23972Reply:
23973@table @samp
23974@item @var{XX@dots{}}
23975Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23976number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23977server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23978@item E @var{NN}
23979@var{NN} is errno
23980@end table
23981
23982@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23983@cindex @samp{M} packet
23984Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23985@var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23986hexadecimal number.
23987
23988Reply:
23989@table @samp
23990@item OK
23991for success
23992@item E @var{NN}
23993for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23994written).
23995@end table
23996
23997@item p @var{n}
23998@cindex @samp{p} packet
23999Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
24000@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
24001register value is encoded.
24002
24003Reply:
24004@table @samp
24005@item @var{XX@dots{}}
24006the register's value
24007@item E @var{NN}
24008for an error
24009@item
24010Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
24011@end table
24012
24013@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
24014@anchor{write register packet}
24015@cindex @samp{P} packet
24016Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
24017number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
24018digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
24019
24020Reply:
24021@table @samp
24022@item OK
24023for success
24024@item E @var{NN}
24025for an error
24026@end table
24027
24028@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24029@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24030@cindex @samp{q} packet
24031@cindex @samp{Q} packet
24032General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
24033described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
24034
24035@item r
24036@cindex @samp{r} packet
24037Reset the entire system.
24038
24039Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
24040
24041@item R @var{XX}
24042@cindex @samp{R} packet
24043Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
24044This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24045
24046The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
24047
24048@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
24049@cindex @samp{s} packet
24050Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
24051@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
24052
24053Reply:
24054@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24055
24056@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
24057@anchor{step with signal packet}
24058@cindex @samp{S} packet
24059Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
24060requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
24061
24062Reply:
24063@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24064
24065@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
24066@cindex @samp{t} packet
24067Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
24068@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
24069@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
24070
24071@item T @var{XX}
24072@cindex @samp{T} packet
24073Find out if the thread XX is alive.
24074
24075Reply:
24076@table @samp
24077@item OK
24078thread is still alive
24079@item E @var{NN}
24080thread is dead
24081@end table
24082
24083@item v
24084Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
24085up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
24086
24087@item vAttach;@var{pid}
24088@cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
24089Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
24090hexadecimal integer identifying the process. The attached process is
24091stopped.
24092
24093This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24094
24095Reply:
24096@table @samp
24097@item E @var{nn}
24098for an error
24099@item @r{Any stop packet}
24100for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24101@end table
24102
24103@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
24104@cindex @samp{vCont} packet
24105Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
24106If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
24107threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
24108specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
24109default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
24110Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
24111
24112@table @samp
24113@item c
24114Continue.
24115@item C @var{sig}
24116Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24117@item s
24118Step.
24119@item S @var{sig}
24120Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24121@end table
24122
24123The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
24124not supported in @samp{vCont}.
24125
24126Reply:
24127@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24128
24129@item vCont?
24130@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
24131Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
24132
24133Reply:
24134@table @samp
24135@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
24136The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
24137command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
24138@item
24139The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
24140@end table
24141
24142@item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
24143@cindex @samp{vFile} packet
24144Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
24145see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
24146
24147@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
24148@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
24149Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
24150@var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
24151its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
24152flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
24153Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
24154together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
24155stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24156packet is received.
24157
24158Reply:
24159@table @samp
24160@item OK
24161for success
24162@item E @var{NN}
24163for an error
24164@end table
24165
24166@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24167@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
24168Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
24169is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
24170packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
24171@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
24172not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
24173(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
24174have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
24175@samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
24176neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
24177target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
24178
24179
24180Reply:
24181@table @samp
24182@item OK
24183for success
24184@item E.memtype
24185for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
24186@item E @var{NN}
24187for an error
24188@end table
24189
24190@item vFlashDone
24191@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
24192Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
24193The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
24194@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
24195@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
24196regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24197request is completed.
24198
24199@item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
24200@cindex @samp{vRun} packet
24201Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
24202command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
24203@var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
24204(e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
24205state.
24206
24207This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24208
24209Reply:
24210@table @samp
24211@item E @var{nn}
24212for an error
24213@item @r{Any stop packet}
24214for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24215@end table
24216
24217@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24218@anchor{X packet}
24219@cindex @samp{X} packet
24220Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
24221@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
24222@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24223
24224Reply:
24225@table @samp
24226@item OK
24227for success
24228@item E @var{NN}
24229for an error
24230@end table
24231
24232@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24233@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24234@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
24235@cindex @samp{z} packet
24236@cindex @samp{Z} packets
24237Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
24238watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
24239@var{length} bytes.
24240
24241Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
24242separately.
24243
24244@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
24245for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
24246remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
24247@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
24248avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
24249be implemented in an idempotent way.}
24250
24251@item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24252@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24253@cindex @samp{z0} packet
24254@cindex @samp{Z0} packet
24255Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
24256@var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24257
24258A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
24259@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
24260@var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
24261breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
24262@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
24263
24264@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
24265code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
24266overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
24267target, is not defined.}
24268
24269Reply:
24270@table @samp
24271@item OK
24272success
24273@item
24274not supported
24275@item E @var{NN}
24276for an error
24277@end table
24278
24279@item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24280@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24281@cindex @samp{z1} packet
24282@cindex @samp{Z1} packet
24283Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
24284address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24285
24286A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
24287dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
24288
24289@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
24290movement.}
24291
24292Reply:
24293@table @samp
24294@item OK
24295success
24296@item
24297not supported
24298@item E @var{NN}
24299for an error
24300@end table
24301
24302@item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24303@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24304@cindex @samp{z2} packet
24305@cindex @samp{Z2} packet
24306Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
24307
24308Reply:
24309@table @samp
24310@item OK
24311success
24312@item
24313not supported
24314@item E @var{NN}
24315for an error
24316@end table
24317
24318@item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24319@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24320@cindex @samp{z3} packet
24321@cindex @samp{Z3} packet
24322Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
24323
24324Reply:
24325@table @samp
24326@item OK
24327success
24328@item
24329not supported
24330@item E @var{NN}
24331for an error
24332@end table
24333
24334@item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24335@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24336@cindex @samp{z4} packet
24337@cindex @samp{Z4} packet
24338Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
24339
24340Reply:
24341@table @samp
24342@item OK
24343success
24344@item
24345not supported
24346@item E @var{NN}
24347for an error
24348@end table
24349
24350@end table
24351
24352@node Stop Reply Packets
24353@section Stop Reply Packets
24354@cindex stop reply packets
24355
24356The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
24357receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
24358@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
24359when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
24360number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
24361@value{GDBN} source code.
24362
24363As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
24364reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
24365syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
24366components.
24367
24368@table @samp
24369
24370@item S @var{AA}
24371The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24372number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
24373@var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
24374
24375@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
24376@cindex @samp{T} packet reply
24377The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24378number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
24379@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
24380and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
24381round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
24382this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
24383
24384@itemize @bullet
24385@item
24386If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
24387corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
24388series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
24389two-digit hex number.
24390
24391@item
24392If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
24393hex.
24394
24395@item
24396If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
24397specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
24398reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
24399signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
24400
24401@item
24402Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
24403and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
24404future.
24405@end itemize
24406
24407The currently defined stop reasons are:
24408
24409@table @samp
24410@item watch
24411@itemx rwatch
24412@itemx awatch
24413The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
24414hex.
24415
24416@cindex shared library events, remote reply
24417@item library
24418The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
24419@value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
24420list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
24421@end table
24422
24423@item W @var{AA}
24424The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
24425applicable to certain targets.
24426
24427@item X @var{AA}
24428The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
24429
24430@item O @var{XX}@dots{}
24431@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
24432written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
24433while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
24434for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
24435
24436@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
24437@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
24438be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
24439correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
24440@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
24441system calls.
24442
24443@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
24444this very system call.
24445
24446The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
24447call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
24448with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
24449reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24450or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
24451Protocol Extension}, for more details.
24452
24453@end table
24454
24455@node General Query Packets
24456@section General Query Packets
24457@cindex remote query requests
24458
24459Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
24460packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
24461query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
24462sending information to and from the stub.
24463
24464The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
24465indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
24466@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
24467definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
24468conventions:
24469
24470@itemize @bullet
24471@item
24472The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
24473@item
24474Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
24475letter.
24476@item
24477The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
24478lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
24479the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
24480foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
24481@end itemize
24482
24483The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
24484parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
24485separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
24486full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
24487in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
24488with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
24489packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
24490for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
24491are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
24492existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
24493packet.}.
24494
24495Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
24496has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
24497explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
24498templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
24499@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
24500
24501Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
24502
24503@table @samp
24504
24505@item qC
24506@cindex current thread, remote request
24507@cindex @samp{qC} packet
24508Return the current thread id.
24509
24510Reply:
24511@table @samp
24512@item QC @var{pid}
24513Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
24514@item @r{(anything else)}
24515Any other reply implies the old pid.
24516@end table
24517
24518@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
24519@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
24520@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
24521Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
24522Reply:
24523@table @samp
24524@item E @var{NN}
24525An error (such as memory fault)
24526@item C @var{crc32}
24527The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
24528@end table
24529
24530@item qfThreadInfo
24531@itemx qsThreadInfo
24532@cindex list active threads, remote request
24533@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
24534@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
24535Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
24536may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
24537works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
24538obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
24539be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
24540sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
24541
24542NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
24543
24544Reply:
24545@table @samp
24546@item m @var{id}
24547A single thread id
24548@item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
24549a comma-separated list of thread ids
24550@item l
24551(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
24552@end table
24553
24554In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
24555more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
24556@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
24557ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
24558with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
24559
24560@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24561@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24562@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24563Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24564by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24565
24566@var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24567thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24568
24569@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24570thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24571information associated with the variable.)
24572
24573@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24574the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24575a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24576object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24577Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24578differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24579
24580Reply:
24581@table @samp
24582@item @var{XX}@dots{}
24583Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24584local storage requested.
24585
24586@item E @var{nn}
24587An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24588
24589@item
24590An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24591@end table
24592
24593@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24594Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24595digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24596subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24597number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24598(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24599returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24600
24601Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24602
24603Reply:
24604@table @samp
24605@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24606Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24607returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24608and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24609digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24610is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24611digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24612@end table
24613
24614@item qOffsets
24615@cindex section offsets, remote request
24616@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24617Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24618image.
24619
24620Reply:
24621@table @samp
24622@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24623Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24624Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24625If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24626@samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24627segments by the supplied offsets.
24628
24629@emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24630@value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24631to the @code{Bss} section.}
24632
24633@item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24634Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24635contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24636@samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24637conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24638@var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24639does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24640as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24641kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24642@end table
24643
24644@item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24645@cindex thread information, remote request
24646@cindex @samp{qP} packet
24647Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24648encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24649
24650Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24651(see below).
24652
24653Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24654
24655@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24656@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24657@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24658@anchor{QPassSignals}
24659Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24660Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24661(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24662strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24663the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24664reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24665combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24666new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24667@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24668
24669Reply:
24670@table @samp
24671@item OK
24672The request succeeded.
24673
24674@item E @var{nn}
24675An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24676
24677@item
24678An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24679the stub.
24680@end table
24681
24682Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24683command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24684This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24685by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24686
24687@item qRcmd,@var{command}
24688@cindex execute remote command, remote request
24689@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24690@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24691execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24692string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24693with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24694packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24695stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24696
24697Reply:
24698@table @samp
24699@item OK
24700A command response with no output.
24701@item @var{OUTPUT}
24702A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24703@item E @var{NN}
24704Indicate a badly formed request.
24705@item
24706An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24707@end table
24708
24709(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24710command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24711conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24712packets.)
24713
24714@item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
24715@cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
24716@cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
24717@anchor{qSearch memory}
24718Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
24719@var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
24720@var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
24721
24722Reply:
24723@table @samp
24724@item 0
24725The pattern was not found.
24726@item 1,address
24727The pattern was found at @var{address}.
24728@item E @var{NN}
24729A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
24730@item
24731An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
24732@end table
24733
24734@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24735@cindex supported packets, remote query
24736@cindex features of the remote protocol
24737@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24738@anchor{qSupported}
24739Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24740query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24741@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24742features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24743at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24744packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24745high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24746be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24747stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24748automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24749reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24750unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24751helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24752versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24753
24754Reply:
24755@table @samp
24756@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24757The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24758depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24759possible forms).
24760@item
24761An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24762or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24763@end table
24764
24765The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24766@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24767are:
24768
24769@table @samp
24770@item @var{name}=@var{value}
24771The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24772with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24773on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24774@item @var{name}+
24775The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24776need an associated value.
24777@item @var{name}-
24778The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24779@item @var{name}?
24780The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24781@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24782needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24783but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24784@end table
24785
24786Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24787supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24788request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24789state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24790a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24791
24792No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24793are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24794@var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24795packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24796versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24797for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24798advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24799improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24800responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24801the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24802of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24803describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24804all the features it supports.
24805
24806Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24807responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24808
24809Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24810should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24811require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24812form response.
24813
24814Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24815@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24816in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24817stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24818
24819Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24820mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24821architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24822about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24823stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24824
24825These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24826
24827@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24828@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24829@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24830@item Feature Name
24831@tab Value Required
24832@tab Default
24833@tab Probe Allowed
24834
24835@item @samp{PacketSize}
24836@tab Yes
24837@tab @samp{-}
24838@tab No
24839
24840@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24841@tab No
24842@tab @samp{-}
24843@tab Yes
24844
24845@item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24846@tab No
24847@tab @samp{-}
24848@tab Yes
24849
24850@item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24851@tab No
24852@tab @samp{-}
24853@tab Yes
24854
24855@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24856@tab No
24857@tab @samp{-}
24858@tab Yes
24859
24860@item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24861@tab No
24862@tab @samp{-}
24863@tab Yes
24864
24865@item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24866@tab No
24867@tab @samp{-}
24868@tab Yes
24869
24870@item @samp{QPassSignals}
24871@tab No
24872@tab @samp{-}
24873@tab Yes
24874
24875@end multitable
24876
24877These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24878
24879@table @samp
24880@cindex packet size, remote protocol
24881@item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24882The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24883length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24884transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24885data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24886There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24887stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24888byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24889@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24890
24891@item qXfer:auxv:read
24892The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24893(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24894
24895@item qXfer:features:read
24896The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24897(@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24898
24899@item qXfer:libraries:read
24900The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24901(@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24902
24903@item qXfer:memory-map:read
24904The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24905(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24906
24907@item qXfer:spu:read
24908The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24909(@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24910
24911@item qXfer:spu:write
24912The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24913(@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24914
24915@item QPassSignals
24916The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24917(@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24918
24919@end table
24920
24921@item qSymbol::
24922@cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24923@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24924Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24925requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24926
24927Reply:
24928@table @samp
24929@item OK
24930The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24931@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24932The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24933@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24934@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24935below.
24936@end table
24937
24938@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24939Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24940
24941@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24942target has previously requested.
24943
24944@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24945@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24946will be empty.
24947
24948Reply:
24949@table @samp
24950@item OK
24951The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24952@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24953The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24954encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24955(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24956@end table
24957
24958@item QTDP
24959@itemx QTFrame
24960@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24961
24962@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24963@cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24964@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24965Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24966the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24967string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24968for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24969displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24970examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24971@samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24972
24973Reply:
24974@table @samp
24975@item @var{XX}@dots{}
24976Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24977comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24978the thread's attributes.
24979@end table
24980
24981(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24982the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24983conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24984packets.)
24985
24986@item QTStart
24987@itemx QTStop
24988@itemx QTinit
24989@itemx QTro
24990@itemx qTStatus
24991@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24992
24993@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24994@cindex read special object, remote request
24995@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24996@anchor{qXfer read}
24997Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24998identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24999starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
25000encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
25001additional details about what data to access.
25002
25003Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25004@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25005formats, listed below.
25006
25007@table @samp
25008@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25009@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
25010Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
25011auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
25012
25013This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25014by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25015
25016@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25017@anchor{qXfer target description read}
25018Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
25019annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
25020always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
25021
25022This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25023by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25024
25025@item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25026@anchor{qXfer library list read}
25027Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
25028The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25029(@pxref{qXfer read}).
25030
25031Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
25032not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
25033the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
25034
25035This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25036by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25037
25038@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25039@anchor{qXfer memory map read}
25040Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
25041annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25042(@pxref{qXfer read}).
25043
25044This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25045by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25046
25047@item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25048@anchor{qXfer spu read}
25049Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25050annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
25051@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25052in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25053in that context to be accessed.
25054
25055This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25056by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25057@end table
25058
25059Reply:
25060@table @samp
25061@item m @var{data}
25062Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
25063target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
25064it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
25065block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
25066@var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
25067request.
25068
25069@item l @var{data}
25070Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
25071There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
25072than the @var{length} in the request.
25073
25074@item l
25075The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
25076There is no more data to be read.
25077
25078@item E00
25079The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25080
25081@item E @var{nn}
25082The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
25083@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25084
25085@item
25086An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
25087the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
25088@end table
25089
25090@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25091@cindex write data into object, remote request
25092Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
25093identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
25094into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
25095(@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
25096is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
25097to access.
25098
25099Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25100@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25101formats, listed below.
25102
25103@table @samp
25104@item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25105@anchor{qXfer spu write}
25106Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25107annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
25108@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25109in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25110in that context to be accessed.
25111
25112This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25113by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25114@end table
25115
25116Reply:
25117@table @samp
25118@item @var{nn}
25119@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
25120This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
25121
25122@item E00
25123The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25124
25125@item E @var{nn}
25126The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
25127@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25128
25129@item
25130An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
25131recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
25132@end table
25133
25134@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
25135Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
25136not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
25137@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
25138must respond with an empty packet.
25139
25140@end table
25141
25142@node Register Packet Format
25143@section Register Packet Format
25144
25145The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
25146In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
25147sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
25148to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
25149byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
25150most-significant - least-significant.
25151
25152@table @r
25153
25154@item MIPS32
25155
25156All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
2515732 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
25158registers; fsr; fir; fp.
25159
25160@item MIPS64
25161
25162All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
25163thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
25164as @code{MIPS32}.
25165
25166@end table
25167
25168@node Tracepoint Packets
25169@section Tracepoint Packets
25170@cindex tracepoint packets
25171@cindex packets, tracepoint
25172
25173Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
25174tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
25175
25176@table @samp
25177
25178@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
25179Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
25180is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
25181the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
25182count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
25183present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
25184tracepoint's actions.
25185
25186Replies:
25187@table @samp
25188@item OK
25189The packet was understood and carried out.
25190@item
25191The packet was not recognized.
25192@end table
25193
25194@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
25195Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
25196@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
25197this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
25198another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
25199trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
25200specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
25201
25202In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
25203can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
25204is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
25205actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
25206taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
25207@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
25208tracepoint actions.
25209
25210The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
25211actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
25212following forms:
25213
25214@table @samp
25215
25216@item R @var{mask}
25217Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
25218a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
25219@var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
25220zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
25221not fit in a 32-bit word.
25222
25223@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
25224Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
25225number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
25226@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
25227address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
25228@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
25229values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
25230
25231@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
25232Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
25233it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
25234@ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
25235two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
25236in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
25237packet).
25238
25239@end table
25240
25241Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
25242packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
25243length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
25244action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
25245actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
25246must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
25247``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
25248separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
25249
25250Replies:
25251@table @samp
25252@item OK
25253The packet was understood and carried out.
25254@item
25255The packet was not recognized.
25256@end table
25257
25258@item QTFrame:@var{n}
25259Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
25260register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
25261request packets from @value{GDBN}.
25262
25263A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
25264requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
25265without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
25266one of the following forms:
25267
25268@table @samp
25269@item F @var{f}
25270The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
25271@var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
25272was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
25273
25274@item T @var{t}
25275The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
25276@var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
25277
25278@end table
25279
25280@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
25281Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25282currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
25283@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
25284
25285@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
25286Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25287currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
25288is a hexadecimal number.
25289
25290@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
25291Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25292currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
25293and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
25294numbers.
25295
25296@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
25297Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
25298frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
25299
25300@item QTStart
25301Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
25302hits in the trace frame buffer.
25303
25304@item QTStop
25305End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
25306
25307@item QTinit
25308Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
25309
25310@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
25311Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
25312will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
25313if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
25314
25315@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
25316containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
25317still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
25318there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
25319
25320@item qTStatus
25321Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
25322
25323Replies:
25324@table @samp
25325@item T0
25326There is no trace experiment running.
25327@item T1
25328There is a trace experiment running.
25329@end table
25330
25331@end table
25332
25333
25334@node Host I/O Packets
25335@section Host I/O Packets
25336@cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
25337@cindex file transfer, remote protocol
25338
25339The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
25340operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
25341used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
25342filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
25343layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
25344Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
25345protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
25346Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
25347target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
25348Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
25349
25350The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
25351its arguments. They have this format:
25352
25353@table @samp
25354
25355@item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
25356@var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
25357should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
25358for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
25359the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
25360numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
25361used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
25362hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
25363buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
25364
25365@end table
25366
25367The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
25368
25369@table @samp
25370
25371@item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
25372@var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
25373non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
25374@var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
25375value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
25376operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
25377binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
25378normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
25379documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
25380@var{attachment}.
25381
25382@item
25383An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
25384
25385@end table
25386
25387These are the supported Host I/O operations:
25388
25389@table @samp
25390@item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
25391Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
25392return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
25393@var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
25394(@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
25395of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
25396@xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
25397
25398@item vFile:close: @var{fd}
25399Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
25400-1 if an error occurs.
25401
25402@item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
25403Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
25404@var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
25405relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
25406common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
25407condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
25408returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
25409@var{count} was zero.
25410
25411The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
25412If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
25413attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
25414number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
25415some characters were escaped.
25416
25417@item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
25418Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
25419to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
25420file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
25421separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
25422packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
25423which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
25424error occurred.
25425
25426@item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
25427Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
25428or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
25429
25430@end table
25431
25432@node Interrupts
25433@section Interrupts
25434@cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
25435
25436When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
25437attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
25438control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
25439setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
25440
25441The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
25442mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
25443not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
25444interfaces.
25445
25446@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
25447transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
25448@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
25449the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
25450transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
25451and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
25452(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
25453@code{0x03} as part of its packet.
25454
25455Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
25456precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
25457implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
25458running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
25459Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
25460of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
25461program is stopped will be discarded.
25462
25463@node Examples
25464@section Examples
25465
25466Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
25467does not get any direct output:
25468
25469@smallexample
25470-> @code{R00}
25471<- @code{+}
25472@emph{target restarts}
25473-> @code{?}
25474<- @code{+}
25475<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25476-> @code{+}
25477@end smallexample
25478
25479Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
25480
25481@smallexample
25482-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
25483<- @code{+}
25484-> @code{s}
25485<- @code{+}
25486@emph{time passes}
25487<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25488-> @code{+}
25489-> @code{g}
25490<- @code{+}
25491<- @code{1455@dots{}}
25492-> @code{+}
25493@end smallexample
25494
25495@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25496@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25497@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
25498
25499@menu
25500* File-I/O Overview::
25501* Protocol Basics::
25502* The F Request Packet::
25503* The F Reply Packet::
25504* The Ctrl-C Message::
25505* Console I/O::
25506* List of Supported Calls::
25507* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
25508* Constants::
25509* File-I/O Examples::
25510@end menu
25511
25512@node File-I/O Overview
25513@subsection File-I/O Overview
25514@cindex file-i/o overview
25515
25516The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
25517target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
25518system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
25519remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
25520actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
25521This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
25522
25523The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
25524It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
25525@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
25526translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
25527protocol representations when data is transmitted.
25528
25529The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
25530@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
25531or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
25532the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
25533memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
25534the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
25535(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
25536
25537The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
25538the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
25539after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
25540previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
25541request from @value{GDBN} is required.
25542
25543@smallexample
25544(@value{GDBP}) continue
25545 <- target requests 'system call X'
25546 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
25547 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
25548 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
25549 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
25550@end smallexample
25551
25552The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
25553the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
25554named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
25555system are not supported by this protocol.
25556
25557@node Protocol Basics
25558@subsection Protocol Basics
25559@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
25560
25561The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
25562as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
25563@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
25564the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
25565of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
25566This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
25567to call the appropriate host system call:
25568
25569@itemize @bullet
25570@item
25571A unique identifier for the requested system call.
25572
25573@item
25574All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
25575in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
25576pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
25577Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
25578
25579@end itemize
25580
25581At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25582
25583@itemize @bullet
25584@item
25585If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25586system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25587standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25588expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25589packet.
25590
25591@item
25592@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25593representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25594
25595@item
25596@value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25597
25598@item
25599It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25600
25601@item
25602If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25603by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25604target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25605by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25606packet.
25607
25608@end itemize
25609
25610Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25611necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25612
25613@itemize @bullet
25614@item
25615Return value.
25616
25617@item
25618@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25619
25620@item
25621``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25622
25623@end itemize
25624
25625After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25626the latest continue or step action.
25627
25628@node The F Request Packet
25629@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25630@cindex file-i/o request packet
25631@cindex @code{F} request packet
25632
25633The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25634
25635@table @samp
25636@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25637
25638@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25639This is just the name of the function.
25640
25641@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25642Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25643of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25644datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25645of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25646comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25647string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25648
25649@end table
25650
25651
25652
25653@node The F Reply Packet
25654@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25655@cindex file-i/o reply packet
25656@cindex @code{F} reply packet
25657
25658The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25659
25660@table @samp
25661
25662@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25663
25664@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25665
25666@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25667representation.
25668This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25669
25670@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25671case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25672The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25673
25674@smallexample
25675F0,0,C
25676@end smallexample
25677
25678@noindent
25679or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25680
25681@smallexample
25682F-1,4,C
25683@end smallexample
25684
25685@noindent
25686assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25687
25688@end table
25689
25690
25691@node The Ctrl-C Message
25692@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25693@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25694
25695If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25696reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25697the target should behave as if it had
25698gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25699interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25700(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25701packet.
25702
25703It's important for the target to know in which
25704state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25705
25706@itemize @bullet
25707@item
25708The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25709
25710@item
25711The system call on the host has been finished.
25712
25713@end itemize
25714
25715These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25716returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25717call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25718on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25719system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25720as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25721
25722@value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25723yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25724@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25725before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25726@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25727The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25728or the full action has been completed.
25729
25730@node Console I/O
25731@subsection Console I/O
25732@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25733
25734By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25735descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25736on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25737(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25738by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
257390 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25740conditions is met:
25741
25742@itemize @bullet
25743@item
25744The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25745@code{read}
25746system call is treated as finished.
25747
25748@item
25749The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25750newline.
25751
25752@item
25753The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25754character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25755
25756@end itemize
25757
25758If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25759the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25760either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25761is stopped at the user's request.
25762
25763
25764@node List of Supported Calls
25765@subsection List of Supported Calls
25766@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25767
25768@menu
25769* open::
25770* close::
25771* read::
25772* write::
25773* lseek::
25774* rename::
25775* unlink::
25776* stat/fstat::
25777* gettimeofday::
25778* isatty::
25779* system::
25780@end menu
25781
25782@node open
25783@unnumberedsubsubsec open
25784@cindex open, file-i/o system call
25785
25786@table @asis
25787@item Synopsis:
25788@smallexample
25789int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25790int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25791@end smallexample
25792
25793@item Request:
25794@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25795
25796@noindent
25797@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25798
25799@table @code
25800@item O_CREAT
25801If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25802rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25803are concerned.
25804
25805@item O_EXCL
25806When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25807an error and open() fails.
25808
25809@item O_TRUNC
25810If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25811writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25812truncated to zero length.
25813
25814@item O_APPEND
25815The file is opened in append mode.
25816
25817@item O_RDONLY
25818The file is opened for reading only.
25819
25820@item O_WRONLY
25821The file is opened for writing only.
25822
25823@item O_RDWR
25824The file is opened for reading and writing.
25825@end table
25826
25827@noindent
25828Other bits are silently ignored.
25829
25830
25831@noindent
25832@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25833
25834@table @code
25835@item S_IRUSR
25836User has read permission.
25837
25838@item S_IWUSR
25839User has write permission.
25840
25841@item S_IRGRP
25842Group has read permission.
25843
25844@item S_IWGRP
25845Group has write permission.
25846
25847@item S_IROTH
25848Others have read permission.
25849
25850@item S_IWOTH
25851Others have write permission.
25852@end table
25853
25854@noindent
25855Other bits are silently ignored.
25856
25857
25858@item Return value:
25859@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25860occurred.
25861
25862@item Errors:
25863
25864@table @code
25865@item EEXIST
25866@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25867
25868@item EISDIR
25869@var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25870
25871@item EACCES
25872The requested access is not allowed.
25873
25874@item ENAMETOOLONG
25875@var{pathname} was too long.
25876
25877@item ENOENT
25878A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25879
25880@item ENODEV
25881@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25882
25883@item EROFS
25884@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25885write access was requested.
25886
25887@item EFAULT
25888@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25889
25890@item ENOSPC
25891No space on device to create the file.
25892
25893@item EMFILE
25894The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25895
25896@item ENFILE
25897The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25898has been reached.
25899
25900@item EINTR
25901The call was interrupted by the user.
25902@end table
25903
25904@end table
25905
25906@node close
25907@unnumberedsubsubsec close
25908@cindex close, file-i/o system call
25909
25910@table @asis
25911@item Synopsis:
25912@smallexample
25913int close(int fd);
25914@end smallexample
25915
25916@item Request:
25917@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25918
25919@item Return value:
25920@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25921
25922@item Errors:
25923
25924@table @code
25925@item EBADF
25926@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25927
25928@item EINTR
25929The call was interrupted by the user.
25930@end table
25931
25932@end table
25933
25934@node read
25935@unnumberedsubsubsec read
25936@cindex read, file-i/o system call
25937
25938@table @asis
25939@item Synopsis:
25940@smallexample
25941int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25942@end smallexample
25943
25944@item Request:
25945@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25946
25947@item Return value:
25948On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25949Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25950returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25951
25952@item Errors:
25953
25954@table @code
25955@item EBADF
25956@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25957reading.
25958
25959@item EFAULT
25960@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25961
25962@item EINTR
25963The call was interrupted by the user.
25964@end table
25965
25966@end table
25967
25968@node write
25969@unnumberedsubsubsec write
25970@cindex write, file-i/o system call
25971
25972@table @asis
25973@item Synopsis:
25974@smallexample
25975int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25976@end smallexample
25977
25978@item Request:
25979@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25980
25981@item Return value:
25982On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25983Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25984is returned.
25985
25986@item Errors:
25987
25988@table @code
25989@item EBADF
25990@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25991writing.
25992
25993@item EFAULT
25994@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25995
25996@item EFBIG
25997An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25998host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25999
26000@item ENOSPC
26001No space on device to write the data.
26002
26003@item EINTR
26004The call was interrupted by the user.
26005@end table
26006
26007@end table
26008
26009@node lseek
26010@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
26011@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
26012
26013@table @asis
26014@item Synopsis:
26015@smallexample
26016long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
26017@end smallexample
26018
26019@item Request:
26020@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
26021
26022@var{flag} is one of:
26023
26024@table @code
26025@item SEEK_SET
26026The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
26027
26028@item SEEK_CUR
26029The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
26030bytes.
26031
26032@item SEEK_END
26033The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
26034bytes.
26035@end table
26036
26037@item Return value:
26038On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
26039the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
26040value of -1 is returned.
26041
26042@item Errors:
26043
26044@table @code
26045@item EBADF
26046@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
26047
26048@item ESPIPE
26049@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
26050
26051@item EINVAL
26052@var{flag} is not a proper value.
26053
26054@item EINTR
26055The call was interrupted by the user.
26056@end table
26057
26058@end table
26059
26060@node rename
26061@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
26062@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
26063
26064@table @asis
26065@item Synopsis:
26066@smallexample
26067int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
26068@end smallexample
26069
26070@item Request:
26071@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
26072
26073@item Return value:
26074On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26075
26076@item Errors:
26077
26078@table @code
26079@item EISDIR
26080@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
26081directory.
26082
26083@item EEXIST
26084@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
26085
26086@item EBUSY
26087@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
26088process.
26089
26090@item EINVAL
26091An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
26092of itself.
26093
26094@item ENOTDIR
26095A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
26096path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
26097and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
26098
26099@item EFAULT
26100@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
26101
26102@item EACCES
26103No access to the file or the path of the file.
26104
26105@item ENAMETOOLONG
26106
26107@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
26108
26109@item ENOENT
26110A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
26111
26112@item EROFS
26113The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26114
26115@item ENOSPC
26116The device containing the file has no room for the new
26117directory entry.
26118
26119@item EINTR
26120The call was interrupted by the user.
26121@end table
26122
26123@end table
26124
26125@node unlink
26126@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
26127@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
26128
26129@table @asis
26130@item Synopsis:
26131@smallexample
26132int unlink(const char *pathname);
26133@end smallexample
26134
26135@item Request:
26136@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
26137
26138@item Return value:
26139On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26140
26141@item Errors:
26142
26143@table @code
26144@item EACCES
26145No access to the file or the path of the file.
26146
26147@item EPERM
26148The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
26149
26150@item EBUSY
26151The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
26152being used by another process.
26153
26154@item EFAULT
26155@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26156
26157@item ENAMETOOLONG
26158@var{pathname} was too long.
26159
26160@item ENOENT
26161A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
26162
26163@item ENOTDIR
26164A component of the path is not a directory.
26165
26166@item EROFS
26167The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26168
26169@item EINTR
26170The call was interrupted by the user.
26171@end table
26172
26173@end table
26174
26175@node stat/fstat
26176@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
26177@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
26178@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
26179
26180@table @asis
26181@item Synopsis:
26182@smallexample
26183int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
26184int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
26185@end smallexample
26186
26187@item Request:
26188@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
26189@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
26190
26191@item Return value:
26192On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26193
26194@item Errors:
26195
26196@table @code
26197@item EBADF
26198@var{fd} is not a valid open file.
26199
26200@item ENOENT
26201A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
26202path is an empty string.
26203
26204@item ENOTDIR
26205A component of the path is not a directory.
26206
26207@item EFAULT
26208@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26209
26210@item EACCES
26211No access to the file or the path of the file.
26212
26213@item ENAMETOOLONG
26214@var{pathname} was too long.
26215
26216@item EINTR
26217The call was interrupted by the user.
26218@end table
26219
26220@end table
26221
26222@node gettimeofday
26223@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
26224@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
26225
26226@table @asis
26227@item Synopsis:
26228@smallexample
26229int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
26230@end smallexample
26231
26232@item Request:
26233@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
26234
26235@item Return value:
26236On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
26237
26238@item Errors:
26239
26240@table @code
26241@item EINVAL
26242@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
26243
26244@item EFAULT
26245@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26246@end table
26247
26248@end table
26249
26250@node isatty
26251@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
26252@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
26253
26254@table @asis
26255@item Synopsis:
26256@smallexample
26257int isatty(int fd);
26258@end smallexample
26259
26260@item Request:
26261@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
26262
26263@item Return value:
26264Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
26265
26266@item Errors:
26267
26268@table @code
26269@item EINTR
26270The call was interrupted by the user.
26271@end table
26272
26273@end table
26274
26275Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
262761 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
26277to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
26278would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
26279needed.
26280
26281
26282@node system
26283@unnumberedsubsubsec system
26284@cindex system, file-i/o system call
26285
26286@table @asis
26287@item Synopsis:
26288@smallexample
26289int system(const char *command);
26290@end smallexample
26291
26292@item Request:
26293@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
26294
26295@item Return value:
26296If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
26297available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
26298For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
26299return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
26300command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
26301return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
26302@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
26303
26304@item Errors:
26305
26306@table @code
26307@item EINTR
26308The call was interrupted by the user.
26309@end table
26310
26311@end table
26312
26313@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
26314to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
26315the host is simplified before it's returned
26316to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
26317is discarded, and the return value consists
26318entirely of the exit status of the called command.
26319
26320Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
26321by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
26322@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
26323
26324@table @code
26325@item set remote system-call-allowed
26326@kindex set remote system-call-allowed
26327Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
26328protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
26329
26330@item show remote system-call-allowed
26331@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
26332Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
26333protocol.
26334@end table
26335
26336@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26337@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26338@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26339
26340@menu
26341* Integral Datatypes::
26342* Pointer Values::
26343* Memory Transfer::
26344* struct stat::
26345* struct timeval::
26346@end menu
26347
26348@node Integral Datatypes
26349@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
26350@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26351
26352The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
26353@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
26354@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
26355
26356@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
26357implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
26358
26359@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
26360
26361@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
26362in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
26363
26364@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
26365
26366All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
26367structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
26368byte order.
26369
26370@node Pointer Values
26371@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
26372@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
26373
26374Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
26375is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
26376transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
26377are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
26378
26379@smallexample
26380@code{1aaf/12}
26381@end smallexample
26382
26383@noindent
26384which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
26385The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
26386the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
26387at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
26388
26389@smallexample
26390@code{123456/d}
26391@end smallexample
26392
26393@node Memory Transfer
26394@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
26395@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
26396
26397Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
26398example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
26399with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
26400this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
26401packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
26402it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
26403data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
26404
26405
26406@node struct stat
26407@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
26408@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
26409
26410The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
26411is defined as follows:
26412
26413@smallexample
26414struct stat @{
26415 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
26416 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
26417 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
26418 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
26419 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
26420 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
26421 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
26422 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
26423 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
26424 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
26425 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
26426 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
26427 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
26428@};
26429@end smallexample
26430
26431The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26432appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26433structure is of size 64 bytes.
26434
26435The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
26436range of values.
26437
26438@table @code
26439
26440@item st_dev
26441A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
26442
26443@item st_ino
26444No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26445
26446@item st_mode
26447Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
26448bits have currently no meaning for the target.
26449
26450@item st_uid
26451@itemx st_gid
26452@itemx st_rdev
26453No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26454
26455@item st_atime
26456@itemx st_mtime
26457@itemx st_ctime
26458These values have a host and file system dependent
26459accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
26460support exact timing values.
26461@end table
26462
26463The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
26464responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
26465continuing.
26466
26467Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
26468representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
26469get truncated on the target.
26470
26471@node struct timeval
26472@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
26473@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
26474
26475The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
26476is defined as follows:
26477
26478@smallexample
26479struct timeval @{
26480 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
26481 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
26482@};
26483@end smallexample
26484
26485The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26486appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26487structure is of size 8 bytes.
26488
26489@node Constants
26490@subsection Constants
26491@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
26492
26493The following values are used for the constants inside of the
26494protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
26495values before and after the call as needed.
26496
26497@menu
26498* Open Flags::
26499* mode_t Values::
26500* Errno Values::
26501* Lseek Flags::
26502* Limits::
26503@end menu
26504
26505@node Open Flags
26506@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
26507@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
26508
26509All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
26510
26511@smallexample
26512 O_RDONLY 0x0
26513 O_WRONLY 0x1
26514 O_RDWR 0x2
26515 O_APPEND 0x8
26516 O_CREAT 0x200
26517 O_TRUNC 0x400
26518 O_EXCL 0x800
26519@end smallexample
26520
26521@node mode_t Values
26522@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
26523@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
26524
26525All values are given in octal representation.
26526
26527@smallexample
26528 S_IFREG 0100000
26529 S_IFDIR 040000
26530 S_IRUSR 0400
26531 S_IWUSR 0200
26532 S_IXUSR 0100
26533 S_IRGRP 040
26534 S_IWGRP 020
26535 S_IXGRP 010
26536 S_IROTH 04
26537 S_IWOTH 02
26538 S_IXOTH 01
26539@end smallexample
26540
26541@node Errno Values
26542@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
26543@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
26544
26545All values are given in decimal representation.
26546
26547@smallexample
26548 EPERM 1
26549 ENOENT 2
26550 EINTR 4
26551 EBADF 9
26552 EACCES 13
26553 EFAULT 14
26554 EBUSY 16
26555 EEXIST 17
26556 ENODEV 19
26557 ENOTDIR 20
26558 EISDIR 21
26559 EINVAL 22
26560 ENFILE 23
26561 EMFILE 24
26562 EFBIG 27
26563 ENOSPC 28
26564 ESPIPE 29
26565 EROFS 30
26566 ENAMETOOLONG 91
26567 EUNKNOWN 9999
26568@end smallexample
26569
26570 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
26571 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
26572
26573@node Lseek Flags
26574@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
26575@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
26576
26577@smallexample
26578 SEEK_SET 0
26579 SEEK_CUR 1
26580 SEEK_END 2
26581@end smallexample
26582
26583@node Limits
26584@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26585@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26586
26587All values are given in decimal representation.
26588
26589@smallexample
26590 INT_MIN -2147483648
26591 INT_MAX 2147483647
26592 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26593 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26594 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26595 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26596@end smallexample
26597
26598@node File-I/O Examples
26599@subsection File-I/O Examples
26600@cindex file-i/o examples
26601
26602Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26603address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26604
26605@smallexample
26606<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26607@emph{request memory read from target}
26608-> @code{m1234,6}
26609<- XXXXXX
26610@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26611-> @code{F6}
26612@end smallexample
26613
26614Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26615address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26616
26617@smallexample
26618<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26619@emph{request memory write to target}
26620-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26621@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26622-> @code{F6}
26623@end smallexample
26624
26625Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26626file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26627
26628@smallexample
26629<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26630-> @code{F-1,9}
26631@end smallexample
26632
26633Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26634host is called:
26635
26636@smallexample
26637<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26638-> @code{F-1,4,C}
26639<- @code{T02}
26640@end smallexample
26641
26642Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26643host is called:
26644
26645@smallexample
26646<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26647-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26648<- @code{T02}
26649@end smallexample
26650
26651@node Library List Format
26652@section Library List Format
26653@cindex library list format, remote protocol
26654
26655On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26656same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26657@value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26658operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26659platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26660@value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26661through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26662packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26663queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26664are loaded.
26665
26666The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26667lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26668associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
26669which report where the library was loaded in memory.
26670
26671For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
26672library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
26673dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
26674should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
26675section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
26676depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
26677
26678@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26679library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26680
26681A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26682offset, looks like this:
26683
26684@smallexample
26685<library-list>
26686 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26687 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26688 </library>
26689</library-list>
26690@end smallexample
26691
26692Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
26693allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
26694
26695@smallexample
26696<library-list>
26697 <library name="sharedlib.o">
26698 <section address="0x10000000"/>
26699 <section address="0x20000000"/>
26700 <section address="0x30000000"/>
26701 </library>
26702</library-list>
26703@end smallexample
26704
26705The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26706
26707@smallexample
26708<!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26709<!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26710<!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26711<!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
26712<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26713<!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26714<!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26715<!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
26716<!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26717@end smallexample
26718
26719In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
26720single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
26721section for each library.
26722
26723@node Memory Map Format
26724@section Memory Map Format
26725@cindex memory map format
26726
26727To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26728memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26729memory map.
26730
26731The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26732(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26733lists memory regions.
26734
26735@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26736memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26737
26738The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26739
26740@smallexample
26741<?xml version="1.0"?>
26742<!DOCTYPE memory-map
26743 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26744 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26745<memory-map>
26746 region...
26747</memory-map>
26748@end smallexample
26749
26750Each region can be either:
26751
26752@itemize
26753
26754@item
26755A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26756bytes from there:
26757
26758@smallexample
26759<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26760@end smallexample
26761
26762
26763@item
26764A region of read-only memory:
26765
26766@smallexample
26767<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26768@end smallexample
26769
26770
26771@item
26772A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26773bytes in length:
26774
26775@smallexample
26776<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26777 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26778</memory>
26779@end smallexample
26780
26781@end itemize
26782
26783Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26784by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26785packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26786
26787The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26788
26789@smallexample
26790<!-- ................................................... -->
26791<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26792<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26793<!-- .................................... .............. -->
26794<!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26795<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26796<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26797<!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26798<!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26799<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26800 and its type, or device. -->
26801<!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26802 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26803 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26804 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26805<!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26806<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26807<!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26808@end smallexample
26809
26810@include agentexpr.texi
26811
26812@node Target Descriptions
26813@appendix Target Descriptions
26814@cindex target descriptions
26815
26816@strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26817and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26818The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26819
26820One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26821is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26822architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26823a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26824and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26825architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26826vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26827
26828@itemize @bullet
26829@item
26830With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26831the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26832@item
26833Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26834audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26835variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26836@item
26837When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26838at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26839@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26840@end itemize
26841
26842To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26843target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26844actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26845processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
26846descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
26847
26848@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26849target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
26850
26851@menu
26852* Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
26853* Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
26854* Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
26855 descriptions.
26856* Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
26857@end menu
26858
26859@node Retrieving Descriptions
26860@section Retrieving Descriptions
26861
26862Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
26863specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
26864description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
26865protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
26866qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
26867@samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
26868XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
26869Format}.
26870
26871Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
26872If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
26873specify a file are:
26874
26875@table @code
26876@cindex set tdesc filename
26877@item set tdesc filename @var{path}
26878Read the target description from @var{path}.
26879
26880@cindex unset tdesc filename
26881@item unset tdesc filename
26882Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26883will use the description supplied by the current target.
26884
26885@cindex show tdesc filename
26886@item show tdesc filename
26887Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26888@end table
26889
26890
26891@node Target Description Format
26892@section Target Description Format
26893@cindex target descriptions, XML format
26894
26895A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26896document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26897the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26898means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26899check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26900However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26901their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26902
26903Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26904and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26905sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26906target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26907
26908Here is a simple target description:
26909
26910@smallexample
26911<target version="1.0">
26912 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26913</target>
26914@end smallexample
26915
26916@noindent
26917This minimal description only says that the target uses
26918the x86-64 architecture.
26919
26920A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26921optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26922are explained further below.
26923
26924@smallexample
26925<?xml version="1.0"?>
26926<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26927<target version="1.0">
26928 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26929 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26930</target>
26931@end smallexample
26932
26933@noindent
26934The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26935breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26936declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26937(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26938useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26939@samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26940including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26941revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26942the version mismatch.
26943
26944@subsection Inclusion
26945@cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26946@cindex XInclude
26947@ifnotinfo
26948@cindex <xi:include>
26949@end ifnotinfo
26950
26951It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26952several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26953share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26954divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26955the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26956
26957@smallexample
26958<xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26959@end smallexample
26960
26961@noindent
26962When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26963the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26964the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26965using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26966@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26967current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26968@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26969original description.
26970
26971@subsection Architecture
26972@cindex <architecture>
26973
26974An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26975
26976@smallexample
26977 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26978@end smallexample
26979
26980@var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26981accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26982Debugging Target}).
26983
26984@subsection Features
26985@cindex <feature>
26986
26987Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26988system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26989registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26990has this form:
26991
26992@smallexample
26993<feature name="@var{name}">
26994 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26995 @var{reg}@dots{}
26996</feature>
26997@end smallexample
26998
26999@noindent
27000Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
27001of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
27002knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
27003should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
27004
27005@subsection Types
27006
27007Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
27008interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
27009but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
27010Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
27011Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
27012
27013Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
27014a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
27015Types must be defined before they are used.
27016
27017@cindex <vector>
27018Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
27019of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
27020specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
27021@var{count}:
27022
27023@smallexample
27024<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
27025@end smallexample
27026
27027@cindex <union>
27028If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
27029with a union type containing the useful representations. The
27030@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
27031each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
27032
27033@smallexample
27034<union id="@var{id}">
27035 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
27036 @dots{}
27037</union>
27038@end smallexample
27039
27040@subsection Registers
27041@cindex <reg>
27042
27043Each register is represented as an element with this form:
27044
27045@smallexample
27046<reg name="@var{name}"
27047 bitsize="@var{size}"
27048 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
27049 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
27050 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
27051 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
27052@end smallexample
27053
27054@noindent
27055The components are as follows:
27056
27057@table @var
27058
27059@item name
27060The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
27061
27062@item bitsize
27063The register's size, in bits.
27064
27065@item regnum
27066The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
27067than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
27068a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
27069defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
27070the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
27071packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
27072in order of increasing register number.
27073
27074@item save-restore
27075Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
27076calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
27077@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
27078some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
27079ABI.
27080
27081@item type
27082The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
27083defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
27084and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
27085for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
27086architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
27087@var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
27088
27089@item group
27090The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
27091be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
27092@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
27093in @code{info registers}.
27094
27095@end table
27096
27097@node Predefined Target Types
27098@section Predefined Target Types
27099@cindex target descriptions, predefined types
27100
27101Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
27102from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
27103standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
27104types. The currently supported types are:
27105
27106@table @code
27107
27108@item int8
27109@itemx int16
27110@itemx int32
27111@itemx int64
27112@itemx int128
27113Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27114
27115@item uint8
27116@itemx uint16
27117@itemx uint32
27118@itemx uint64
27119@itemx uint128
27120Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27121
27122@item code_ptr
27123@itemx data_ptr
27124Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
27125any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
27126pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
27127address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
27128may be marked as data pointers.
27129
27130@item ieee_single
27131Single precision IEEE floating point.
27132
27133@item ieee_double
27134Double precision IEEE floating point.
27135
27136@item arm_fpa_ext
27137The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
27138
27139@end table
27140
27141@node Standard Target Features
27142@section Standard Target Features
27143@cindex target descriptions, standard features
27144
27145A target description must contain either no registers or all the
27146target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
27147@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
27148the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
27149default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
27150described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
27151can recognize them.
27152
27153This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
27154which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
27155with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
27156if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
27157feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
27158description. You can add additional registers to any of the
27159standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
27160they were added to an unrecognized feature.
27161
27162This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
27163Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
27164@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
27165
27166Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
27167company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
27168architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
27169containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
27170
27171The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
27172of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
27173registers using the capitalization used in the description.
27174
27175@menu
27176* ARM Features::
27177* MIPS Features::
27178* M68K Features::
27179* PowerPC Features::
27180@end menu
27181
27182
27183@node ARM Features
27184@subsection ARM Features
27185@cindex target descriptions, ARM features
27186
27187The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
27188It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
27189@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
27190
27191The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
27192should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
27193
27194The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
27195it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
27196@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
27197@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
27198
27199@node MIPS Features
27200@subsection MIPS Features
27201@cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
27202
27203The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
27204It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
27205@samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
27206on the target.
27207
27208The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
27209contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
27210registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27211
27212The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
27213it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
27214contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
27215@samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27216
27217The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
27218contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
27219Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
27220
27221@node M68K Features
27222@subsection M68K Features
27223@cindex target descriptions, M68K features
27224
27225@table @code
27226@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
27227@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
27228@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
27229One of those features must be always present.
27230The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
27231used. The feature that is present should contain registers
27232@samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
27233@samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
27234
27235@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
27236This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
27237@samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
27238@samp{fpiaddr}.
27239@end table
27240
27241@node PowerPC Features
27242@subsection PowerPC Features
27243@cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
27244
27245The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
27246targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
27247@samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
27248@samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27249
27250The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
27251contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
27252
27253The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
27254contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
27255and @samp{vrsave}.
27256
27257The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
27258contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
27259@samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
27260@samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
27261@samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
27262these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
27263user.
27264
27265@include gpl.texi
27266
27267@raisesections
27268@include fdl.texi
27269@lowersections
27270
27271@node Index
27272@unnumbered Index
27273
27274@printindex cp
27275
27276@tex
27277% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
27278% meantime:
27279\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
27280\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
27281\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
27282\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
27283\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
27284\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
27285\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
27286\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
27287\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
27288\page\colophon
27289% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
27290@end tex
27291
27292@bye
This page took 0.134583 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.